Yamaha MD4S Manual de usuario

Categoría
Mezcladores de audio
Tipo
Manual de usuario
MULTITRACK MD RECORDER
Owners Manual
5 / 6 7 / 8
STEREO
MONITOR LEVEL
CUE
STEREO
2TR IN
CUE MIX TO STEREO
MONITOR SELECT
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TOC WRITE
REHE REC PLAY STOP
PAUSE
IN OUT
SONG SEARCH
LAST REC SEARCH
MARK SEARCHREPEAT
AUTO
PUNCH I/O
AB
DATA CURSOR
PHONES PUNCH I/O
PITCH
EJECT
ADJUST EDIT UTILITY
CH1
BUS
CH2
REC SELECT
CH3 CH4
LRLR
PEAK HOLD DISPLAY
010
MIN MAX
010
MULTITRACK MD RECORDER
IN THRUOUT
MIDI
MIC/LINE INPUT
3
21
4 5678
LINE INPUT
AUX SEND
INSERT
I/O
INSERT
I/O
TRACK
DIRECT OUT
STEREO
OUT
2TR IN MONITOR
OUT
12
1234
EXIT
ENTER
SET
MARK
1
1
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
–15 +15
MID
–15 +15
LOW
–15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
2
2
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
–15 +15
MID
–15 +15
LOW
–15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
3
3
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
–15 +15
MID
–15 +15
LOW
–15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
4
4
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
–15 +15
MID
–15 +15
LOW
–15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
E
Laser Diode Properties
* Material : GaAlAs
* Wavelength : 780–790 nm
* Emission Duration : Continuous
* Laser Output Power : Less than 44.6 µW
Laser output is measured at a
distance of 20cm from the object
lens on the optical pick-up head.
(Note)
• On USA or Canadian
models do not have this
label.
• This label is located on
the interior.
• Varningsanvisning för
laserstrålning. Placerad
i apparaten.
CAUTION
VARNING
VARO !
VARNING
VORSICHT!
: INVISIBLE LASER RADIATION WHEN OPEN.
AVOID EXPOSURE TO BEAM.
: OSYNLIG LASERSTRÅLNING NÄR DENNA DEL ÄR
ÖPPEND. STRÅLEN ÄR FARLIG.
: NÄKYMÄTÖNTÄ AVATTAESSA OLET ALTTIINA
LESERSÄTEILYLLE. ÄLÄ KATSO SÄTEESEEN.
: OSYNLIG LASERSTRÅLNING NÄR DENNA DEL ÄR
ÖPPNAD. BETRAKTA EJ STRÅLEN.
: UNSICHTBARE LESERSTRAHLUNG WENN ABDECKUNG
GEÖFFNET. NICHT DEM STRAHL AUSSETZEN.
This unit is classified as a
Class 1 laser product.
This label is located on the
exterior.
CLASS 1 LASER PRODUCT
LUOKAN 1 LASERLAITE
KLASS 1 LASERAPPARAT
Klassmärkning för Finland.
CAUTION
USE OF CONTROLS OR ADJUSTMENTS OR
PERFORMANCE OF PROCEDURES OTHER
THAN THOSE SPECIFIED HEREIN MAY RESULT
IN HAZARDOUS RADIATION EXPOSURE.
ADVARSEL
Usynlig laserstråling ved åbning. Undgå udsaettelse
for stråling.
VAROITUS
Laitteen käyttäminen muulla kuin tässä käyttöohjeesa
mainitulla tavalla saattaa altistaa käyttäjän
turvallisuusluokan 1 ylittävälle näkymättömälle
lasersäteilylle.
VARNING
Om apparaten används på annat sätt än i denna
bruksanvisning specificerats, kan användaren utsättas
för osynlig laserstrålning, som överskrider gränsen för
laserklass 1.
IMPORTANT
Please record the serial number of this unit in the space below.
Serial No.:
The serial number is located on the bottom or rear of the unit.
Retain this Owner's Manual in a safe place for future reference.
IMPORTANT
THE WIRES IN MAINS LEAD ARE COLOURED IN
ACCORDANCE WITH THE FOLLOWING CODE:
BLUE : NEUTRAL
BROWN : LIVE
As the colours of the wires in the mains lead of this apparatus
may not correspond with the coloured markings identifying the
terminals in your plug proceed as follows:
The wire which is coloured BLUE must be connected to the
terminal which is marked with the letter N or coloured BLACK.
The wire which is coloured BROWN must be connected to the
terminal which is marked with the letter L or coloured RED.
Making sure that neither core is connected to the earth terminal of
the three pin plug.
* This applies only to products distributed by YAMAHA KEMBLE
MUSIC (U.K.) LTD.
FCC INFORMATION (U.S.A.)
1. IMPORTANT NOTICE: DO NOT MODIFY THIS UNIT! This product, when
installed as indicated in the instructions contained in this manual, meets FCC
requirements. Modifications not expressly approved by Yamaha may void your
authority, granted by the FCC, to use the product.
2. IMPORTANT: When connecting this product to accessories and/or another
product use only high quality shielded cables. Cable/s supplied with this product
MUST be used. Follow all installation instructions. Failure to follow instructions
could void your FCC authorization to use this product in the USA.
3. NOTE: This product has been tested and found to comply with the requirements
listed in FCC Regulations, Part 15 for Class B digital devices. Compliance
with these requirements provides a reasonable level of assurance that your use of
this product in a residential environment will not result in harmful interference
with other electronic devices. This equipment generates/uses radio frequencies
and, if not installed and used according to the instructions found in the users
manual, may cause interference harmful to the operation of other electronic
devices. Compliance with FCC regulations does not guarantee that interference
will not occur in all installations. If this product is found to be the source of
interference, which can be determined by turning the unit OFF and ON,
please try to eliminate the problem by using one of the following measures:
Relocate either this product or the device that is being affected by the
interference. Utilize power outlets that are on different branch (circuit breaker or
fuse) circuits or install AC line filter/s. In the case of radio or TV interference,
relocate/reorient the antenna. If the antenna lead-in is 300 ohm ribbon lead,
change the lead-in to coaxial type cable. If these corrective measures do not
produce satisfactory results, please contact the local retailer authorized to
distribute this type of product. If you can not locate the appropriate retailer,
please contact Yamaha Corporation of America, Electronic Service Division,
6600 Orangethorpe Ave, Buena Park, CA 90620
The above statements apply ONLY to those products distributed by Yamaha
Corporation of America or its subsidiaries.
• Explanation of Graphical Symbols
The exclamation point within an equilat-
eral triangle is intended to alert the user to
the presence of important operating and
maintenance (servicing) instructions in the
literature accompanying the product.
The lightning flash with arrowhead symbol
within an equilateral triangle is intended to
alert the user to the presence of uninsulated
dangerous voltage within the products
enclosure that may be of sufficient magni-
tude to constitute a risk of electric shock to
persons.
10. Power Sources The appliance should be connected to a
power supply only of the type described in the operating
instructions or as marked on the appliance.
11. Grounding or Polarization The precautions that should be
taken so that the grounding or polarization means of an
appliance is not defeated.
12. Power-Cord Protection Power-supply cords should be
routed so that they are not likely to be walked on or pinched by
items placed upon or against them, paying particular attention
to cords at plugs, convenience receptacles, and the point where
they exit from the appliance.
13. Cleaning The appliance should be cleaned only as recom-
mended by the manufacturer.
14. Nonuse Periods The power cord of the appliance should be
unplugged from the outlet when left unused for a long period
of time.
15. Object and Liquid Entry Care should be taken so that
objects do not fall and liquids are not spilled into the enclosure
through openings.
16. Damage Requiring Service The appliance should be ser-
viced by qualified service personnel when:
A. The power-supply cord or the plug has been damaged; or
B. Objects have fallen, or liquid has been spilled into the
appliance; or
C. The appliance has been exposed to rain; or
D. The appliance does not appear to operate normally or
exhibits a marked change in performance; or
E. The appliance has been dropped, or the enclosure dam-
aged.
17. Servicing The user should not attempt service the appliance
beyond that described in the operating instructions.
SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS
CAUTION: TO REDUCE THE RISK OF
ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO NOT REMOVE
COVER (OR BACK). NO USER-SERVICEABLE
PARTS INSIDE. REFER SERVICING TO
QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL.
CAUTION
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK
DO NOT OPEN
1. Read Instructions All the safety and operating instructions
should be read before the appliance is operated.
2. Retain Instructions The safety and operating instructions
should be retained for future reference.
3. Heed Warnings All warnings on the appliance and in the
operating instructions should be adhered to.
4. Follow Instructions All operating and use instructions
should be followed.
5. Water and Moisture The appliance should not be used near
water for example, near a bathtub, washbowl, kitchen sink,
laundry tub, in a wet basement, or near a swimming pool, and
the like.
6. Carts and Stands The appliance
should be used only with a cart or stand
that is recommended by the manufac-
turer.
6A An appliance and cart combination
should be moved with care. Quick
stops, excessive force, and uneven
surfaces may cause the appliance and cart combination to
overturn.
7. Wall or Ceiling Mounting The appliance should be mounted
to a wall or ceiling only as recommended by the manufacturer.
8. Ventilation The appliance should be situated so that its
location or position does not interfere with its proper ventila-
tion. For example, the appliance should not be situated on a
bed, sofa, rug, or similar surface that may block the ventilation
openings; or, placed in a built-in installation, such as a
bookcase or cabinet that may impede the flow of air through
the ventilation openings.
9. Heat The appliance should be situated away from heat
sources such as radiators, heat registers, stoves, or other
appliances (including amplifiers) that produce heat.
The above warning is located on the
bottom or rear of the unit
4
Important
—Owner’s Manual
Important
Read the Following Before Operating the MD4S
Warnings
Do not place a container with liquid or small metal objects on top of this unit. Liquid or metal
objects inside this unit are a fire and electrical shock hazard.
Do not allow water to enter this unit or allow the unit to become wet. Fire or electrical shock
may result.
Connect this unit is power cord only to an AC outlet of the type stated in this Owner’s Manual
or as marked on the unit. Failure to do so is a fire and electrical shock hazard.
Do not scratch, bend, twist, pull, or heat the power cord. A damaged power cord is a fire and
electrical shock hazard.
Do not place heavy objects, including this unit, on top of the power cord. A damaged power
cord is a fire and electrical shock hazard. In particular, be careful not to place heavy objects on
a power cord covered by a carpet.
If you notice any abnormality, such as smoke, odor, or noise, or if a foreign object or liquid
gets inside the unit, turn it off immediately. Remove the power cord from the AC outlet.
Consult your dealer for repair. Using the unit in this condition is a fire and electrical shock
hazard.
Should this unit be dropped or the cabinet be damaged, turn the power switch off, remove the
power plug from the AC outlet, and contact your dealer. If you continue using the unit
without heeding this instruction, fire or electrical shock may result.
If the power cord is damaged (i.e., cut or a bare wire is exposed), ask your dealer for a
replacement. Using the unit with a damaged power cord is a fire and electrical shock hazard.
Do not remove the unit’s cover. You could receive an electrical shock. If you think internal
inspection, maintenance, or repair is necessary, contact your dealer.
Do not modify the unit. Doing so is a fire and electrical shock hazard.
Do not insert or drop metal or flammable objects into the disc loading slot of this unit. Fire or
electrical shock may result.
Cautions
Allow enough free space around the unit for normal ventilation. This should be: 10 cm at the
sides, and 10 cm behind.
These distances should also be adopted when rack-mounting the unit. For normal ventilation
during use, remove the rear of the rack or open a ventilation hole.
If the airflow is not adequate, the unit will heat up inside and may cause a fire.
Keep this unit away from the following locations:
Locations exposed to oil splashes or steam, such as near cooking stoves, humidifiers, etc.
Unstable surfaces, such as a wobbly table or slope.
Locations exposed to excessive heat, such as inside a car with all the windows closed, or
places that receive direct sunlight.
Locations subject to excessive humidity or dust accumulation.
This unit has ventilation holes at the top, and bottom to prevent the internal temperature
rising too high. Do not block them. Blocked ventilation holes are a fire hazard.
Important
5
—Owner’s Manual
Turn off all musical instruments, audio equipment, and speakers when connecting to this
unit. Use the correct connecting cables and connect as specified.
Always lower the volume control to minimum before turning on the power to this unit. A
sudden blast of sound may damage your hearing.
Hold the power cord plug when disconnecting it from an AC outlet. Never pull the cord. A
damaged power cord is a potential fire and electrical shock hazard.
Do not touch the power plug with wet hands. Doing so is a potential electrical shock hazard.
Do not raise the volume of headphones or speakers to a level that makes you feel
uncomfortable. Listening to loud music for long periods can damage your hearing.
Do not look at the laser beam. You may damage your vision.
Operating Notes
The digital circuits of this unit may induce a slight noise into nearby radios and TVs. If noise
occurs, relocate the affected equipment.
XLR-type connectors are wired as follows:
pin 1: ground, pin 2: hot (+), and pin 3: cold (–).
Insert TRS phone jacks are wired as follows:
sleeve: ground, tip: send, and ring: return.
The performance of components with moving contacts, such as switches, rotary controls,
faders, and connectors, deteriorates over time. The rate of deterioration depends on the
operating environment and is unavoidable. Consult your dealer about replacing defective
components.
This unit must not be operated in a tilted position. Doing so can cause malfunctions.
Copyright
© 1998 Yamaha Corporation. All rights reserved.
No part of the MD4S software or this
Owner’s Manual
may be reproduced or distributed in
any form or by any means without the prior written authorization of Yamaha Corporation.
Trademarks:
MD DATA and MiniDisc are trademarks of Sony Corporation.
US and foreign patents licensed from Dolby Laboratories Licensing Corporation.
All other trademarks are the property of their respective holders.
Keep This Manual For Future Reference
6
Contents
—Owner’s Manual
Contents
Welcome to the MD4S......................................... 9
MD4S Features ............................................................................................9
Mixer............................................................................................................ 9
Recorder ...................................................................................................... 9
Buying discs for the MD4S.........................................................................10
MD DATA and MiniDisc .......................................................................... 10
MD4S TOC .................................................................................................11
To update the TOC.................................................................................... 11
Recording modes and recording times......................................................11
MD4S songs and blank areas .....................................................................12
Front and rear panel...................................................................................13
Mono Inputs............................................................................................... 13
Stereo Inputs .............................................................................................. 15
Monitor/Master section............................................................................. 15
Disc transport section................................................................................ 16
Display ........................................................................................................ 19
Top panel connectors ................................................................................ 22
Rear panel................................................................................................... 23
Front panel ................................................................................................. 24
Basic operation.................................................... 25
Before you begin.........................................................................................25
Example connections................................................................................. 25
Turning on the MD4S................................................................................ 26
Inserting a disc ........................................................................................... 26
Recording the first track (Direct Recording) ............................................26
Preparations for recording ........................................................................ 26
Start recording............................................................................................ 28
Overdubbing...............................................................................................30
Mixdown.....................................................................................................32
After completing the Basic Operation section ..........................................34
Advanced recording techniques ......................... 35
Advanced techniques on the MD4S ..........................................................35
Mixing multiple channels as you record ...................................................36
Ping-pong recording ..................................................................................39
Adding sounds during mixdown...............................................................42
Contents
7
—Owner’s Manual
Applying effects...........................................................................................44
Using the INSERT I/O jacks.......................................................................44
Using the AUX SEND jacks .......................................................................46
Applying effects during mixdown .............................................................47
Applying an effect during ping-pong recording .......................................48
Applying an effect only to the monitor signal...........................................50
Punch-in/out...............................................................................................52
Manual punch-in/out.................................................................................52
Auto punch-in/out .....................................................................................55
Quick search functions...............................................................................61
Searching for songs.....................................................................................61
Locating to a specified time........................................................................61
Locating to the Last Record In/Out Point.................................................62
Searching for Markers ................................................................................62
Adjusting the location of a marker or auto punch-in/out point .............63
Erasing a marker or auto punch-in/out point ..........................................65
Various playback functions........................................................................66
Play forward/backward at various speeds (Cue/Review) .........................66
Playback at half speed (x1/2 Play)..............................................................67
Playing a song repeatedly (One Song Repeat/All Song Repeat)...............67
Repeating a specific portion of a song (A-B Repeat)................................68
Cue List playback........................................................................................68
Programming the song playback order (Program Play) ..........................71
Editing functions ........................................................................................73
Copying a portion of a track (Part Copy) .................................................73
Erasing a section of a track (Part Erase)....................................................74
Copying an entire track to another track (Track Copy)...........................75
Erasing an entire track (Track Erase) ........................................................76
Copying/converting a song (Song Copy)..................................................76
Erasing a song (Song Erase) .......................................................................78
Splitting a song into two (Song Divide) ....................................................79
Joining divided songs together (Song Combine)......................................80
Moving a song (Song Move)......................................................................81
Exchanging the order of songs (Song Renumber)....................................82
Other functions...........................................................................................84
Adjusting the record/playback pitch (Pitch function) .............................84
Titling discs and songs................................................................................85
Erasing a disc (Disc Erase) .........................................................................86
Viewing disc contents.................................................................................86
Changing the recording mode ...................................................................87
Adjusting the display brightness................................................................88
Selecting the type of Frame display............................................................88
Using a Foot switch ....................................................................................89
MIDI functions...........................................................................................90
Synchronizing the MD4S with a MIDI sequencer....................................90
About MTC and MIDI Clock ....................................................................91
Synchronization using MTC......................................................................91
Synchronization using MIDI Clock...........................................................92
Synchronizing two MD4S recorders..........................................................94
Synchronizing to MTC with a specified offset (time difference).............97
Controlling the MD4S by MMC................................................................98
8
Contents
—Owner’s Manual
Appendix ............................................................ 100
Q&A Section ..............................................................................................100
Troubleshooting ........................................................................................101
Display Messages
Modes of the MD4S transport ..................................................................104
Specifications .............................................................................................105
Recorder .................................................................................................... 105
Mixer.......................................................................................................... 105
General....................................................................................................... 106
Dimensions................................................................................................ 106
Block Diagram ...........................................................................................107
Glossary......................................................................................................108
Tempo Map Chart.....................................................................................111
MIDI Implementation Chart .............................. 112
Index................................................................... 113
Welcome to the MD4S
9
—Owner’s Manual
Welcome to the MD4S
MD4S Features
Mixer
The mixer section is an analog mixer with four MIC/LINE and four LINE inputs.
Continuously variable GAIN controls are provided on input channels 1–4, accepting signals
ranging from mic input to line level.
Of the four MIC/LINE inputs, two are balanced, allowing the use of either TRS phone plugs
or XLR plugs.
Input channels 1 and 2 provide INSERT I/O jacks that allow external effects such as a
compressor to be connected.
Input channels 1–4 provide three-band EQ (HIGH/MID/LOW) that has been specially
engineered for musical applications.
Two AUX SEND jacks allow external effects such as reverb to be connected.
Signals sent from input channels 1–4 to the CUE bus (a signal route for monitoring) can be
monitored in stereo.
The mixer features an in-line design that allows the input signal and the track playback sound
to be controlled simultaneously. While using the CUE bus to monitor each track, you can
make full use of input channels 1–4 as you record. During mixdown, a total of eight sources
(including track playback signals) can be mixed.
TRACK DIRECT OUT jacks are provided for direct output of the playback from each track.
Recorder
The recorder features a 4-track recorder based on the MD DATA audio format. This provides
many advantages over tape-based multitrack recorders.
You can choose from three recording modes: 4 track, 2 track, monaural.
Negligible decrease in audio quality even after repeated ping-pong operations.
Ping-pong is possible even if all four tracks have been recorded.
A variety of locate functions allow you to move instantly to any location in the song.
Accurate auto punch-in/out can be performed with 11.6-millisecond accuracy.
A variety of editing functions allow you to copy or erase songs and tracks.
A variety of repeat functions allow songs or portions of a song to be repeated seamlessly.
The multi-take auto punch-in/out function lets you repeat auto punch-in/out several times,
and select the best take afterward.
Shuttle playback allows rapid playback / reverse-playback at speeds of 1/2, 2x, 4x, 8x, 16x, or
32x normal speed. (Forward playback only for 1/2 speed.)
Program Play function lets you program the playback order of songs. In addition, Cue List
Playback lets you freely program the playback order between markers.
10
Welcome to the MD4S
—Owner’s Manual
The recording/playback pitch can be adjusted up to a maximum of
±
10%. In addition, you
can use the x1/2 play function to playback at half-speed with a pitch that is one octave lower.
MIDI Time Code (MTC) / MIDI Clock data can be transmitted from the MIDI OUT
connector. This allows synchronization with a MIDI sequencer or rhythm machine without
using up a recording track. In addition, MTC from an external device can be received at the
MIDI IN connector, allowing the MD4S to be synchronized to external video/audio devices.
MIDI Machine Control (MMC) can be received, allowing the transport of the MD4S to be
controlled from a MIDI sequencer or other external device.
Buying discs for the MD4S
The MD4S can use two types of disc: MD DATA and MiniDisc. MD DATA discs can be used
for 4-track recording/playback, and MiniDiscs can be used for recording/playback of up to
two tracks. (They cannot be used for 4-track recording/playback.)
MD DATA and MiniDisc
MD DATA are widely used for computer data storage, and the MD4S uses the audio format of
this type of disc.
MiniDiscs (also known as MD) are used only for music.
Type
MD DATA MiniDisc
Logo
4-track recording/
playback
Yes (37 minutes per track) No
2-track recording/
playback
Yes (74 minutes) Yes (74 minutes)
Monaural recording/
playback
Yes (148 minutes) Yes (148 minutes)
Notes
These discs are for computer stor-
age applications, and can be pur-
chased at computer shops. Two
types are available: playback-only
and rewritable. Use the rewritable
type with the MD4S.
MD DATA discs recorded on the
MD4S cannot be played back on a
conventional MD player.
MD DATA discs that have been
used to store computer data can-
not be used as is by the MD4S.
Such discs must first be formatted
for audio use. See
“Erasing a disc
(Disc Erase)”
on page 86 for more
information.
Songs that were recorded in 8-
track mode on a recorder such as
the MD8 cannot be played back
on the MD4S.
These discs are for music. Two
types are available: playback-only
and rewritable. If you use the
rewritable type, you can record up
to two tracks.
MiniDiscs recorded on the MD4S
can be played back on a conven-
tional MD player.
MiniDiscs recorded on a conven-
tional MD recorder can be edited
on the MD4S, but if the music
includes a song that was digitally
copied from a copy-protected
music CD, editing will not be pos-
sible.
MD4S TOC
11
—Owner’s Manual
MD4S TOC
TOC refers to the Table of Contents area on the disc. The TOC contains information about
what is recorded on the disc, the disc title, song titles, and so on.
When you record a new song or edit the song title, the TOC EDIT indicator of the MD4S will
light to indicate that the TOC needs to be updated.
If the TOC EDIT indicator is lit, you must update the TOC before turning off the power of the
MD4S. If the power is turned off when the TOC EDIT indicator is lit, the data you recorded or
edited will be lost.
To update the TOC
Press the STOP button, and with the MD4S stopped, press the TOC WRITE button. (The
STOP button and the TOC WRITE button are the same button.)
The display will show “Writing TOC, indicating that the TOC is being written to disc. When
the TOC has been updated, the “Writing TOC” display and the TOC EDIT indicator will go
dark.
Recording modes and recording times
The MD4S offers three recording modes: 4-track (4TR), 2-track (2TR), and monaural
(MONO). The times available for recording on a single disc will depend on the recording
mode. Available recording/playback times will be 37 minutes in 4TR mode, 74 minutes in 2TR
mode, and 148 minutes in MONO mode. You can use a different recording mode for each
song, which allows you to make the most efficient use of each disc.
Note: If you press the EJECT button while the TOC EDIT indicator is lit, the TOC will
automatically be updated before the disc is ejected.
TOC EDIT
TOC WRITE
STOP
4TR mode
37 minutes
2TR mode
MONO mode
74 minutes
148 minutes
12 Welcome to the MD4S
—Owner’s Manual
MD4S songs and blank areas
On the MD4S, recordings are made in units called “songs. Each song is assigned a number
indicating the order in which it was recorded. For example if you have recorded two songs on
a disc, song 2 will be recorded immediately after song 1, as shown in the following diagram.
When you record a new song or record additional material onto a previously-recorded song to
lengthen it, the new recording is done only on the unrecorded portion of the disc; the “blank
area. In the diagram above, it is possible to record a new song (song 3) in the blank area, or to
record additional material onto song 2 to lengthen it. However since there is no blank area
immediately after song 1, it is not immediately possible to record additional material to song 1
to lengthen it.
If three songs (songs 1, 2, and 3) are recorded consecutively on disc as shown in the following
diagram, and the middle song is erased, there will be a blank area corresponding to the length
of that song.
* Blank areas are also assigned a “blank area number” in the order in which they are created.
If you then record a song in the situation shown above, you will be able to select either blank
area 1 or blank area 2 in which to record. However if you select blank area 2, the time available
for recording will be limited to the length of the song that was erased.
Tip: If you wish to lengthen song 1, you will need to use a song editing function to move
song 1 to the blank area.
Song 1 Song 2
Blank area 1
Song 1 Song 3Song 2
Blank area 1
Song 1 Song 3Blank area 2
Erase song 2
Blank area 1
Front and rear panel 13
—Owner’s Manual
Front and rear panel
This section explains the names and functions of each part of the MD4S.
Mono Inputs
A GAIN control
This adjusts the input sensitivity of the MIC/LINE input jack (jacks 1 and 2 on the top
panel). Input channels 1–4 can accommodate signals of any level from mic input to the
line level signals produced by devices such as synthesizers.
B FLIP switch
This switch selects the signal source for the input channel and the signal source that is
sent to the CUE bus for monitoring.
When this switch is in the MIC/LINE position ( ), the signal from the MIC/LINE jack
will be sent to the input channel, and the track signal (the signal currently being recorded
or played back) will be sent to the CUE bus.
When this switch is in the PB position ( ), the signal from the track will be sent to the
input channel, and the signal from the MIC/LINE jack will be sent to the CUE bus.
1
1
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
–15 +15
MID
–15 +15
LOW
–15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
1
2
5
6
7
3
4
GAIN
HIGH
LINE MIC
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
CUE
LR
010
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
GAIN
HIGH
LINE MIC
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
CUE
LR
010
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
To the CUE bus To the CUE bus
To the ST bus,
tracks etc.
To the ST bus,
tracks etc.
Signal input to the
MIC/LINE INPUT jack
from an instrument etc.
Signal input to the
MIC/LINE INPUT jack
from an instrument etc.
MD4S
track signal
MD4S
track signal
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
PB
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
PB
When the FLIP
switch is in the
PB position ( )
When the FLIP
switch is in
the MIC/LINE
position ( )
14 Welcome to the MD4S
—Owner’s Manual
C CUE PAN/CUE LEVEL controls
These two controls adjust the pan and signal level of the signal that is sent to the CUE bus. The
signal that is sent to the CUE bus will depend on the setting of the FLIP switch
2.
D EQ controls
These controls are used to adjust the high, middle, and low frequency bands. Each can boost
(amplify) or cut (attenuate) the frequency bands shown below over a range of ±15 dB. Each
knob is detented at the 12 o’clock position, which produces a flat response (no boost or cut).
HIGH (high range): 10 kHz (shelving)
MID (mid range): 2.5 kHz (peaking)
LOW (low range): 100 Hz (shelving)
E AUX control
This control sends the signal from the input channel to the AUX SEND jacks. Rotating the
knob toward the “1” position will sent the signal from the input channel to the AUX SEND 1
jack, and rotating the knob toward the “2” position will send the signal to the AUX SEND 2
jack. The knob is detented at the 12 o’clock position, and at this position no signal will be sent
to either AUX SEND jack 1 or 2. The AUX controls are normally used to adjust the signal level
that is sent to external effect devices.
F PAN control
This control adjusts the pan (left/right position) of the input channel signal that is sent to the
ST bus. If you are recording via the ST bus, rotating this control to the L position will assign
the input signal to odd-numbered tracks (tracks 1 and 3), and rotating it to the R position will
assign the input signal to even-numbered tracks (tracks 2 and 4). During mixdown, use this
control to adjust the stereo position of the playback for each track.
G Fader
During recording (when the FLIP switch is at MIC/LINE), use the fader to adjust the input
level of the signal being recorded on the track. During mixdown (when the FLIP switch is at
PB), use the fader to adjust playback level of each track. The fader will be at unity gain when
located between 7 and 8.
Unity gain: This refers to a condition where the output signal and input signal levels are the
same, which will produce the least distortion and the optimal S/N ratio.
Note: The AUX control is “post-fader”; i.e., it adjusts the level of the signal that has passed
through the fader
7. This means that if the fader has been lowered, the AUX control will
have no effect.
Response [dB]
Frequency [Hz]
+5
+10
+15
–15
–10
–5
0
10k1k100 20k20
Front and rear panel 15
—Owner’s Manual
Stereo Inputs
H Level (5/6), (7/8) controls
These controls adjust the level of the signals input from STEREO
INPUT jacks 5/6 or 7/8. These input signals are always sent to the
ST bus, and are mixed with the signals from input channels 1–4
and the playback signals of the tracks.
Monitor/Master section
I CUE MIX TO STEREO switch
This switch turns the cue mix function on/off. When the switch is
pressed in ( ), the CUE MIX indicator in the display will light,
and the signal from the CUE bus will be mixed into the ST bus.
The cue mix function can be used only during playback, and is
normally used when adding sounds during mixdown (page 42).
J MONITOR SELECT switches
These switches select the signal that will be monitored from the
MONITOR OUT jacks (rear panel
4) and the PHONES jack
(front panel
1). When the switch is pressed in, the
corresponding source is selected (on). When the switch is up, the
signal will not be selected (off). The three switches can be turned
on/off independently.
2TR IN................... Monitor the signal that is input from the 2TR
IN jacks (rear panel
6).
STEREO ............... Monitor the ST bus signal that is output from
the STEREO OUT jacks (rear panel
5).
CUE....................... Monitor the CUE bus signal.
K MONITOR LEVEL control
This control adjusts the output level of the monitor signal that is
sent to the MONITOR OUT jacks (rear panel
4) and the
PHONES jack (front panel
1).
L STEREO fader
This adjusts the output level of the ST bus that is output from the
STEREO OUT jacks (rear panel
5). The fader will be at unity
gain when located between 7 and 8.
Unity gain: Refer to the explanation of 7 Fader.
5 / 6 7 / 8
010010
8
STEREO
MONITOR LEVEL
CUE
STEREO
2TR IN
CUE MIX TO STEREO
MONITOR SELECT
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MIN MAX
9
K
L
J
16 Welcome to the MD4S
—Owner’s Manual
Disc transport section
A Disc transport buttons
REHE button ......This button is used to rehearse punch-in/out. During rehearsal the REHE
indicator located above the button will light, and while rehearsal is paused
the indicator will blink.
REC button.........This button is used to record. When you press the REC button during
playback, recording will begin from that location on any recordable
track(s). (See “Manual punch-in/out” on page 52 for more information.)
The REC indicator located above the button will light during recording,
and will blink to indicate record pause.
PLAY button .......This button is used to begin normal playback, recording, and rehearsal.
After pressing the REHE button, pressing the PLAY button will enter
rehearsal mode. After pressing the REC button, pressing the PLAPY button
will begin recording. If you press the PLAY button without pressing the
REHE or REC button, normal playback will begin. During playback/
recording/rehearsal, the PLAY indicator located above the button will light.
When playback/recording/rehearsal is paused, the PLAY indicator will blink.
PAUSE button....This button temporarily halts (pauses) playback/recording/rehearsal. After
operation has been paused, pressing the PAUSE button once again will
resume playback/recording/rehearsal from that location. If you do not
operate any buttons for about 10 minutes while the unit is in Pause or Rec
Pause mode, the mode will be canceled automatically.
TOC WRITE
REHE REC PLAY STOP
PAUSE
IN OUT
SONG SEARCH
LAST REC SEARCH
MARK SEARCHREPEAT
AUTO
PUNCH I/O
AB
DATA CURSOR
PHONES PUNCH I/O
PITCH
EJECT
ADJUST EDIT UTILITY
CH1
BUS
CH2
REC SELECT
CH3 CH4
LRLR
PEAK HOLD DISPLAY
MULTITRACK MD RECORDER
1234
EXIT
ENTER
SET
MARK
L
K
J
M
N
O
P
Q
R
9
6
7
5
8
2
1
3
4
* Please remove the protective film from the panel.
If the film is left on, the adhesive may break down and soil the unit.
Front and rear panel 17
—Owner’s Manual
STOP/TOC WRITE button........... This button stops playback/recording/rehearsal. When
stopped, this button functions as the TOC WRITE button
to update the TOC (page 11).
B AUTO PUNCH I/O button
This button turns the auto punch-in/out function on/off. When auto punch-in/out is on, the
auto punch indicator in the display (display
K) will light.
C SONG SEARCH [ ]/[ ] buttons
These buttons search for the starting locations of songs or blank areas. They are used to search
for and move to the beginning of songs.
D A B repeat button
This button sets the A and B points of the A-B repeat function (page 68).
E LAST REC SEARCH [IN]/[OUT], SET buttons
The LAST REC SEARCH [IN]/[OUT] buttons locate to the points at which recording or
rehearsal were last started (last record IN point) or last ended (last record OUT point). In
conjunction with the SET button, these buttons can be used to specify any desired location in
a song as the last record in/out point (punch-in/out point).
F REPEAT button
This button is used to select functions such as one song repeat” which repeatedly plays back a
single song, or all song repeat” which repeatedly plays back all songs on the disc, and is also
used to switch the repeat function on/off. The repeat indicator (display
O) will light to
indicate the repeat function that is selected.
G MARK SEARCH [ ]/[ ], MARK buttons
The MARK SEARCH buttons are used to locate to the Start marker (beginning of the song),
End marker (end of the song), or to markers that you can set at desired locations in the song.
The MARK button is used to insert a marker into the desired location of a song.
H Disc compartment
An MD DATA or MiniDisc can be inserted here.
I BUS button
This button is used in conjunction with the REC SELECT buttons J to specify the tracks on
which the ST bus signal will be recorded.
J REC SELECT buttons
These buttons select/defeat recording tracks. Tracks selected for recording will be indicated by
the track record indicators (display
J) in the display.
When you press only a REC SELECT button
Recording will be enabled for the corresponding track, and the signal from input channels 1–
4 will be sent directly to the track (direct recording).
When you hold down the BUS button and press a REC SELECT button
Recording will be enabled for the corresponding track. The L channel of the ST bus will be
sent to tracks 1 and 3, and the R channel of the ST bus signal will be sent to tracks 2 and 4.
K EJECT button
This button ejects the disc from the MD4S. If you press the EJECT button while the TOC
EDIT indicator (display
1) is lit, the TOC will be updated before the disc is ejected.
18 Welcome to the MD4S
—Owner’s Manual
L PEAK HOLD button
This button turns the peak hold function on/off. When the peak hold function is on, a
segment of the track/stereo level meters will remain lit to indicate the maximum level that was
reached. When the peak hold function is on, pressing the PEAK HOLD button once again will
turn off the peak hold function, and the segment that had remained lit will be reset.
M DISPLAY button
This button selects the time counter mode (ELAPSE TIME / TOTAL TIME / REMAIN TIME).
The selected time counter mode will be shown in the display (display
5). If a tempo map has
been programmed for the MD4S, this button will switch the time counter between measure/
beat/clock displays.
N Function buttons
These buttons are used to access a variety of functions. When a button is pressed to access the
corresponding function, the indicator located above the button will light.
PITCH button......Selects functions to adjust the pitch for playback and recording (page 84).
According to the setting, the pitch indicator in the display will indicate
“FIX” (fixed) or “VARI” (variable).
ADJUST button..Allows you to make fine adjustments to the markers or last recording in/
out points that you have set within a song (page 63).
EDIT button ........Accesses a variety of editing functions, and allows you to specify a disc title
or song title.
UTILITY button...Allows you to use MIDI functions, adjust the display contrast, and change
the recording mode etc.
O EXIT button
Use this button to cancel a function or mode.
P ENTER button
Use this button to set functions.
Q DATA dial (DATA+ –)
When the MD4S is stopped or paused, rotating the DATA dial will move through the song in
frame steps. When editing various functions (when one of the function buttons has been
pressed), the DATA dial is used to modify parameter values.
R CURSOR shuttle
When the MD4S is stopped or paused, rotating the CURSOR shuttle allows you to rapidly
rewind or fast-forward through the song. During playback, the CURSOR shuttle allows you to
review (play backward) or cue (play forward) at a variety of speeds (Shuttle playback
functions: page 66). While editing various functions, the CURSOR shuttle is used to select
parameters.
Front and rear panel 19
—Owner’s Manual
Display
A TOC EDIT indicator
This indicator will light when the TOC (table of contents) needs to be updated, such as after a
new recording or edit. If the power of the MD4S is turned off while the TOC EDIT indicator is
lit, the recorded or edited content may be lost. When you update the TOC, the indicator will
go dark.
B Status indicators
These indicators show the current operating mode.
C Pitch indicator
This indicator shows the current pitch mode. The status of the x1/2 Play function is also
shown here.
HALF..................... Lights when the x1/2 Play function is on.
FIX......................... Lights when the Pitch function is off.
VARI...................... Lights when the Pitch function is on.
D Title and function display
Song numbers, song/disc titles, the currently selected function, or other messages will appear
here.
Indicator Meaning
Normal playback
Cue or Review
Playback is paused
Rehearsal Pause mode
Rehearsal in progress
Record Pause mode
Recording in progress
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 OUTINE10S
REPEAT A1ALL B
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
L R L R
AUTO PUNCH
SINGLE MULTI
MTC FRAMESBEAT SECMEASURE MIN
REMAIN TIMETOTAL TIMEELAPSE TIME
MTC SYNCPITCH
REHE
REC
TOC EDIT
HALF FIX VARI
MASTER SLAVE
MMCMIDI CLK
TRK
DIR
BUS
CLIP
3
6
9
12
15
18
27
39
+12
+9
+6
+3
0
3
6
12
20
STEREO
CUE MIX
dB
L R
SONG NO.
REC MODE
STEP NO.
` 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0
3
2
1
4 5678
9JLNMO K
REHE
REHE
REC
REC
20 Welcome to the MD4S
—Owner’s Manual
E Time counter mode
This indicates the time counter mode that was selected by the DISPLAY button (disc transport
M). However if a tempo map has been programmed and the time counter is showing
measure/beat/clock, all of these indicators will be dark.
ELAPSE TIME......The time counter will show the current elapsed time within the song.
TOTAL TIME.........The time counter will show the time position within the entire disc.
REMAIN TIME......The time counter will show the remaining time within the son
F MIDI indicators
The status of various MIDI functions is shown here.
MTC SYNC MASTER ..........This will light when you enable MTC transmission. In this case,
the MD4S will transmit MTC and will function as the master of
a synchronized MIDI system.
MTC SYNC SLAVE..............This will light when you enable MTC reception. In this case, the
MD4S will receive MTC and will function as a slave in a
synchronized MIDI system.
MIDI CLK ..............This will light when you enable MIDI Clock transmission. In this case, the
MD4S will transmit MIDI Clock and will function as the master of a
synchronized MIDI system.
MMC......................This will light when you enable MMC (MIDI Machine Control) reception.
In this case, the MD4S can be controlled from an external device such as a
MIDI sequencer.
G Track level meters
These indicate the recording/playback level of each track. The range from –39 dB to CLIP is
shown in nine steps. The CLIP indicator will light to indicate that digital clipping has
occurred in the signal. If no disc is inserted, these meters will indicate the input levels of input
channels 1–4.
H Stereo level meter
This meter indicates the output level of the STEREO OUT jacks. The range from –20 dB to
+12 dB is shown in nine steps.
I CUE MIX indicator
This indicates the on/off status of the cue mix function. If you record while the cue mix
function is on, this indicator will blink, indicating that the cue mix function has been
temporarily turned off.
J Track recording indicators
These indicate the recording status of each track. When a indicator is blinking, the
corresponding track is ready to record. When recording begins, the blinking indicator will
light solidly.
DIR/14 .................These indicate tracks that have been selected for direct recording (in which
the signal from the input channel is recorded directly).
BUS/L, R...............These indicate tracks that have been selected for recording the signal from
the ST bus (L or R channel).
Front and rear panel 21
—Owner’s Manual
K Auto punch indicator
This indicator shows the status of the auto punch-in/out function.
AUTO PUNCH SINGLE....... This will light when you select Single Take Auto Punch-in/out
(in which auto punch-in/out will occur only once).
AUTO PUNCH MULTI......... This will light when you select Multi Take Auto Punch-in/out (in
which you can perform auto punch-in/out repeatedly, and then
select the best take).
L IN, OUT indicators
These show the status of the last record in (IN)/out (OUT) points.
IN........................... This will light if the Last Record In Point (auto punch-in point) has been
set. During auto punch-in/out, this indicator will go dark when the song
reaches or passes the specified IN point.
OUT....................... This will light if the Last Record Out Point (auto punch-out point) has
been set. During auto punch-in/out, this indicator will go dark when the
song reaches or passes the specified OUT point.
M Time counter
This indicates time locations on the disc in minutes/seconds/frames. When transmitting
MIDI Clock data, the minutes/seconds/frames display can be changed to measures/beats/
clocks. (In this case, the MEASURE and BEAT indicators will light.)
N Marker indicators
These indicate the status of the various markers that have been set within the song. When a
marker is set, the corresponding indicator will light. When a song passes a marker point that
has been set, the corresponding indicators will blink.
S ............................ Start marker (beginning of the song)
110 ...................... Marker numbers 1–10 that were set at desired locations in the song using
the MARK button.
E ............................ End marker (end of the song)
O Repeat indicator
This indicates the repeat function that has been selected by the REPEAT button (disk
transport
6, or the A B button (disk transport 4).
REPEAT 1 ............ One Song Repeat
REPEAT ALL....... All Song Repeat
REPEAT A B........ A-B repeat
REPEAT + auto punch indicator K ........... Auto punch-in/out is rehearsed repeatedly
22 Welcome to the MD4S
—Owner’s Manual
Top panel connectors
A MIC/LINE INPUT 1,2 jacks
Balanced dynamic mics or line-level devices with balanced output can be connected to these
inputs. Unbalanced outputs such as on synthesizers can also be connected here. These jacks
will accommodate either XLR plugs or TRS phone plugs.
B INSERT I/O jacks
These are TRS phone jacks for connecting external effect devices. By connecting an external
effect such as a compressor or noise gate to these jacks, you can process the signal of input
channels 1 and 2.
C MIC/LINE INPUT 3, 4 jacks
These are 1/4" phone jacks used to connect electronic instruments such as a synthesizer or an
unbalanced mic.
D LINE INPUT 5–8 jacks
These are 1/4" phone jacks used to connect line-level devices such as synthesizers or CD
players. They can also be used as effect return jacks to input the effect sound from external
effect units such as reverb.
134
MIC/LINE INPUT
3
21
4 5678
LINE INPUT
INSERT
I/O
INSERT
I/O
2
MIC/LINE INPUT
3
21
4
INSERT
I/O
INSERT
I/O
INPUT OUTPUT
External effect unit (compressor, noise gate etc.)
Front and rear panel 23
—Owner’s Manual
Rear panel
A POWER switch
This switch is used to turn the MD4S on and off.
B AC IN
Connect the included power cable here.
C AUX SEND 1, 2 jacks
These are 1/4" phone jacks that output the signals from the input channels as adjusted by the
AUX controls (input channel
5). Normally they are used as effect send jacks to send signals
to external effect processors (page 45).
D MONITOR OUT jacks
These are RCA phono jacks that output the monitor signal selected by the MONITOR
SELECT switch (monitor/master
J). Connect them to your hi-fi system or to amplified
monitor speakers.
E STEREO OUT jacks
These are RCA phono jacks that output the signal of the ST bus that has passed through the
STEREO fader (monitor/master
L). During mixdown, connect these jacks to the inputs of
your master recorder.
F 2TR IN jacks
These are RCA phono jacks for connecting a line-level stereo device. Normally they are
connected to the output jacks of your DAT or other master recorder.
G TRACK DIRECT OUT 1–4 jacks
These are RCA phono jacks which individually output the signals from tracks 1–4 (the signals
currently being recorded/played). Normally they are used to connect the MD4S to the input
jacks of a large mixer when you wish to use an external mixer to mix the playback of the MD4S
recorder tracks.
RRR 4 2
LLL
2TR INAUX SENDAC IN
31
MIDI
OUT
STEREO
OUT
MONITOR
OUTPOWER
ON/ OFF
TRACK
DIRECT OUT
THRU IN
12
7
8
4 56
321
CAUTION
TO PREVENT ELECTRIC SHOCK,
MATCH WIDE BLADE OF PLUG TO
WIDE SLOT, FULLY INSERT.
24 Welcome to the MD4S
—Owner’s Manual
H MIDI IN, OUT, THRU connectors
These connectors are used to exchange MIDI messages with external MIDI devices.
MIDI OUT connector.......... MIDI Clock and MIDI Time Code (MTC) is output from this
connector. This is used when synchronizing the MD4S with a
MIDI sequencer or rhythm machine.
MIDI IN connector..............MTC or MMC (MIDI Machine Control) is received at this
connector. This is used when controlling the transport of the
MD4S from an external MIDI sequencer.
MIDI THRU connector....... MIDI messages received at the MIDI IN connector are
retransmitted without change from this connector to another
external MIDI device.
Front panel
A PHONES jack
A pair of stereo headphones can be connected here for
monitoring. This jack will output the same signal as the
MONITOR OUT jacks.
B PUNCH I/O jack
A Yamaha FC5 (sold separately) can be connected here,
allowing you to use a foot switch to start/pause playback,
start/pause rehearsal, or punch-in/out. (See “Using a Foot
switch on page 89 for more information.)
1 2
Basic operation 25
—Owner’s Manual
Basic operation
This chapter explains the process of recording instruments separately on each of the four
tracks, and finally mixing down to a master recorder.
Before you begin
Example connections
Synthesizer
Guitar
Microphone
Headphones
LR
5 / 6 7 / 8
STEREO
MONITOR LEVEL
CUE
STEREO
2TR IN
CUE MIX TO STEREO
MONITOR SELECT
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TOC WRITE
REHE REC PLAY STOP
PAUSE
IN OUT
SONG SEARCH
LAST REC SEARCH
MARK SEARCHREPEAT
AUTO
PUNCH I/O
AB
DATA CURSOR
PHONES PUNCH I/O
PITCH
EJECT
ADJUST EDIT UTILITY
CH1
BUS
CH2
REC SELECT
CH3 CH4
LRLR
PEAK HOLD DISPLAY
010
MIN MAX
010
MULTITRACK MD RECORDER
IN THRUOUT
MIDI
MIC/LINE INPUT
3
21
4 5678
LINE INPUT
AUX SEND
INSERT
I/O
INSERT
I/O
TRACK
DIRECT OUT
STEREO
OUT
2TR IN MONITOR
OUT
12
1234
EXIT
ENTER
SET
MARK
1
1
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
2
2
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
3
3
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
4
4
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
Master recorder
AC outlet
RRR 4 2
LLL
2TR INAUX SENDAC IN
31
MIDI
OUT
STEREO
OUT
MONITOR
OUTPOWER
ON/ OFF
TRACK
DIRECT OUT
THRU IN
12
Amplified monitor speakers
Guitar effects
processor
YAMAHA
VOL VOL
26 Basic operation
—Owner’s Manual
Turning on the MD4S
1. Plug the power cable into an AC outlet.
2. Press the POWER switch located on the rear
panel of the MD4S. When the power is
turned on, the display will light.
To turn off the MD4S, press the POWER switch
again.
Inserting a disc
Make sure that the write protect slider of the disc
is in the write permit position.
1. With the arrow printed on the disc pointing
away from yourself, slide the disc gently into
the disc compartment.
The disc will be pulled in automatically. If not, check
that the arrow is pointing the correct direction.
When a disc is inserted into the MD4S, the TOC
will be read to see what the disc contains. If the
disc is new, the display will indicate “Blank Disc.
If songs have already been recorded on the disc,
the disc title will appear for several seconds, and
then the number of songs on the disc (e.g., Total
004”) will appear.
Recording the first track (Direct Recording)
On the MD4S, the signals that are input to the MIC/LINE INPUT jacks 1–4 can be recorded
directly to tracks 1–4 (direct recording). Since you simply need to connect the audio source to MIC/
LINE INPUT jack 1 if you wish to record on track 1, or to MIC/LINE INPUT jack 3 if you wish to
record on track 3, this method is convenient when you will be recording each part separately.
In this example, we will explain how to record your first audio source on track 1.
Preparations for recording
LRLR
5 / 6 7 / 8
STEREO
STEREO
2TR IN
CUE MIX TO STEREO
MONITOR SELECT
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TOC WRITE
REHE PLAY STOP
PAU SE
IN OUT
LAST REC SEARCH
MARK SEARCHREPEAT
AUTO
PUNCH I/O
AB
DATA CURSOR
PHONES PUNCH I/O
PITCH
EJECT
ADJUST EDIT UTILITY
BUS
CH2
REC SELECT
CH3 CH4
PEAK HOLD DISPLAY
010
010
MULTITRACK MD RECORDER
IN THRUOUT
MIDI
MIC/LINE INPUT
3
2
4 5678
LINE INPUT
AUX SEND
INSERT
I/O
INSERT
I/O
TRACK
DIRECT OUT
STEREO
OUT
2TR IN MONITOR
OUT
12
EXIT
ENTER
SET
MARK
1
1
4
4
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
3
3
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
2
2
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
CUE
LR
PAN
LR
AUX
12
P
A
N
423
MONITOR LEVEL
CUE
REC
SONG SEARCH
CH1
MIN MAX
1
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
GAIN
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PB
L
E
V
E
L
1
5 1
4
B
9
0
7
A
3
2
86
Recording the first track (Direct Recording) 27
—Owner’s Manual
Find a blank area
A new song can be recorded only on a blank area.
If you wish to record a new song on a disc that
already contains recorded material, you must
begin by finding a blank area.
1 Press the SONG SEARCH [ ] button several
times to find the blank area.
When a blank area has been found, the display will
indicate “BLANK X (where X is the number of
the blank area).
Select the track for recording
2
Connect your audio source to MIC/LINE
INPUT jack 1.
Normally, you will record the rhythm instruments
(rhythm machine, drums, or rhythm guitar etc.)
first.
3 Set the FLIP switch of input channel 1 to
“MIC/LINE ( ).”
When you set the FLIP switch to the “MIC/LINE
( )” position, the input signal from the MIC/
LINE INPUT jack will be sent to the correspond-
ing input channel.
4 Press REC SELECT button 1.
The REC SELECT buttons are switches that select
the recording source for each track. When you
press REC SELECT button 1, track 1 will be ready
for recording, and the signal from input channel 1
will be sent directly to track 1. The track recording
indicator (DIR) for track 1 will blink.
Check the recording level
To insure the best audio quality for the recording,
it is important to set an appropriate recording
level. Always be sure to adjust the recording level
before you begin recording.
5 Press the REC button.
The REC indicator will blink, and the MD4S will
be in record-pause mode. The display will indicate
the number of the song to be recorded (001), and
if this is the first time you are recording the song,
the display will indicate “NEW REC.
6 Rotate the GAIN control of input channel 1
all the way to the LINE position.
7 Set the input channel 1 fader between the 7
and 8 marks.
8 While playing your audio source, watch the
track level meter and rotate the GAIN control
once again to adjust the recording level.
Ideally, the track level meter will indicate about –3
for the loudest sounds. If the recording level is too
high even when the GAIN control is rotated all the
way to the LINE position, lower the output level of
the audio source.
Note: Since new discs (or discs that have been
erased) are entirely blank, this step is not necessary.
Note: With normal recording operations, there will
be only one blank area. However if you move or
delete songs, multiple blank areas may be created.
(See “Editing functions” on page 73 for more
information.) If there is more than one blank area,
the time available for consecutive recording may
differ depending on the size of the blank area. (See
“MD4S songs and blank areas” on page 12 for more
information.)
Tip: If you press the DISPLAY button to set the
display time counter mode to REMAIN TIME, the
length of available recording time for each blank area
will be shown when you search to that blank area.
Song 1 Song 2 Blank area
Unrecorded area
Tip: If you press PEAK HOLD to turn on the Peak
Hold function, the level meter will hold the
maximum level that was reached. For details on the
PEAK HOLD button, refer to page 18.
28 Basic operation
—Owner’s Manual
Monitor the signal being recorded on
the track
9 Press the MONITOR SELECT CUE switch to
turn it on.
The MONITOR SELECT switches choose the sig-
nal source that will be monitored. When the CUE
switch is on, the signal from the CUE bus will be
sent to the PHONES jack and the MONITOR
OUT jacks, allowing you to monitor the sound
through headphones or monitor speakers.
0 Raise the CUE LEVEL control of input channel
1 to the 7–8 mark.
The CUE LEVEL controls of input channels 1–4
adjust the signal that is sent from tracks 1–4 to the
CUE bus (for tracks that are in record/record-
pause mode this will be the recording source, or
for tracks that are playing back this will be the
playback sound of the track).
A While listening to your headphones or moni-
tor speakers, adjust the MONITOR LEVEL
control to an appropriate volume.
B As desired, use the EQ controls to adjust the
tone.
Adjusting the EQ controls will affect the recording
level. When you finish adjusting the EQ controls,
use the GAIN control to re-adjust the recording
level as necessary.
Start recording
Begin recording
1
Make sure that the REC indicator is blinking.
If it is not blinking, press the REC button.
2 Press the PLAY button.
Recording will begin, and the track 1 track record
indicator and the REC indicator will change from
blinking to lit. Begin playing the audio source that
you wish to record first.
3 When you finish recording, press the STOP
button.
The transport will stop, and the track record indi-
cator of track 1 will change to blinking.
The display will indicate Writing TOC” for a
short time, and then the TOC EDIT indicator will
go dark, indicating that the TOC has been
updated automatically.
LRLR
5 / 6 7 / 8
STEREO
MONITOR LEVEL
CUE
STEREO
2TR IN
CUE MIX TO STEREO
MONITOR SELECT
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
REHE
PAUSE
OUT
SONG SEARCH
MARK SEARCHREPEAT
AUTO
PUNCH I/O
AB
DATA CURSOR
PHONES PUNCH I/O
PITCH
EJECT
ADJUST EDIT UTILITY
BUS
CH2
REC SELECT
CH3 CH4
PEAK HOLD DISPLAY
010
010
MIN MAX
MULTITRACK MD RECORDER
IN THRUOUT
MIDI
MIC/LINE INPUT
3
21
4 5678
LINE INPUT
AUX SEND
INSERT
I/O
INSERT
I/O
TRACK
DIRECT OUT
STEREO
OUT
2TR IN MONITOR
OUT
12
EXIT
ENTER
SET
MARK
1
1
4
4
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
3
3
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
2
2
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
423
TOC WRITE
REC PLAY STOP
IN
LAST REC SEARCH
CH1
1
1 5
2
3
6
4
Recording the first track (Direct Recording) 29
—Owner’s Manual
Listening to the first track
4
Press the LAST REC SEARCH [IN] button.
This will locate to the point at which the previous
recording was begun. (For details on the LAST
REC SEARCH buttons, refer to page 17.) If this
was the first recording, you will always return to
the “00:00.00” location.
5 Press the PLAY button.
If the input channel 1 FLIP switch is in the “MIC/
LINE ( )” position, the playback of track 1 can
be monitored (via the CUE bus) from the
PHONES jack or MONITOR OUT jacks.
If you decide to re-record this take, press the LAST
REC SEARCH [IN] button, and repeat steps 1–4.
If you wish to re-record just a portion of the track,
you can use punch-in/out. See “Punch-in/out on
page 52 for more information.
6 If you are satisfied with the recording on
track 1, press the REC SELECT switch.
The track 1 track record indicator (DIR) will go
dark.
Signal flow during track recording
Note: If you forget to press the REC SELECT switch,
track 1 will be erased when you record the next track.
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PA N
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
1
R
L
MONITOR
OUT
PHONES
CUE Bus
Track 1
Track 2
Track 3
Track 4
30 Basic operation
—Owner’s Manual
Overdubbing
Now that you have finished recording track 1, let’s record additional audio sources on other
tracks while listening to the playback of this track. The basic procedure is the same as in
“Recording the first track.
Select the track to record
1
Connect the audio source to MIC/LINE
INPUT jack 2.
2 Set the input channel 2 FLIP switch to the
MIC/LINE ( ) position.
At this time, leave the input channel 1 FLIP switch
in the MIC/LINE ( ) position.
3 Press REC SELECT button 2.
The track 2 track record indicator (DIR) will
blink, and track 2 will be ready to record.
4 Press the REC button to enter record-pause
mode.
5 While watching the track level meter, use the
GAIN control and fader of input channel 2 to
set the recording level.
LRLR
5 / 6 7 / 8
STEREO
MONITOR LEVEL
CUE
STEREO
2TR IN
CUE MIX TO STEREO
MONITOR SELECT
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TOC WRITE
REHE STOP
PAUSE
OUT
SONG SEARCH
MARK SEARCHREPEAT
AUTO
PUNCH I/O
AB
DATA CURSOR
PHONES PUNCH I/O
PITCH
EJECT
ADJUST EDIT UTILITY
CH1
BUS
REC SELECT
CH3 CH4
PEAK HOLD DISPLAY
010
010
MIN MAX
MULTITRACK MD RECORDER
IN THRUOUT
MIDI
MIC/LINE INPUT
3
1
4 5678
LINE INPUT
AUX SEND
INSERT
I/O
INSERT
I/O
TRACK
DIRECT OUT
STEREO
OUT
2TR IN MONITOR
OUT
12
EXIT
ENTER
SET
MARK
1
1
4
4
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
3
3
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
2
2
CUE
HIGH
LR
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
P
A
N
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
143
REC PLAY
IN
LAST REC SEARCH
CH2
2
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
GAIN
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
010
PB
L
E
V
E
L
2
2
6
4 7
9
85
1
30
Note: You must make sure that the track 1 record
indicator (DIR) is dark. If it is blinking, press REC
SELECT button 1.
Overdubbing 31
—Owner’s Manual
Simultaneously monitoring the
recording source and the track
playback
6
While playing the audio source that you wish
to record, raise the CUE LEVEL control of
input channel 2.
Use the CUE LEVEL control of input channel 2 to
adjust the monitor level of the signal that will be
recorded on track 2. While listening to the sound
in your headphones or monitor speakers, adjust
the monitor level as desired. If you begin record-
ing now, the playback sound from track 1 will be
mixed with the track 2 recording source, and can
be monitored via the CUE bus.
Start recording
7
Press the PLAY button to begin recording.
When you finish recording, press the STOP but-
ton.
Listen to the recording
8
Press the LAST REC SEARCH [IN] button to
move to the location where you began
recording track 2.
If you wish to start listening from the beginning of
the song, press the SONG SEARCH [ ] button.
9 Press the PLAY button to playback, and listen
to the recording.
0 If you are satisfied with the recording, press
the REC SELECT 2 button.
The track 2 track recording indicator (DIR) will
go dark.
Go ahead and record the remaining tracks 3 and 4
by overdubbing in the same way.
Signal flow during overdubbing
2
1
1
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PA N
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
2
2
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PA N
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
R
L
MONITOR
OUT
PHONES
CUE bus
Track 1
Track 2
Track 3
Track 4
32 Basic operation
—Owner’s Manual
Mixdown
When you have finished recording the four tracks, let’s mixdown the recorded tracks to stereo,
and record the mix on a master recorder.
Connecting a master recorder
1
Connect the STEREO OUT jacks of the MD4S
to the input jacks of your master recorder.
Connect the output jacks of your master
recorder to the 2TR IN jacks of the MD4S.
Adjust the mix balance of each track
2
Set the FLIP switches of input channels 1–4 to
the “PB ( )” position.
When the FLIP switches are set to the “PB ( )”
position, the playback sound of the corresponding
track will be sent to the input channel, allowing
you to use the EQ controls to adjust the tone, and
use the PAN control to set the stereo (left/right)
position. The signals of input channels 1–4 (the
track playback sound) will be mixed in stereo, and
output via the ST bus to the STEREO OUT jacks.
3 Turn on the MONITOR SELECT STEREO
switch.
The ST bus will be selected as the signal source for
monitoring. Now you can use headphones or
monitor speakers connected to the PHONES jack
or MONITOR OUT jacks to monitor the same
signal as is being output from the STEREO OUT
jacks.
4 Set the STEREO fader to the 7–8 mark.
5 Press the SONG SEARCH [ ] button to
locate to the beginning of the song (the start
point), and press the PLAY button to begin
playback.
LRLR
5 / 6 7 / 8
MONITOR LEVEL
CUE
STEREO
2TR IN
CUE MIX TO STEREO
MONITOR SELECT
REHE REC
PAUSE
IN OUT
LAST REC SEARCH
MARK SEARCHREPEAT
AUTO
PUNCH I/O
AB
DATA CURSOR
PHONES PUNCH I/O
PITCH
EJECT
ADJUST EDIT UTILITY
CH1
BUS
CH2
REC SELECT
CH3 CH4
PEAK HOLD DISPLAY
010
010
MIN MAX
MULTITRACK MD RECORDER
IN THRUOUT
MIDI
MIC/LINE INPUT
3
21
4 5678
LINE INPUT
AUX SEND
INSERT
I/O
INSERT
I/O
TRACK
DIRECT OUT
STEREO
OUT
2TR IN MONITOR
OUT
12
EXIT
ENTER
SET
MARK
1
1
4
4
GAIN
CUE
LINE MIC
LR
010
AUX
12
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
3
3
GAIN
CUE
LINE MIC
LR
010
AUX
12
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
2
2
GAIN
CUE
LINE MIC
LR
010
AUX
12
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
GAIN
CUE
LINE MIC
LR
010
AUX
12
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
1423
STEREO
STEREO
2TR IN
MONITOR SELECT
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TOC WRITE
PLAY STOP
SONG SEARCH
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
HIGH
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
HIGH
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
PB
HIGH
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
PB
HIGH
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
PB
RRR 42
L LL
2TR INAUX SENDAC IN
31
MIDI
OUT
STEREO
OUT
MONITOR
OUTPOWER
ON/ OFF
TRACK
DIRECT OUT
THRU IN
12
1
2
6
8
9
3
45
7
Mixdown 33
—Owner’s Manual
6 While listening through the headphones or
monitor speakers, use the faders, PAN con-
trols, and EQ controls of input channels 1–4
to adjust the mixdown.
First, use the PAN controls to set the left/right bal-
ance. Next, adjust the faders to set the volume bal-
ance of each track. At the ideal level, the +12 mark
of the stereo level meter should light occasionally.
Make fine adjustments to the STEREO fader as
necessary. Finally, use the EQ controls as desired
to adjust the tone, and re-adjust the volume levels
if necessary.
Record to your master recorder
When the mix balance is complete, you can record
the result to your master recorder.
7 Put your master recorder in record mode,
and playback the MD4S song from the
beginning.
8 When the mixdown is finished, stop the
MD4S and the master recorder.
Listen to the master recording
9
Press the MONITOR SELECT 2TR IN switch.
Now the playback of your master recorder that is
being sent to the 2TR IN jacks will be sent to the
PHONES jack and the MONITOR OUT jacks.
0 Playback your master recorder from the
beginning of the song and listen to the mas-
ter recording.
Use the MONITOR LEVEL control to adjust the
monitor level.
Signal flow during mixdown
STEREO
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
1
1
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PA N
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
2
2
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PA N
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
3
3
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PA N
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
4
4
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PA N
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
ST bus
R
L
MONITOR
OUT
R
L
STEREO
OUT
PHONES
Track 1
Track 2
Track 3
Track 4
34 Basic operation
—Owner’s Manual
After completing the Basic Operation section
In the preceding pages, you have learned the basic procedure for recording four parts, mixing
them in stereo, and mixing down to a master recorder. However by taking full advantage of
the functionality that the MD4S provides, you can use more sophisticated recording methods
and editing techniques. The following page, Advanced techniques on the MD4S, introduces
the wide variety of functionality provided by the MD4S. You can look through the list to find a
topic in which you are especially interested, and continue reading from the appropriate page.
Advanced recording techniques 35
—Owner’s Manual
Advanced recording techniques
In this chapter we will introduce more advanced topics, such as more sophisticated recording
techniques and editing techniques.
Advanced techniques on the MD4S
In addition to the functionality described on the preceding pages, the MD4S provides the
functionality listed below. These functions are actually the core capabilities of the MD4S, and
by taking full advantage of them, you will find that the expressive power of the MD4S will take
a dramatic leap. Please become familiar with these advanced techniques so that you can enjoy
the full potential of the MD4S.
• Record a greater number of parts
Mixing multiple channels as you record ..............page 36
Ping-pong recording..............................................page 39
Adding sounds during mixdown ..........................page 42
• Apply effects while you record/mixdown
Applying effects......................................................page 44
• Re-record over a mistake
Punch-in/out..........................................................page 52
• Jump immediately to a specific location in a song
Quick search functions..........................................page 61
• Playback a song repeatedly
• Program the playback order of the songs
Various playback functions....................................page 66
• Edit a song you recorded
Editing functions....................................................page 73
• Modify the pitch as you record/playback
Other functions......................................................page 84
• Record with a MIDI sequencer
• Control the MD4S from a MIDI sequencer
MIDI functions ......................................................page 90
36 Advanced recording techniques
—Owner’s Manual
Mixing multiple channels as you record
By combining multiple parts into a pair of tracks, you can record more than four parts on the
MD4S. For example if you have recorded drums, bass, and rhythm guitar, you can re-record
these three parts in stereo onto two tracks, and then record two other parts on the remaining
two tracks.
To do this, you will mix the signals of the input channels to the ST bus and record them on
either one or two tracks..
As an example, the following will explain how four audio sources connected to MIC/LINE
INPUT jacks 1–4 can be mixed in stereo and recorded onto tracks 1 and 2.
Drums
Guitar
Bass
MD4S
Stereo mix
Track 1
Track 2
Track 3
Track 4
Drums+Guitar+
Bass
TOC WRITETOC WRITE
5 / 6 7 / 8
MONITOR LEVEL
STEREO
2TR IN
CUE MIX TO STEREO
MONITOR SELECT
REHE REC PLAY STOP
PAUSE
OUT
SONG SEARCH
MARK SEARCHREPEAT
AUTO
PUNCH I/O
AB
DATA CURSOR
PHONES PUNCH I/O
PITCH
EJECT
ADJUST EDIT UTILITY
PEAK HOLD DISPLAY
010
010
MIN MAX
MULTITRACK MD RECORDER
IN THRUOUT
MIDI
5678
LINE INPUT
AUX SEND
INSERT
I/O
INSERT
I/O
TRACK
DIRECT OUT
STEREO
OUT
2TR IN MONITOR
OUT
12
EXIT
ENTER
SET
MARK
1
1
4
4
CUE
HIGH
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
AUX
12
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
3
CUE
HIGH
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
AUX
12
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
2
HIGH
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
AUX
12
HIGH
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
AUX
12
MIC/LINE INPUT
3
21
4
IN
STEREO
CUE
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
GAIN
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
PAN
LR
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
GAIN
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
PAN
LR
PB
GAIN
CUE
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
PAN
LR
PB
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
GAIN
CUE
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
PAN
LR
PB
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
LRLR
REC PLAY STOP
LAST REC SEARCH
CH1
BUS
CH2
REC SELECT
CH3 CH4
1 42 3
6
1
A
C
B4C
3
5
7
9
8
2
Mixing multiple channels as you record 37
—Owner’s Manual
1 Connect the audio sources to MIC/LINE
INPUT jacks 1–4.
If necessary, you can also mix line level devices
such as synthesizers connected to LINE INPUT
jacks 5 and 6 or 7 and 8.
2 Set the FLIP switch of input channels 1–4 to
“MIC/LINE ( ).”
3 While holding down the BUS button, press
REC SELECT buttons 1 and 2.
The track recording indicators for tracks 1 and 2
(BUS/L,R) will blink.
The signal of an input channel whose FLIP switch
is set to “MIC/LINE ( )” will be sent to the ST
bus. Also, if the REC SELECT button of a track is
pressed while holding down the BUS button, the
signal from the ST bus will be selected as the
recording source for that track. In this case, the L
channel signal of the ST bus will be assigned to
track 1, and the R channel signal of the ST bus will
be assigned to track 2.
4 Press the REC button.
The REC indicator will blink, and the MD4S will
be in record-pause mode.
5 Set the faders of input channels 1–4 and the
STEREO fader to the 7–8 mark.
6 Watch the track level meters, and use the
GAIN control and faders of input channels 1–
4 and the STEREO fader to adjust the record-
ing level. Use the PAN controls of input chan-
nels 1–4 to adjust the stereo position of each
audio source.
7 Turn on the MONITOR SELECT CUE switch.
The signal of the CUE bus will be sent to the
PHONES jack and the MONITOR OUT jacks.
Turn off the MONITOR SELECT STEREO switch.
8 Set the CUE LEVEL controls of input channels
1 and 2 to the 7–8 range.
This allows the recording source for tracks 1 and 2
(in this case, the signals from input channels 1–4)
be monitored in the CUE bus.
9 Rotate the CUE PAN controls of input chan-
nels 1 and 2 to far left and far right respec-
tively.
This makes the CUE bus signal stereo, and allows
you to monitor the same sound image as is being
recorded.
0 Listen to the headphones or monitor speak-
ers, and adjust the volume and pan of each
input channel. As necessary, use the EQ con-
trols to adjust the tone.
A Press the PLAY button to begin recording.
The track recording indicators (BUS) of tracks 1
and 2 will change to steadily lit.
B When you finish recording, press the STOP
button.
The TOC will be automatically updated, and the
track recording indicators (BUS) of tracks 1 and 2
will change to blinking.
C Press the LAST REC SEARCH [IN] button to
locate to the point at which recording began,
and press the PLAY button to hear the record-
ing.
If you are satisfied with the recording, press REC
SELECT buttons 1 and 2. The track recording
indicators (BUS/L,R) will go dark.
Tip: You may find it easiest to first adjust the GAIN
controls while you play each audio source separately,
then use the input channel faders to adjust the
volume balance, and finally use the STEREO fader to
adjust the overall recording level.
Note: In this situation, the CUE bus and the ST bus
have the same signal content. Be aware that if the
MONITOR SELECT CUE switch and the STEREO
switch are both on, the sound being monitored in the
PHONES jack or the MONITOR OUT jacks will
appear unnatural.
38 Advanced recording techniques
—Owner’s Manual
Signal flow when mixing multiple channels
21
1
1
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PA N
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
2
2
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PA N
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
3
3
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PA N
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
4
4
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PA N
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
STEREO
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
34
R
L
MONITOR
OUT
PHONES
CUE bus
ST bus
L
R
Track 1
Track 2
Track 3
Track 4
Ping-pong recording 39
—Owner’s Manual
Ping-pong recording
The process of mixing two or more previously-recorded tracks and re-recording them onto
one or two tracks is called ping-pong recording. By ping-ponging, you can free up other
tracks to record additional parts, so this is a useful technique when you wish to record a larger
number of parts than you have actual tracks. Since the MD4S records signals digitally, it is able
to playback a track while recording onto the same track. Thus, while a conventional cassette-
tape type MTR needs one or two vacant tracks in order to ping-pong, the MD4S allows you to
ping-pong even if there are no unused tracks.
The following diagram shows the process of mixing four recorded tracks into a stereo pair,
and continuing to overdub while ping-pong recording additional tracks.
Note: Since the MD4S records data in digital form, repeated ping-pong recording as shown
above will not impair the audio quality. However, please be aware that since the MD4S’s
mixer section is analog, repeated ping-pong recording will result in a very small decrease in
audio quality (although compared to the result of ping-pong recording on a tape MTR, this
loss will be virtually undetectable).
Tip: If you ping-pong record tracks 1–4 to tracks 3 and 4 as shown above, the content that
had been recorded on tracks 3 and 4 will be erased. Before you ping-pong record, we
recommend that you copy the song to backup the original. (See “Copying/converting a song
(Song Copy)” on page 76 for more information.)
MD4S
Track 1
Track 2
Track 3
Track 4
Track 1
Track 2
Track 3
Track 4
Stereo mix
Drums+Guitar+
Bass+Vocal
Drums
Guitar
Bass
Vocal
A
B
C
D
A (vacant)
B (vacant)
A+B+C+D
(STEREO)
E
F
A+B+C+D
(STEREO)
L
R
Overdubbing
(parts E and F)
Ping-pong
recording
Ping-pong
recording
Overdubbing
(parts G and H)
Mixdown
(parts A~H)
E (vacant)
F (vacant)
A+B+C+D
+E+F
(STEREO)
G
H
A+B+C+D
+E+F
(STEREO)
L
R
Track 1
Track 2
Track 3
Track 4
40 Advanced recording techniques
—Owner’s Manual
In the following, we will give an example of mixing previously-recorded tracks 1–4 into a ste-
reo pair, and ping-pong recording them to tracks 3 and 4.
1 Set the FLIP switches of input channels 1–4 to
“PB ( ).”
The playback sound of tracks 1–4 will be sent via
the input channels to the ST bus.
2 While holding down the BUS button, press
REC SELECT buttons 3 and 4.
The ST bus will be selected as the recording source
for tracks 3 and 4, and the track record indicators
(BUS/L, R) will blink.
Make sure that the track record indicators for
tracks 1 and 2 are dark.
3 Turn on the MONITOR SELECT STEREO
switch.
The ST bus will be selected as the signal source for
monitoring, allowing you to monitor the playback
sound of tracks 1–4.
Make sure that the MONITOR SELECT CUE
switch is off.
4 Set the STEREO fader in the 7–8 range.
5 Press the SONG SEARCH [ ] button to
locate to the beginning of the song.
6 Press the REHE button, and then press the
PLAY button to begin rehearsing the ping-
pong recording.
7 While listening to your monitoring head-
phones or monitor speakers, use the faders
and PAN controls of input channels 1–4 to
adjust the mix balance of tracks 1–4. As nec-
essary, use the EQ controls to adjust the tone.
When you finish adjusting the mix balance, watch
the track level meters of tracks 3 and 4 as you
adjust the STEREO fader to set the recording level.
(At the ideal level, the –3 segment of the meter will
light at the peaks.)
LR
5 / 6 7 / 8
MONITOR LEVEL
CUE
2TR IN
CUE MIX TO STEREO
MONITOR SELECT
REHE
PAUSE
OUT
MARK SEARCHREPEAT
AUTO
PUNCH I/O
AB
DATA CURSOR
PHONES PUNCH I/O
PITCH
EJECT
ADJUST EDIT UTILITY
CH1 CH2
REC SELECT
PEAK HOLD DISPLAY
010
010
MIN MAX
MULTITRACK MD RECORDER
IN THRUOUT
MIDI
MIC/LINE INPUT
3
21
4 5678
LINE INPUT
AUX SEND
INSERT
I/O
INSERT
I/O
TRACK
DIRECT OUT
STEREO
OUT
2TR IN MONITOR
OUT
12
EXIT
ENTER
SET
MARK
1
1
4
4
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
AUX
12
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
3
3
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
AUX
12
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
2
2
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
AUX
12
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
AUX
12
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
12
STEREO
SONG SEARCH
LR
STEREO
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TOC WRITE
REHE REC PLAY STOP
IN
LAST REC SEARCH
BUS
REC SELECT
CH3 CH4
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
PAN
LR
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
PAN
LR
PB
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
PAN
LR
PB
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
PAN
LR
PB
43
A
94
7
5
8
0
68
1
7
3
2
9
Tip: If you use LINE INPUT jacks 5–8, the audio
sources connected to LINE INPUT jacks 5–8 can be
added to tracks 1–4 as you ping-pong record. The
input level of LINE INPUT jacks 5–8 can be adjusted
by the LEVEL controls 5/6 and 7/8.
Ping-pong recording 41
—Owner’s Manual
8 When you have finished adjusting the mix
balance and recording level, press the SONG
SEARCH [ ] button to locate to the begin-
ning of the song, and then press the REC but-
ton and PLAY button to begin ping-pong
recording.
9 When ping-pong recording ends, press the
STOP button, and then press REC SELECT
buttons 3 and 4.
0 Set the faders of input channels 3 and 4 in
the 7–8 range, and rotate the PAN controls to
far left and far right respectively. Set all EQ
controls to the 12 o’clock position (flat).
At this time, lower the faders of input channels 1
and 2 to zero.
A Press the LAST REC SEARCH [IN] button to
locate to the point at which ping-pong
recording began, and while using the MONI-
TOR LEVEL control to adjust the monitor
level, listen to the recorded content of tracks
3 and 4.
Signal flow for ping-pong recording
STEREO
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
1
1
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PA N
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
2
2
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PA N
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
3
3
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PA N
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
4
4
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PA N
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
ST Bus
L
R
R
L
MONITOR
OUT
PHONES
Track 1
Track 2
Track 3
Track 4
42 Advanced recording techniques
—Owner’s Manual
Adding sounds during mixdown
The mixer section of the MD4S features an “in-line design that can simultaneously handle
both the input signal from the MIC/LINE INPUT jack and the playback sound from the disk.
For example, this allows you to add external input signals during mixdown. This is conve-
nient, for example, when you wish to layer some sound effects onto the introduction of a song
that you completed on the MD4S.
In the following, we will give an example of how audio sources connected to MIC/LINE
INPUT jacks 1 and 2 can be added during mixdown.
1 Make preparations for mixdown.
See “Mixdown on page 32, adjust the mix balance
of each track, and complete the steps up until you
are ready to mixdown (steps
16).
2 Connect your audio sources to MIC/LINE
INPUT jacks 1 and 2.
When the FLIP switch of the input channel is in
the “PB ( )” position, the tape playback sound
will be set to the ST bus, and the input signal from
the MIC/LINE INPUT jack will be sent via the
CUE PAN/LEVEL control to the CUE bus. In this
case, the input signals from MIC/LINE INPUT
jacks 1 and 2 will be sent via the CUE PAN/LEVEL
controls of input channels 1 and 2 to the CUE bus.
MD4S
Track 1
Track 2
Track 3
Track 4
Stereo mix
Drums
Guitar
Bass
Vocal
Master recorder
External audio source
LRLR
5 / 6 7 / 8
STEREO
MONITOR LEVEL
CUE
STEREO
2TR IN
MONITOR SELECT
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TOC WRITE
REHE REC STOP
PAUSE
IN OUT
SONG SEARCH
LAST REC SEARCH
MARK SEARCHREPEAT
AUTO
PUNCH I/O
AB
DATA CURSOR
PHONES PUNCH I/O
PITCH
EJECT
ADJUST EDIT UTILITY
CH1
BUS
CH2
REC SELECT
CH3 CH4
PEAK HOLD DISPLAY
010
010
MIN MAX
MULTITRACK MD RECORDER
IN THRUOUT
MIDI
MIC/LINE INPUT
34 5678
LINE INPUT
AUX SEND
INSERT
I/O
INSERT
I/O
TRACK
DIRECT OUT
STEREO
OUT
2TR IN MONITOR
OUT
12
EXIT
ENTER
SET
MARK
1
1
4
4
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
3
3
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
2
2
HIGH
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
HIGH
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
1423
CUE MIX TO STEREO
PLAY
21
GAIN
CUE
LINE MIC
LR
010
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
GAIN
CUE
LINE MIC
LR
010
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
3
5
2
6
4
Adding sounds during mixdown 43
—Owner’s Manual
3 Turn on the CUE MIX TO STEREO switch.
The cue mix function will be turned on, and the
CUE MIX indicator in the display will light. With
this setting, the signal of the CUE bus (the MIC/
LINE INPUT jack input signal) will be mixed into
the ST bus.
4 Set the CUE LEVEL controls of input channels
1 and 2 in the 7–8 range.
5 Press the PLAY button to begin playback.
If the MONITOR SELECT STEREO switch is on,
you will be able to hear the track playback in your
headphones or monitor speakers.
6 Play the audio sources that are connected to
MIC/LINE INPUT jacks 1 and 2, and use the
GAIN controls of input channels 1 and 2 to
adjust the input level.
Use the stereo level meter to check the input levels
together with the track playback sound. If the level
is too high even when the GAIN control is rotated
all the way to the LINE position, lower the CUE
LEVEL control. If necessary, you can use the CUE
PAN controls to adjust the stereo position. (If you
are adding a stereo source, set the CUE PAN con-
trols of input channels 1 and 2 to far left and far
right respectively.)
7 After you have adjusted the input signal levels
from MIC/LINE INPUT jacks 1 and 2, start
recording on your master recorder, and play-
back the MD4S from the beginning of the
song.
When recording is completed, playback the master
recorder to hear the recorded result.
Signal flow when adding external signals during mixdown
Tip: The input signals from LINE INPUT jacks 5–8
can be added to the mix during mixdown. However
since LINE INPUT jacks 5/6 and 7/8 are stereo pairs,
LINE INPUT jacks 5 and 7 will be mixed directly to
the L channel of the ST bus, and LINE INPUT jacks
6 and 8 will be mixed directly to the R channel of the
ST bus. If you wish to use microphones or to adjust
the pan, you should use the MIC/LINE INPUT jacks.
21
STEREO
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
1
1
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PA N
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
2
2
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PA N
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
3
3
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PA N
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
4
4
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PA N
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
CUE Bus
R
L
MONITOR
OUT
R
L
STEREO
OUT
PHONES
CUE MIX TO STEREO
ST Bus
Track 1
Track 2
Track 3
Track 4
44 Advanced recording techniques
—Owner’s Manual
Applying effects
Here we will explain how external effects can be applied as you record tracks or during mix-
down. If you wish to apply effects to the input signal of an input channel or to the playback
sound of a track, two methods are available: using the INSERT I/O jack or using the AUX
SEND jack.
Using the INSERT I/O jacks
Input channels 1 and 2 of the MD4S provide INSERT I/O jacks for inserting external effect
processors. By using these jacks, you can apply an effect only to a specific channel/track as you
record a track or while you mixdown. Normally, the technique of applying an effect via the
INSERT I/O jack is used for effects which affect the dynamics or tone of the original sound
(e.g., compressor, limiter, noise gate, equalizer etc.).
The INSERT I/O jacks accommodate TRS (tip, ring, sleeve) phone plugs. The signal of the
input channel is sent from the tip of the INSERT I/O jack to the external effect unit, and the
signal that has been processed by the external effect unit is sent via the ring of the INSERT I/O
jack back into the input channel.
INSERT I/O jacks
Effect processor
MD4S
Applying an effect to a specific track as you record
Bass Bass
Track 1
Track 2
Track 3
Track 4
Applying effects 45
—Owner’s Manual
Signal flow through the INSERT I/O jack and the insertion cable
In order to use the INSERT I/O jack to apply an external effect, you will a special insertion
cable as shown in the above diagram. Use the insertion cable to connect the external effect
processor as shown in the following diagram.
External effect connections when using an insertion cable
After making these connections, you can record tracks or perform a mixdown in the same way
as usual. When the FLIP switch is in the “MIC/LINE ( )” position, the effect will be applied
to the input signal from MIC/LINE INPUT jack 1 or 2. When the FLIP switch is in the “PB
( )” position, the effect will be applied to the playback sound of track 1 or 2.
HIGH
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
INSERT
I/O
Sleeve Tip
SleeveRingTip
Input jack of the external effect processor
Output jack of the external effect processor
INSERT I/O
jack
5 / 6 7 / 8
2TR IN
CUE MIX TO STEREO
MONITOR SELECT
PITCH
EJECT
ADJUST EDIT UTILITY
CH1
BUS
CH2
REC SELECT
CH3 CH4
LRLR
PEAK HOLD DISPLAY
010010
MULTITRACK MD RECORDER
IN THRUOUT
MIDI
MIC/LINE INPUT
3
21
4 5678
LINE INPUT
AUX SEND
INSERT
I/O
INSERT
I/O
TRACK
DIRECT OUT
STEREO
OUT
2TR IN MONITOR
OUT
12
1234
1
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
PB
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
2
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
PB
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
3
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
PB
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
4
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
PB
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
External effect processor
Insertion cable
Output jackInput jack
46 Advanced recording techniques
—Owner’s Manual
Using the AUX SEND jacks
When the AUX SEND jacks of the MD4S are used, a single external effect processor can be used
simultaneously by two or more input channels. For example when you are re-recording several
channels to two tracks or when mixing down, you can use this method to apply an effect such as
delay or reverb while adjusting the depth of the effect independently for each channel (track).
When using the AUX SEND jacks to connect an external effect processor, connect the AUX
SEND jacks 1 or 2 to the input jacks of the external effect processor, and connect the output
jacks of the effect processor to LINE INPUT jacks 5 and 6 or 7 and 8.
External effect connections when using the AUX SEND jacks
With this setup, rotating the AUX controls of the input channels toward the 1 or 2 position
will mix the signals from the input channels (in mono) and send them via the AUX SEND 1 or
2 jack to the external effect processor. The output signals from the effect processor will be
mixed via the LINE INPUT jacks 5 and 6 (or 7 and 8) into the ST bus. Normally, the technique
of using the AUX SEND jacks to apply effects is used for effects in which the original sound is
mixed with the processed sound (e.g., delay, reverb, chorus etc.). In general, you should make
settings on the effect processor so that it will output only the processed sound, and use the
MD4S mixer to adjust the mix of the original sound (the signal sent from the input channel to
the ST bus) and the effect sound (the signal sent via LINE INPUT jacks 5–8 to the ST bus).
MD4S
AUX SEND jacks
Track 1
Track 2
Track 3
Track 4
Stereo mix
Drums
Guitar
Bass
Vocal
Master recorder
Effect processor
Applying an effect with a different depth for each track as you mixdown
5 / 6 7 / 8
2TR IN
CUE MIX TO STEREO
MONITOR SELECT
PITCH
EJECT
ADJUST EDIT UTILITY
CH1
BUS
CH2
REC SELECT
CH3 CH4
LRLR
PEAK HOLD DISPLAY
010010
MULTITRACK MD RECORDER
IN THRUOUT
MIDI
MIC/LINE INPUT
3
21
4 5678
LINE INPUT
AUX SEND
INSERT
I/O
INSERT
I/O
TRACK
DIRECT OUT
STEREO
OUT
2TR IN MONITOR
OUT
12
1234
1
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
PB
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
2
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
PB
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
3
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
PB
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
4
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
PB
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
Output jack L RROutput jack LInput jack Input jack
Effect processor 1 Effect processor 2
Applying effects 47
—Owner’s Manual
Applying effects during mixdown
Applying an effect such as reverb to each track during a mixdown is an example of a situation
in which you would connect the external effect processor to the AUX SEND jack. In this case,
you can use the AUX control of each input channel to adjust the effect depth for each track.
1 Connect the AUX SEND 1 jack to the input
jack of your effect processor, and connect the
output jacks of the effect processor to LINE
INPUT jacks 5 and 6. Make settings on the
effect processor so that its output jacks will
output only the effect sound.
2 Prepare for mixdown.
As described in “Mixdown (page 32), adjust the
mix balance of each track, and perform the steps
leading up to mixdown (steps
16).
3 Press the PLAY button to playback the song,
and for each input channel to which you wish
to apply the effect, rotate the AUX control
toward the “1” position.
The signals from input channels 1–4 (the playback
of tracks 1–4) will be sent to the external effect
processor connected to the AUX SEND 1 jack.
Adjust the input level of the effect processor if nec-
essary.
4 Raise level control 5/6.
The effect sound processed by the external effect
processor will be mixed into the ST bus. Raising
the level control will increase the overall effect.
5 When you are finished adjusting the effect
depth, press the SONG SEARCH [ ] button
to locate to the beginning of the song, and
begin the mixdown.
LRLR
7 / 8
STEREO
MONITOR LEVEL
CUE
STEREO
2TR IN
CUE MIX TO STEREO
MONITOR SELECT
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TOC WRITE
REHE REC STOP
PAUSE
IN OUT
LAST REC SEARCH
MARK SEARCHREPEAT
AUTO
PUNCH I/O
AB
DATA CURSOR
PHONES PUNCH I/O
PITCH
EJECT
ADJUST EDIT UTILITY
CH1
BUS
CH2
REC SELECT
CH3 CH4
PEAK HOLD DISPLAY
010
MIN MAX
MULTITRACK MD RECORDER
IN THRUOUT
MIDI
MIC/LINE INPUT
3
21
478
LINE INPUT
INSERT
I/O
INSERT
I/O
TRACK
DIRECT OUT
STEREO
OUT
2TR IN MONITOR
OUT
2
EXIT
ENTER
SET
MARK
1
1
4
4
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
3
3
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
2
2
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
1423
5 / 6
PLAY
SONG SEARCH
010
56
LINE INPUT
AUX SEND
1
AUX
12
AUX
12
AUX
12
AUX
12
1
3
4
5
48 Advanced recording techniques
—Owner’s Manual
Applying an effect during ping-pong recording
By using the AUX SEND jacks you can apply spatial-type effects such as reverb or chorus dur-
ing ping-pong recording as well. This technique is particularly useful when you wish to ping-
pong in stereo down to two tracks. The following will explain how to apply an effect to the
playback of tracks 1–4 as you ping-pong them in stereo to tracks 3 and 4.
1 Connect the AUX SEND 1 jack to the input
jack of your external effect processor, and
connect the output jacks of the effect proces-
sor to the LINE INPUT jacks 5 and 6. Make
settings on your effect processor so that only
the processed sound is output.
2 Hold down the BUS button, and press REC
SELECT buttons 3 and 4.
The track record indicators (BUS/L, R) will blink.
Make sure that the track record indicators for
tracks 1 and 2 are dark.
3 Turn on the MONITOR SELECT STEREO
switch.
Make sure that the MONITOR SELECT CUE
switch is off.
4 Set the STEREO fader in the 7–8 range.
5 Press the REHE button.
6 Press the SONG SEARCH [ ] button to
locate to the beginning of the song, and
press the PLAY button to begin rehearsal.
7 While listening to your monitor headphones
or monitor speakers, use the input channel
1–4 faders and PAN controls to adjust the mix
balance of tracks 1–4. If necessary, use the EQ
controls to adjust the tone.
When you have finished adjusting the mix bal-
ance, watch the track 3 and 4 track level meters as
you make fine adjustments to the STEREO fader
to set the recording level. (At the ideal level, the –3
segment will light when peaks occur.)
1
2
LR
7 / 8
MONITOR LEVEL
CUE
2TR IN
CUE MIX TO STEREO
MONITOR SELECT
TOC WRITE
STOP
PAUSE
IN OUT
LAST REC SEARCH
MARK SEARCHREPEAT
AUTO
PUNCH I/O
AB
DATA CURSOR
PHONES PUNCH I/O
PITCH
EJECT
ADJUST EDIT UTILITY
CH1 CH2
PEAK HOLD DISPLAY
010
MIN MAX
MULTITRACK MD RECORDER
IN THRUOUT
MIDI
MIC/LINE INPUT
3
21
478
LINE INPUT
INSERT
I/O
INSERT
I/O
TRACK
DIRECT OUT
STEREO
OUT
2TR IN MONITOR
OUT
2
EXIT
ENTER
SET
MARK
1 4
4
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PB
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
3
3
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
PB
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
2
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
PB
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PB
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
12
STEREO
LR
5 / 6
STEREO
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
REHE REC PLAY
SONG SEARCH
BUS
REC SELECT
CH3 CH4
010
56
LINE INPUT
AUX SEND
1
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PAN
LR
AUX
12
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PAN
LR
AUX
12
43
3
6
0
2
7
8
9
54
7
1
Applying effects 49
—Owner’s Manual
8 On the input channels to which you wish to
apply the effect, rotate the AUX control
toward the “1” position.
The signals from the input channels will be mixed
in monaural according to the position of each
AUX control, and will be sent via the AUX SEND 1
jack to the external effect processor.
9 Raise level control 5/6.
The effect sound from the external effect proces-
sor will be sent via LINE INPUT jacks 5 and 6 and
mixed into the ST bus.
0 When you have finished adjusting the mix
balance, recording level, and effect amount,
press the SONG SEARCH [ ] button to
locate to the beginning of the song, and then
press the REC button and PLAY button to
start ping-pong recording.
50 Advanced recording techniques
—Owner’s Manual
Applying an effect only to the monitor signal
By making skillful use of direct recording and the MONITOR SELECT switches, you can
apply effects only to the monitor signal so that tracks are recorded without effects. For exam-
ple when recording vocals, you can let the vocalist monitor their voice with reverb, but record
the vocal on the track without effects. The following will explain the example of monitoring
tracks 1–3 while you record a vocal on track 4.
1 Connect the AUX SEND 1 jack to the input
jack of your external effect processor, and
connect the output jacks of the effect proces-
sor to the LINE input jacks 5 and 6. Make set-
tings on your effect processor so that it will
output only the processed sound.
2 Connect the vocal mic to MIC/LINE INPUT
jack 4.
3 Set the FLIP switch of input channels 1–4 to
“MIC/LINE ( ).”
4 Press REC SELECT button 4.
The track record indicator (DIR 4) will blink, and
the vocal will be recorded directly to track 4. Make
sure that the other track record indicators are
dark.
5 Raise the CUE LEVEL controls of input chan-
nels 1–4.
The recording source of track 4 (vocal without the
effect) and the playback of tracks 1–3 can now be
monitored via the CUE bus.
6 Rotate the AUX control of input channel 4
toward the “1” position.
The vocal signal will be sent to the effect processor
connected to the AUX SEND 1 jack.
7 Raise level control 5/6.
Only the vocal effect sound will be sent to the ST
bus.
8 Turn on the MONITOR SELECT CUE switch
and MONITOR SELECT STEREO switch.
With these settings, the signal of the CUE bus (the
playback of tracks 1–3 and the unprocessed vocal)
and the signal of the ST bus (vocal effect sound)
can be monitored together.
LRL
7 / 8
STEREO
MONITOR LEVEL
2TR IN
CUE MIX TO STEREO
MONITOR SELECT
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TOC WRITE
REHE REC PLAY STOP
PAUSE
IN OUT
SONG SEARCH
LAST REC SEARCH
MARK SEARCHREPEAT
AUTO
PUNCH I/O
AB
DATA CURSOR
PHONES PUNCH I/O
PITCH
EJECT
ADJUST EDIT UTILITY
CH1
BUS
CH2
REC SELECT
CH3
PEAK HOLD DISPLAY
010
MIN MAX
MULTITRACK MD RECORDER
IN THRUOUT
MIDI
MIC/LINE INPUT
3
21
78
LINE INPUT
INSERT
I/O
INSERT
I/O
TRACK
DIRECT OUT
STEREO
OUT
2TR IN MONITOR
OUT
2
EXIT
ENTER
SET
MARK
1
1
4
4
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE MIC
LR
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
3
3
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE MIC
LR
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
2
2
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE MIC
LR
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE MIC
LR
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
123
R
5 / 6
CUE
STEREO
CH4
010
456
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
010
AUX
12
PB
L
E
V
E
L
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
010
PB
L
E
V
E
L
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
010
PB
L
E
V
E
L
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
010
PB
L
E
V
E
L
4
3
4
8
5
6
7
21
Applying effects 51
—Owner’s Manual
Signal flow when applying an effect only to the monitor signal
1
1
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PA N
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
2
2
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PA N
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
3
3
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PA N
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
4
4
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PA N
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
STEREO
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
5 / 6
010
54 6
R
L
MONITOR
OUT
PHONES
From the external
effect processor
To the external
effect processor
CUE Bus
ST Bus
Track 1
Track 2
Track 3
Track 4
52 Advanced recording techniques
—Owner’s Manual
Punch-in/out
This section explains techniques using punch-in/out. Punch-in/out is a function that allows
you to re-record just a specific portion of a previously-recorded track. While listening to the
playback of a track, you can begin recording (punch-in) at the desired location, play the por-
tion that you wish to re-record, and then stop recording (punch-out), thus re-recording only
the portion where a mistake occurred.
The MD4S allows you to use a variety of punch-in/out techniques. You can use manual
punch-in/out” by pressing the REC button or REC SELECT buttons or an optional FC5 foot
switch. Alternatively, you can use auto punch-in/out” that will automatically perform the
operation at the previously-specified locations. You can also use the rehearsal function to
practice the punch-in/out for any of these techniques.
Manual punch-in/out
Here’s how to use the MD4S’s REC button and REC SELECT buttons (or an optional FC5 foot
switch) to perform manual punch-in/out.
Punch-in/out using the REC button
1. Connect the audio source to the MD4S.
2. Set the FLIP switches of input channels 1–4 to “MIC/LINE ( ).”
3. Turn on the MONITOR SELECT CUE switch.
When performing punch-in/out, you will need to monitor the track playback up to the point
where you punch-in, and monitor the recording source after punch-in. For this reason when
you use punch-in/out, you must always turn on the MONITOR SELECT CUE switch to mon-
itor the CUE bus. Also, you should turn off the MONITOR SELECT STEREO switch.
4. Locate to a point slightly earlier than where you wish to punch-in.
By operating the CURSOR shuttle during playback, you can cue (play forward) or review
(play backward) at a variety of speeds. (See “Shuttle playback functions on page 66.) For other
locate methods, refer to “Other functions on page 84.
5. Press one of the REC SELECT buttons (or the BUS button + one of the REC
SELECT buttons) to select the track on which you wish to record.
The track record indicator for the selected track will blink.
6. Press the REC button and adjust the recording level.
The REC indicator will blink, and the MD4S will be in record-pause mode.

Punch-in Punch-out
Wrong notes
Re-record

Punch-in/out 53
—Owner’s Manual
7. When you have finished adjusting the recording level, press the STOP button
to temporarily cancel record-pause mode.
8. Press the PLAY button to begin playback.
9. At the location where you wish to punch-in, press the REC button.
The REC indicator will light, and from this point recording will begin for the track that was
selected by the REC SELECT buttons. At this time, the monitor signal of the track that was
selected for recording will change from the track playback to the recording source.
10. At the point where you wish to punch-out, press the PLAY button.
The REC indicator will go dark, recording will end, and normal playback will resume. The
monitor signal of the track selected for recording will return to the track playback.
Punch-in/out using REC SELECT
1. Make preparations for manual punch-in/out.
Use steps 1–6 of “Punch-in/out using the REC button on page 52 to prepare for manual
punch-in/out.
2. For the recording track that you selected in step 1, press the REC SELECT but-
ton once again so that all track record indicators are dark.
3. Press the PLAY button.
With the REC indicator still blinking, the track will playback. Recording will not occur at this
time because the recording track is not selected.
4. When you arrive at the location where you wish to punch-in, press the REC
SELECT button for the track that you wish to record. (Alternatively, you can
hold down the BUS button and press the REC SELECT button.)
The REC indicator will change to be steadily lit, and recording will begin on the track selected
by the REC SELECT buttons.
Tip: By pressing the REHE button instead of the REC button, you can rehearse the punch-
in/out. In this case, the monitor signal of the track that was selected for recording will change
from the track playback to the recording source, but the recording source will not actually be
recorded on the track. This is convenient when you wish to practice the timing at which you
punch-in/out, or to check the volume difference between the track playback and the
recording source.
Punch-in point
3
4
2
1
Playback
REC
SELECT
PlaybackRecord
Punch-out point
REC
TOC WRITE
STOP
PLAY
PLAY
PLAY
PLAY
54 Advanced recording techniques
—Owner’s Manual
5. When you arrive at the location where you wish to punch-out, press the REC
SELECT button once again.
The track record indicator will go dark, recording will end, and playback will resume.
Punch-in/out using a foot switch
If you connect a separately sold FC5 foot switch to the PUNCH I/O jack located on the front
panel of the MD4S, you can punch-in/out using the foot switch. This method is convenient
when the same person is both playing an instrument and operating the MD4S to punch-in/
out.
Foot switch connections
1. Make preparations for manual punch-in/out.
Follow steps 1–6 of “Punch-in/out using the REC button on page 52 to prepare for manual
punch-in/out.
2. Press the foot switch.
The REC indicator will continue blinking, and track playback will begin.
3. Press the foot switch at the location where you wish to punch-in.
The REC indicator and the track record indicator will change to steadily lit, and recording will
begin on the track selected by the REC SELECT button.
4. Press the foot switch at the location where you wish to punch-out.
The REC indicator will go dark. Recording will end and normal playback will resume.
5. Press the foot switch once again to enter pause mode.
Press the STOP button to stop.
Note: The PLAY button is not used when using a foot switch to punch-in/out. Be aware that
if you inadvertently press the PLAY button from record-pause mode, recording will begin
immediately.
Punch-in point
3
4
2
1
Playback
(record-ready)
Record-pause
REC
SELECT
PlaybackRecord
Punch-out point
REC SELECT
REC
TOC WRITE
STOP
PLAY
PLAY
PLAY
PLAY
CH3
L
3
Foot switch
Punch-in/out 55
—Owner’s Manual
Auto punch-in/out
Here we will explain how to use the auto punch-in/out function, which performs the punch-
in and punch-out operations automatically. This function allows you to repeatedly perform
punch-in/out with single-frame accuracy (11.6 ms).
Specify the auto punch-in/out points
Before you begin auto punch-in/out, you must set the “auto punch-in point at which punch-
in will occur, and the “auto punch-out point at which punch-out will occur. The locations at
which recording/rehearsal was last started (last record in point) and ended (last record out
point) will be used as the auto punch-in/out points.
1. At the location where you wish to auto punch-in, hold down the SET button
and press the LAST REC SEARCH [IN] button.
The display will indicate “MARK IN, and this location will be specified as the auto punch-in
point.
2. At the location where you wish to auto punch-out, hold down the SET button
and press the LAST REC SEARCH [OUT] button.
The display will indicate “MARK OUT, and this location will be specified as the auto punch-
out point.
Setting the pre-roll/post-roll times
“Pre-roll time is the length of playback that will occur immediately before the punch-in
point. “Post-roll time is the length of playback that will occur immediately after the punch-
out point. On the MD4S, the pre-roll and post-roll times are each set to 5 seconds, but you can
modify this if desired. The location at which the pre-roll starts is called the “pre-roll point,
and the location at which the post-roll ends is called the “post-roll point.
Note: It is not possible to perform auto punch-in/out if the auto punch-out point is earlier
than the auto punch-in point.
Note: When the MD4S is turned off, the auto punch-in/out points you set will be lost.
Tip: Auto punch-in/out points can be adjusted in steps of a single frame (11.6 ms). (See
“Adjusting the location of a marker or auto punch-in/out point” on page 63 for more
information.)
Punch-in point
3
4
2
1
Playback
REC
SELECT
PlaybackRecord
Punch-out point
Pause
Record-pause
REC
TOC WRITE
STOP
56 Advanced recording techniques
—Owner’s Manual
1. Press the UTILITY button.
2. Rotate the DATA dial until the display indicates PrePostRoll, and press the
ENTER button.
3. With the display showing Pre Xsec (X will be a number of 09), rotate the
DATA dial to set a pre-roll length of 09 seconds.
4. After you have made the pre-roll setting, press the ENTER button.
5. Rotate the DATA dial until the display indicates Post Xsec (X will be a num-
ber of 09), and rotate the DATA dial to set a post-roll length of 09 seconds.
6. After you have made the post-roll setting, press the ENTER button.
7. Press the UTILITY button once again to return to normal operation.
Single-take auto punch-in/out
There are two types of auto punch-in/out: “single-take in which auto punch-in/out is per-
formed only once, and mult-take in which punch-in/out can be performed two or more
times, after which you can select the best take. Here we will explain the procedure for single-
take auto punch-in/out.
1. Connect the audio source to the MD4S, and press the REC SELECT button (or
the BUS button + REC SELECT button) to select the track that you wish to
record.
2. Set the auto punch-in/out points.
See “Specify the auto punch-in/out points on page 55 for more information.
3. Press the AUTO PUNCH I/O button.
The display will indicate “SINGLE TAKE.
4. Press the ENTER button.
The AUTO PUNCH SINGLE indicator in the display will light, indicating that single-take
auto punch-in/out has been selected.
The display will also indicate A.Punch Rehe, and the MD4S will be in auto punch-in/out
rehearsal-pause mode.
Note: Pre-roll/post-roll time settings are remembered even if the MD4S is turned off.
Pre-roll point
Punch-in
point
Punch-out
poin
Pre-roll time Post-roll time
Post-roll point
OUTIN
Punch-in/out 57
—Owner’s Manual
Rehearsing the auto punch-in/out (single-take)
5. Press the PLAY button, and begin rehearsing the auto punch-in/out.
When you press the PLAY button, the MD4S will automatically locate to the pre-roll point,
and will start playback. When the auto punch-in point is reached, the IN indicator in the dis-
play will disappear, and the monitor signal will switch from the track playback to the record-
ing source. When the auto punch-out point is reached the OUT indicator in the display will
go dark, and the monitor signal will revert to the track playback. (In rehearsal mode, record-
ing will not actually take place during this time.) After the auto-punch out point is passed and
the post-roll is reached, the MD4S will automatically locate to the pre-roll point, and again
enter auto punch-in/out rehearsal-pause mode.
Actually performing the auto punch-in/out (single-take)
6. When stopped or paused, press the REC button.
The REC indicator will blink, the display will indicate A.Pnch, and the MD4S will be in auto
punch-in/out record-pause mode.
7. Press the PLAY button to begin the actual auto punch-in/out.
When you press the PLAY button, the MD4S will automatically locate to the pre-roll point,
and begin playback. When you reach the auto punch-in point, the IN indicator of the display
will go dark, and the track selected by the REC SELECT buttons will begin recording (punch-
in). When you reach the auto punch-out point, the OUT indicator of the display will go dark,
recording will end, and playback will resume (punch-out). When the post-roll point is
reached, auto punch-in/out will automatically be defeated, and the MD4S will locate to the
pre-roll point and automatically enter playback-pause mode.
8. Press the PLAY button to hear the recorded result.
Tip: When the display shows “A.Punch Rehe,” you can begin rehearsing the auto punch-in/
out simply by pressing the PLAY button. (It is not necessary to press the REHE button.)
Tip: If you press the REPEAT button while rehearsing auto punch-in/out, the auto punch-
in/out rehearsal will repeat automatically.
Note: In the case of single-take auto punch-in/out, auto punch-in/out will automatically be
canceled when you perform the actual punch-in/out. If you wish to perform auto punch-in/
out once again, you must repeat the procedure from step 1.
Tip: If an optional FC5 foot switch is connected to the PUNCH I/O jack, you can use the
foot switch to perform steps 4 and 6.
58 Advanced recording techniques
—Owner’s Manual
Multi-take auto punch-in/out
Multi-take auto punch-in/out allows you to perform auto punch-in/out recording two or
more times, then to audition all takes (including the original) and select the best take. Multi-
take auto punch-in/out allows you to record up to 99 takes, as long as blank area remains.
1. Connect an audio source to the MD4S, and press a REC SELECT button (or
the BUS button + REC SELECT button) to select the track that you wish to
record.
2. Set the auto punch-in/out points.
See “Specify the auto punch-in/out points on page 55 for more information.
3. Press the AUTO PUNCH I/O button.
The display will indicate “SINGLE TAKE.
4. Rotate the DATA dial to make the display read MULTI TAKE.
5. Press the ENTER button.
The display will indicate “TAKE 1 Load” for a short time. Then the AUTO PUNCH MULTI
indicator will light, indicating that multi-take auto punch-in/out has been selected. The dis-
play will indicate “TAKE 1 Rehe, and the MD4S will be in auto punch-in/out rehearsal-pause
mode.
Rehearsing the auto punch-in/out (multi-take)
6. Press the PLAY button to begin rehearsing the auto punch-in/out.
In the same way as in single-take auto punch-in/out, the monitor signal of the track selected
for recording will switch from the track playback to the recording source between the auto
punch-in/out points. Recording will not actually occur.
Tip: While rehearsing the auto punch-in/out, you can press the REPEAT button to
automatically repeat the rehearsal.
Pre-roll point
Punch-in point
Punch-out point
Post-roll point
Playback
(rehearsal-ready)
Rehearsal Playback
OUTIN OUT
AUTO
PUNCH I/O
ENTER
PLAY
PLAY
Playback
(record-ready) Record Playback
PLAY
PLAY
REC
SINGLE TAKE
3
4
2
1
REC
SELECT
Punch-in/out 59
—Owner’s Manual
Actually performing the auto punch-in/out (multi-take)
7. From a stopped or paused condition, press the REC button.
The REC indicator will blink, and the display will indicate “TAKE 1. Auto punch-in/out will
be in record-pause mode, ready to record the first take (take 1).
8. Press the PLAY button to begin the actual auto punch-in/out.
When you reach the post-roll point, the MD4S will automatically stop, and the display will
indicate “NEXT TAKE.
Recording the next take
9. With NEXT TAKE shown in the display, press the ENTER button.
The display will briefly indicate “TAKE 2 Load. Then the display will change to “TAKE 2, and
the MD4S will be in record-pause mode for take 2 of the auto punch-in/out.
10. Press the PLAY button to begin auto punch-in/out.
When you reach the post-roll point, the MD4S will automatically stop, and the display will
indicate “NEXT TAKE. If you wish to record another take, press the ENTER button to enter
record-pause mode for the next take. If you wish to listen to the takes that you have recorded,
advance to the following procedure with “NEXT TAKE” still displayed.
Auditioning each take
11. When you have nished recording auto punch-in/out takes and the display
indicates NEXT TAKE, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read MONI
TAKE.
12. Press the ENTER button.
The display will indicate “TAKE X:MONI” (X will be the take number).
13. Rotate the DATA dial to select the take that you wish to hear, and press the
ENTER button to playback the selected take.
When you reach the post-roll point (or press the STOP button), the MD4S will stop, and you
will again be able to select a take.
If you press the EXIT button when the display reads TAKE X:MONI, you will return to the
“NEXT TAKE” display.
Selecting the best take
14. When the display reads TAKE X:MONI, rotate the DATA dial to select the
best take.
The “TAKE X display will blink.
15. Rotate the CURSOR shuttle toward the right to make the MONI display
blink.
Note: Takes 2 and following will always begin with the actual auto punch-in/out. If you wish
to rehearse, you must press the REHE button.
Tip: To audition the original, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read
“ORIGIN:MONI.”
60 Advanced recording techniques
—Owner’s Manual
16. Rotate the CURSOR shuttle toward the right to make the display read
TAKE X:FIX.
17. Press the ENTER button.
The display will ask “FIX TAKE X?” If at this time you press the EXIT button, you will again
return to the step of selecting a take.
18. Press the ENTER button once again to nalize the take.
When you finalize the take, the display will indicate TAKE X FIX” for a short time. Then you
will exit auto punch-in/out and return to normal operation.
Quick search functions 61
—Owner’s Manual
Quick search functions
This section explains the variety of Locate functions that are provided by the MD4S. Methods
of adjusting the auto punch-in/out points and ways to set Markers will also be explained here.
Searching for songs
If the disc contains two or more songs, you can use the SONG SEARCH [ ]/[ ] buttons
to locate songs. The SONG SEARCH [ ] button locates the previous song, and the SONG
SEARCH [ ] button locates the next song. The MD4S will pause at the beginning of the
selected song.
If you press the SONG SEARCH [ ] button while stopped during a song, the MD4S will
locate to the beginning of the song and then pause. If you press the SONG SEARCH [ ]
button while a song is playing, the MD4S will locate to the beginning of the song and then
immediately begin playback.
Locating to a specied time
By using the DATA dial and CURSOR shuttle to input a minute/second/frame location, you
can locate to a desired location of the disc. If a tempo map (page 111) has been programmed,
you can input and locate to a measure/beat/clock location.
1. Press the STOP or PAUSE button to stop or playback-pause the MD4S.
It is not possible to locate to a specified time during playback or recording.
2. Press the DISPLAY button to switch the time counter mode.
If you wish to locate to a point within the current song, select ELAPSE TIME (or REMAIN
TIME). If you wish to locate to a point within the entire disc, select TOTAL TIME. If a tempo
map has been programmed for the current song, you can switch the time counter to the mea-
sure/beat/clock display.
3. Use the CURSOR shuttle and the DATA dial to specify the desired locate position.
By moving the CURSOR shuttle to various angles left or right you can play forward or back-
ward at a variety of speeds, which provides a convenient way to reach the approximate loca-
tion you desire. As you rotate the DATA dial to left or right, you will move backward or
forward in steps of one frame for each click of the dial, allowing you to specify the desired
location more precisely.
Note: If you press the SONG SEARCH [ ] button when the last song is selected, the
MD4S will search for a blank area. (See page 12 for more information.)
Note: The SONG SEARCH buttons cannot be used during recording.
Current location
Song 1
Song 2 Song 3 Song 4
62 Advanced recording techniques
—Owner’s Manual
4. When you have specied the desired location, press the ENTER button.
The MD4S will locate to the specified location, and will enter playback-pause mode. If you
press the PLAY button instead of the ENTER button, playback will begin from the specified
location.
Locating to the Last Record In/Out Point
When you record or rehearse, the starting location and ending location will automatically be
remembered as the “last record in point” and the “last record out point. When these points
have been set, the IN/OUT indicators in the display will light.
If the last record in/out points have been set, you can use the LAST REC SEARCH [IN] button
to locate to the “last record in point, or the LAST REC SEARCH [OUT] button to locate to
the “last record out point. The MD4S will then enter playback-pause mode. When you locate
to the last record in or out point, the respective IN/OUT indicator will begin blinking. The
LAST REC SEARCH [IN] button provides a convenient way to check the result of the last
recording.
The last record in/out points are also used as the auto punch-in/out points and to specify the
range of various editing functions. These points can be adjusted in steps of a single frame
(11.6 ms). (For details refer to page 63.)
Searching for Markers
The MD4S lets you place up to ten markers in each song. You can use the MARK SEARCH
[ ][ ] button to locate immediately to markers that you inserted. Markers are especially
convenient when you need to repeatedly jump to specific points in a song. The location of a
marker you insert can be adjusted later in steps of a single frame.
Inserting a marker in a song
1. At the location where you wish to insert a marker, press the MARK button.
Markers can be inserted when the MD4S is playing back, recording, paused, or stopped. When
you press the MARK button, the display will indicate “MARK X” (X will be the marker num-
ber that was inserted) for a brief time, indicating that a marker has been inserted at that loca-
tion. Markers are numbered sequentially, starting from the beginning of the song. If a new
marker is inserted between two existing markers, the marker numbers will be exchanged.
Note: The last record in/out points will be lost when the MD4S is turned off.
Start marker Marker 1 Marker 2 Marker 3 End marker
Insert a marker
Start marker Marker 1 Marker 2 Marker 3 Marker 4 End marker
Quick search functions 63
—Owner’s Manual
2. Press the TOC WRITE button to update the TOC.
Locating to a marker
3. Use the MARK SEARCH[ ]/[ ] buttons to locate to a marker you inserted.
The MARK SEARCH [ ] button will locate to a marker earlier than the current location,
and the MARK SEARCH [ ] button will locate to a marker after the current location. The
MD4S will then enter playback-pause mode. If no marker has been inserted, the MARK
SEARCH [ ] button will locate to the start marker (the beginning of the song), and the
MARK SEARCH [ ] button will locate to the end marker (the end of the song).
Adjusting the location of a marker or auto punch-in/out point
Here’s how you can make fine adjustments in steps of a single frame to the location of a
marker or an auto punch-in/out point. This procedure can be performed when the MD4S is
stopped or when it is in playback-pause mode.
1. Press a MARK SEARCH button or a LAST REC SEARCH button to locate to the
marker or auto punch-in/out point whose location you wish to adjust.
2. Press the ADJUST button.
If you pressed a MARK SEARCH button in step 1, the display will indicate “MARK X:ADJST”
(X will be the number of the marker that you selected), and “MARK X” will be blinking. If you
pressed a LAST REC SEARCH button, the display will indicate “IN:ADJST” (auto punch-in
point) or “OUT:ADJST” (auto punch-out point). At this time you can rotate the DATA dial to
select another marker or auto punch-in/out point.
Note: If you turn off the power of the MD4S without updating the TOC, the marker settings
will be lost.
Tip: The marker indicator in the display shows the marker that corresponds to the current
location. When an indicator for a marker you inserted is blinking, the current location is
between that marker and the next marker.
Start marker Marker 1 Marker 2 Marker 3 End marker
Current location
Start marker
Marker indicator
Marker 1 Marker 2 Marker 3 End marker
Current location
1 2 3E
S
64 Advanced recording techniques
—Owner’s Manual
3. Press the ENTER button.
The display will indicate AdjstLoad... for a short time. Then the display will change to
ADJST 0 and the track will play back for approximately 1.5 seconds before and after the
point you selected in step 1. At this time, there will be a volume difference between the first 1.5
seconds and the last 1.5 seconds, so that you can hear exactly where the marker occurs.
4. Press the PLAY button, and while listening to playback 1.5 seconds before and
after the marker, rotate the DATA dial to adjust the location of the marker in
single-frame units (11.6 ms).
When you rotate the DATA dial to move the marker backward or forward, the display will
indicate ADJST XXX (XXX is the number of frames that the marker was moved.)
5. As necessary, rotate the CURSOR shuttle to invert the high/low volume
change.
By rotating the CURSOR shuttle to left or right you can invert the high/low volume change
that occurs between the first 1.5 seconds and the last 1.5 seconds. If the display indicates ,
the first 1.5 seconds will be played at a lower volume. if the display indicates , the last 1.5
seconds will be played at a lower volume.
6. When you have nished making adjustments, press the ENTER button.
The new location will be finalized, and the MD4S will locate to that spot. The display will
return to the state in which it was before you press the ADJUST button in step 2.
7. Press the ADJUST button once again to return to normal operation.
8. Press the TOC WRITE button to update the TOC.
Tip: 1.5 seconds before and after the marker will also playback immediately after you rotate
the CURSOR shuttle. If you keep inverting the volume difference while you listen, it will be
easier to make accurate adjustments to the position.
Note: The frames with which we are dealing here are 11.6 ms units. Do not confuse them
with MTC frames. If MTC frames are displayed in the time display, the adjusted location may
not be reflected by the time counter.
Marker or auto punch-in/out point
1.5 sec.
CURSOR shuttle
Display
Playback volume
1.5 sec. 1.5 sec. 1.5 sec.
Marker or auto punch-in/out point
Quick search functions 65
—Owner’s Manual
Erasing a marker or auto punch-in/out point
Here’s how to erase a marker location or auto punch-in/out point that you have set. This pro-
cedure can be performed when the MD4S is either stopped or in playback-pause mode.
1. Press a MARK SEARCH or LAST REC SEARCH button to locate to the marker or
the auto punch-in/out point that you wish to erase.
2. Press the ADJUST button.
The display will indicate “MARK X:ADJST” or “IN:ADJST” or “OUT:ADJST, and the word
on the left (MARK X/IN/OUT) will blink. At this time, you may rotate the DATA dial to select
a different marker or auto punch-in/out point.
3. Rotate the CURSOR shuttle toward the right.
The word ADJST” in the display will blink.
4. Rotate the DATA dial toward the right.
The word ADJST” in the display will change to “CLEAR.
5. Press the ENTER button.
If you are erasing a marker, the display will indicate “CLR MARKX?” (X will be the marker
number). By pressing the EXIT button at this point you can cancel the Erase operation.
6. Press the ENTER button once again to erase the marker, or press the EXIT but-
ton to cancel the Erase operation.
The marker indicator (or IN/OUT indicator) that corresponds to the erased marker (or auto
punch-in/out point) will go dark. Depending on the marker that was erased, the marker num-
bers will change.
7. Press the ADJUST button or the EXIT button to return to normal operation,
and press the TOC WRITE button to update the TOC.
Note: This method can be used to make fine adjustments in a range of approximately 10
seconds forward or backward from the selected marker (or auto punch-in/out point). If you
wish to make adjustments that would be further than this range, you will need to either repeat
steps 2–6, or re-set the point that you wish to adjust. If another marker has already been
inserted before or after the marker (or auto punch-in/out point) that you are moving, it is
not possible to move these markers past each other.
Start marker Mark 1 Mark 2 Mark 4Mark 3 End marker
Erase marker 3
Start marker Mark 1 Mark 2 Mark 3 End marker
66 Advanced recording techniques
—Owner’s Manual
Various playback functions
This section explains the various playback functions offered by the MD4S.
Play forward/backward at various speeds (Cue/Review)
During playback, you can operate the CURSOR shuttle to play forward (cue) or backward
(review) at various speeds. This is a convenient way to find the desired location within a song.
1. Press the PLAY button to begin playback.
2. Move the CURSOR shuttle to right or left to Cue or Review.
The cue/review speed will depend on the angle to which you move the CURSOR shuttle.
Shuttle playback functions
3. If you press the ENTER button while using cue/review, the cue/review will be
locked (xed).
Cue/review will continue even if you release the CURSOR shuttle. When you press the PLAY
button, cue/review will be canceled, and normal playback will resume from that location. If
cue/review reaches the beginning or end of the song, it will stop.
Note: It is not possible to move directly from normal playback to 1/2X speed cue. You must
move the CURSOR shuttle toward the right to select 2X cue or faster, and then return the
CURSOR shuttle to the 1/2X speed cue position.
Note: When 1/2X speed cue is used, the playback pitch will be one octave lower than normal.
(This is the same effect as the 1/2X speed playback explained below.) However, the pitch will
not change for cue/review at other speeds.
CURSOR
shuttle
Speed
Cue (play forward)
Normal playback
1/2X speed 2X speed 4X speed 8X speed 16X speed 32X speed
CueHALF Cue x2 Cue x4 Cue x8 Cue x16 Cue x32
Display
CURSOR
shuttle
Speed
Review (play backward)
Normal playback
1/2X speed 4X speed 8X speed 16X speed 32X speed
Rev x2 Rev x4 Rev x8 Rev x16 Rev x32
Display
Various playback functions 67
—Owner’s Manual
Playback at half speed (x1/2 Play)
x1/2 Play is a function that drops the pitch of the disc to half the normal pitch during play-
back. When x1/2 Play is used, the pitch will be one octave lower than normal. (This is the
same effect as Cue-Half.) This provides a convenient way to practice rapidly-played phrases
that you have recorded from a CD etc.
1. Press the UTILITY button.
2. Rotate the DATA dial until the display indicates X1/2 Play, and press the
ENTER button.
The display will indicate X1/2 OFF. The HALF indicator will light.
3. Rotate the DATA dial to make the display indicate X1/2 ON, and press the
ENTER button.
X1/2 Play will be active.
4. To turn off the X1/2 Play function, rotate the DATA dial to make the display
read x1/2 OFF and press the ENTER button.
Playing a song repeatedly (One Song Repeat/All Song Repeat)
The One Song Repeat function causes a single song to playback repeatedly. The All Songs
Repeat function causes all songs on the disc to playback repeatedly. These functions can be
selected when the MD4S is playing, stopped, or paused.
Note, however, that the One Song Repeat/All Songs Repeat functions are disabled for MIDI
sync operation. In this case, you can use the One Song Repeat function only on the MD4S that
has been assigned as the MTC master.
1. Press the REPEAT button to select the desired Repeat function.
Each time you press the button, the selection will cycle between One Song Repeat, All Song
Repeat, and Repeat function off. The display will indicate the selected Repeat function.
REPEAT 1 ..................One Song Repeat is selected. The currently selected song will continue
playing.
REPEAT ALL .............All Song Repeat is selected. All songs on disc will continue playing
repeatedly.
Note: Recording or rehearsal cannot be performed at X1/2 Play. Nor will it be possible to
synchronize with a MIDI sequencer using MTC or MIDI Clock while using x1/2 Play.
One Song Repeat
playback repeatedly
Song 1 Song 2 Song 3
All Song Repeat
playback repeatedly
Song 1 Song 2 Song 3
68 Advanced recording techniques
—Owner’s Manual
2. To turn off the Repeat function, press the REPEAT button until the Repeat indi-
cator goes dark.
Repeating a specic portion of a song (A-B Repeat)
A-B Repeat is a function that causes the portion of a song between a specified point A and
point B to playback repeatedly. The A and B points can be in different songs if desired. The A
and B points can be set while the MD4S is playing, stopped, or in playback-pause mode.
1. At the beginning of the desired repeat, press the A B button.
The Repeat indicator in the display will indicate “REPEAT A, indicating that the beginning of
the repeat (point A) has been specified.
2. At the end of the desired repeat, press the A B button once again.
The Repeat indicator in the display will indicate “REPEAT A B, indicating that the end of the
repeat (point B) has been specified. When you specify point B, the MD4S will automatically
locate to point A, and will begin playing repeatedly between points A and B.
3. During A-B Repeat, press the REPEAT button to turn off the A-B Repeat func-
tion.
A-B Repeat will also be canceled if you press the STOP button.
Cue List playback
Cue List is a function that lets you playback sections between markers in an order that you
specify. You can set up to 26 steps (A–Z), each specifying the marker at which playback will
begin and end, and the number of times that each step will repeat.
Programming a Cue List
1. Press the UTILITY button.
2. Rotate the DATA dial to make the display indicate Cue List, and press the
ENTER button.
The display will indicate “EDIT List.
3. Rotate the DATA dial to select either EDIT List or NEW List.
If you wish to create a new cue list, select “NEW List. If you wish to recall an existing cue list,
select “EDIT List.
4. Press the ENTER button to begin programming the cue list.
The display will show the first step (A). The blinking letter is the currently selected parameter.
Note: When A-B Repeat is turned off, points A and B will be reset. If you wish to temporarily
stop A-B Repeat playback, use the PAUSE button.
Various playback functions 69
—Owner’s Manual
5. Use the CURSOR shuttle to select a parameter, and rotate the DATA dial to
modify the setting.
The range of each parameter is as follows.
Step ...........................A–Z (while programming, this is shown as lowercase letters a–z)
Beginning/ending markers ......... s, 1–10, e (numerals are marker numbers, ‘s and e’ are
the start marker and end marker respectively)
Number of repeats ......................... 0–99
If a cue list has been programmed as shown below, the portion between the start marker and
marker 1 will be repeated twice, between marker 2 and marker 3 repeated twice, and between
marker 3 and marker 4 repeated four times.
Playing a Cue List
6. After you have nished programming the desired steps, press the ENTER button.
The display will ask “List PLAY?”
7. Press the ENTER button once again.
The display will indicate the first step (A), and the MD4S will be in Cue List playback-pause
mode. (During cue list playback, the steps will be shown as uppercase letters A–Z.) At this
time you can rotate the DATA dial to change the step at which cue list playback will begin.
8. Press the PLAY button to begin Cue List playback.
When all steps have finished playing back, cue list playback will be canceled, and the MD4S
will stop. If you wish to stop cue list playback while it is in progress, press the STOP button. If
you press the PAUSE button to temporarily halt cue list playback, you can rotate the DATA
dial to select a different step, and then resume cue list playback.
Tip: If you rotate the CURSOR shuttle to the right when the Number of Repeats parameter
is selected, you will advance to the next step. If you rotate the CURSOR shuttle toward the
left when the Step parameter is selected, you will return to the previous step.
Number of repeatsStep
Beginning marker Ending marker
STEP NO.
a:s—>1 n= 2
b:2—>3 n= 2
c:3—>4 n= 4
d:2—>3 n= 1
e:3—>4 n= 4
f:5—>7 n= 2
g:s—>1 n= 0
h:s—>1 n= 0
i:s—>1 n= 0
" "
" "
"
Cue List
70 Advanced recording techniques
—Owner’s Manual
Creating a new song from a Cue List (Cue List Copy)
The playback order that you have programmed in a cue list can be rewritten into a new song.
As shown in the following diagram, this can be used to remake a song into a new version
whose length and arrangement differ from the original song.
1. As described in steps 15 of Programming a Cue List on page 68, program
the desired cue list.
2. Press the ENTER button.
The display will ask “List PLAY?”
3. Rotate the DATA dial to make the display read List COPY?
4. Press the ENTER button to execute the Cue List Copy operation.
The display will briefly indicate “CopyTo X” (X is the copy destination song number), and
then a new song will be created. By pressing the STOP button while CopyTo X” is displayed,
you can cancel the Cue List Copy operation.
When the cue list copy has been completed, the TOC will be updated automatically and the
MD4S will stop at the beginning of the new song.
Note: In rare circumstances, playback may skip between steps of Cue List playback.
Note: Cue List program contents are remembered even when the MD4S is turned off.
Cue List
Original song
New song after Cue List Copy
a: s>1 n=2 (start the song by repeating the intro twice)
b: 1>2 n=2 (Opening A played twice)
c: 2>3 n=1 (Opening B)
d: 6>7 n=1 (Bridge 2)
e: 4>5 n=1 (Chorus A)
f: 8>9 n=1 (the eight measures of fill are moved forward)
g: 3>4 n=1 (Bridge 1)
h: 7>8 n=2 (repeat Chorus B twice, and move it back)
i:
10
>e n=2 (repeat the Ending twice and fade out)
Intro
Opening A
abcdefgh i
Opening B
Opening BChorus A Chorus B Chorus C Ending
Intro Intro
Opening A Opening A
Opening B Chorus A Chorus B Chorus B Ending Ending
Bridge
1
Bridge
1
Bridge
2
Bridge
2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9E10S
8 measures
of fill
8 measures
of fill
Various playback functions 71
—Owner’s Manual
Programming the song playback order (Program Play)
Program Play is a function that lets you program the playback order of the songs on disc. You
can specify up to 36 steps of song numbers for playback.
1. Press the UTILITY button.
2. Rotate the DATA dial to make the display read Prog Play, and press the
ENTER button.
The display will indicate “EDIT Prog.
3. Rotate the DATA dial to select either EDIT Prog or NEW Prog.
If you wish to create a new program, select “NEW Prog. If you wish to recall an existing pro-
gram, select “EDIT Prog.
4. Press the ENTER button to begin programming.
The display will indicate the parameters of each step. The blinking character is the currently
selected parameter.
5. Rotate the CURSOR shuttle to select parameters, and rotate the DATA dial to
modify the value.
The range of each parameter is as follows.
Step number ...........S1–S36 (S will be displayed as a lowercase letter during programming)
Song number .........*, song number (* indicates that no song number has been specified for
this step)
Note: For steps 2 and following, the song number specified for the previous step will also be
displayed. However this is only for your information, and cannot be modified.
Tip: If you rotate the CURSOR shuttle to the right when the Song Number parameter is
selected, you will advance to the next step. If you rotate the CURSOR shuttle toward the left
when the Step parameter is selected, you will return to the previous step.
Song numberStep number
Song number that was
specified for the previous step
72 Advanced recording techniques
—Owner’s Manual
With the program shown in the following diagram, playback will occur in the order of Song 1
Song 3 Song 2 Song 2.
6. After you have entered all of the desired steps, press the ENTER button.
The display will show the first step (S1), and the MD4S will be in Program Play playback-
pause mode. (In Program Play, the S for “Step will be show as an uppercase character.) At this
time, you can use the SONG SEARCH buttons to change the step at which Program Play will
begin.
7. Press the PLAY button to begin Program Play.
When all steps have finished playing back, the MD4S will stop. By pressing the STOP button
during Program Play, you can also cancel Program Play and stop.
Tip: If you press the PAUSE button during Program Play, the playback will pause
temporarily, and you can use the PLAY button to resume Program Play. While paused, you
can also use the SONG SEARCH buttons to change the step from which Program Play will
resume.
Note: Program Play settings are remembered even when the MD4S is turned off.
Program Play
S 1: 1
S 2: 1 3
S 3: 3 2
S 4: 2 2
S 5: 2 9
S 6: 9 5
S 7: 5 1
S 8: 1 *
S 9: * *
S10: * *
S11: * *
Editing functions 73
—Owner’s Manual
Editing functions
This sections explains the track and song editing functions that are provided on the MD4S.
Copying a portion of a track (Part Copy)
Part Copy is a function that copies a portion of a track to a different location within the same
track or to the desired location in another track. You can also copy between songs. This func-
tion is useful when you wish to re-use a specific phrase in a different place.
1. Specify the Last Record In/Out points to set the Copy Source area.
Locate to the beginning of the copy source area. Hold down the SET button and press the
LAST REC SEARCH IN button to set the Last Record In point. Then locate to the end of the
copy source area. Hold down the SET button and press the LAST REC SEARCH OUT button
to set the Last Record Out point. When you set each point, the IN/OUT indicators in the dis-
play will light.
2. Locate to the copy destination, and stop or pause playback.
The location at which you stop or pause will be the beginning of the copy destination.
3. Press the EDIT button.
4. Rotate the DATA dial to make the display read Part Copy, and press the
ENTER button.
The display will show the copy source track and the copy destination track.
The currently selected parameter will blink.
5. Use the CURSOR shuttle and the DATA dial to specify the copy source track
number and the copy destination track number.
If “*” is shown for a track number parameter, the Part Copy operation cannot be executed.
6. After you have set the copy source and copy destination tracks, press the
ENTER button.
The display will ask “COPY EXE?” If you press the EXIT button at this point, the Part Copy
operation will be canceled.
Tip: Last Record In/Out points (auto punch-in/out points) can be adjusted in single-frame
units (1/86 second). See “Adjusting the location of a marker or auto punch-in/out point” on
page 63 for more information.
Tip: If you use the SONG SEARCH buttons to select a different song, the track in the selected
song will be copy destination track.
Note: The copy destination area must not extend beyond the end of the song. Also, when
copying within the same track, the copy destination area must not overlap the copy source area.
Copy destination track numberCopy source track number
74 Advanced recording techniques
—Owner’s Manual
7. Press the ENTER button once again to execute the Part Copy operation.
While the Part Copy is being executed, the display will indicate “COPY EXE.. and the track
record indicator (DIR) for the copy destination track will light. If you press the STOP button
at this time, the copy can be interrupted. When the copy is completed, the MD4S will stop.
Erasing a section of a track (Part Erase)
The Part Erase function erases a section portion of a track. You can select two or more tracks
for erasure. The section that was erased will be silent.
1. At the beginning of the section you wish to erase, press the SET button +
LAST REC SEARCH [IN] button. At the end of the section, press the SET button
+ LAST REC SEARCH [OUT] button.
The last record in/out points will be set, and the area between them will be selected for era-
sure. When you set each point, the IN/OUT indicator in the display will light.
2. Press the EDIT button.
3. Rotate the DATA dial to make the display read Part Erase, and press the
ENTER button.
The display will show the track from which data will be erased.
The currently selected parameter will blink.
4. Rotate the CURSOR shuttle to select tracks, and rotate the DATA dial to specify
whether or not data will be erased from each track.
Data will be erased from the track numbers shown. (The tracks shown as “*” will not be
erased.) For example if the display indicates “1**4T, the specified area of tracks 1 and 4 will be
erased. If all tracks show “*”, the Part Erase operation will not be executed.
5. Press the ENTER button.
The display will ask “Erase EXE?” If you wish to cancel the operation at this point, press the
EXIT button.
Note: When you execute the copy operation, the content that had been recorded on the copy
destination track will be erased.
Copy source track
Copy destination track
Copy
Current location where stopped/paused
OUTIN
Track to erase
Editing functions 75
—Owner’s Manual
6. Press the ENTER button to execute the Part Erase operation.
While the data is being erased, the display will indicate “Erase EXE.. and the track record indi-
cator (DIR) for the tracks being erased will light. Part Erase requires one minute to erase each
minute of selected area. While Part Erase is in progress, tracks not being erased will playback.
Copying an entire track to another track (Track Copy)
Track Copy is a function that copies an entire track to another track.
1. Press the EDIT button, use the CURSOR shuttle to make the display read
Track Copy, and press the ENTER button.
The display will show the parameters that specify the copy source track and copy destination
track.
The currently selected parameter will blink.
2. Use the CURSOR shuttle and the DATA dial to specify the copy source track
number and copy destination track number.
If either track number parameter shows “*” the Track Copy operation cannot be executed.
3. After you have specied the copy source and copy destination tracks, press
the ENTER button.
The display will ask “COPY EXE?” If you wish to cancel the copy operation, you can press the
EXIT button at this time.
4. Press the ENTER button once again to execute the Track Copy operation.
While the track copy is being executed, the display will indicate “COPY EXE.. and the track
record indicator (DIR) for the copy destination track will light. If you wish to cancel the oper-
ation mid-way through the copy, you can press the STOP button at this time. When the track
copy has been completed, the MD4S will stop.
Note: By pressing the STOP button, you can stop the Part Erase operation mid-way through
its progress. However, in this case, the data between the point at which Part Erase was
executed until the STOP button was pressed will already have been erased.
Note: When you execute the copy operation, any content that had been recorded on the copy
destination track will be erased.
Before Part Erase
After Part Erase
Part Erase
OUTIN
Copy destination track numberCopy source track number
76 Advanced recording techniques
—Owner’s Manual
Erasing an entire track (Track Erase)
Track Erase is a function that erases an entire track. You can select one or more tracks to erase.
The erased track(s) will contain only silence.
1. Press the EDIT button, and rotate the DATA dial to make the display read
Track Erase. Then press the ENTER button.
The display will show the parameter that specifies the track(s) to be erased.
The currently selected parameter will blink.
2. Use the CURSOR shuttle and the DATA dial to select the track(s) that will be
erased.
Tracks whose numbers are shown will be displayed. (Tracks for which “*” is displayed will not
be erased.) For example with settings of “12**T, tracks 1 and 2 will be erased. If all tracks are
“*” the Track Erase operation cannot be executed.
3. Press the ENTER button.
The display will ask “Erase EXE?” If you wish to cancel the Track Erase operation, you can
press the EXIT button at this time.
4. Press the ENTER button once again to execute the Track Erase operation.
While Track Erase is being executed, the display will indicate “Erase EXE.. and the track
record indicator (DIR) for the track(s) being erased will light. The Track Erase operation takes
four minutes for a four-minute song. While the operation is in progress, tracks not being
erased will play back.
Copying/converting a song (Song Copy)
Song Copy is a function that duplicates an entire song, including the title, markers, and tempo
map data. It is convenient to use this function to create a backup of the original song before
performing ping-pong recording or punch-in/out recording. If desired, the recording mode
(4TR/2TR/MONO mode) of the copy destination song can be converted, and you may change
the order of the tracks. (For more on the recording modes, refer to page 11.)
1. Use the SONG SEARCH buttons to select the copy source song, and press the
ENTER button.
2. Rotate the DATA dial to make the display read Song Copy, and press the
ENTER button.
The display will ask “Copy X?” (X is the copy source song number). At this time you can rotate
the DATA dial to select a different song number.
Note: By pressing the STOP button, you can stop the Track Erase operation mid-way
through its progress. However, in this case, the data between the point at which Track Erase
was executed until the STOP button was pressed will already have been erased.
Track to erase
Editing functions 77
—Owner’s Manual
3. Press the ENTER button once again.
The display will indicate the recording mode and track order of the copy source song.
If you wish to create a complete duplicate of the song without changing the recording mode or
track order, proceed to step 7.
Changing the record mode
4. Rotate the DATA dial to select the recording mode of the copy destination
song.
The following recording modes are available for conversion.
• 4T (4TR mode)
• 2T (2TR mode)
• MO (MONO mode)
For example if you specify “2T:12” the copy destination song will be as follows.
Changing the order of the tracks
5. Rotate the CURSOR shuttle to the right.
The numerals indicating the track order will blink.
6. Use the CURSOR shuttle to select the track whose order you wish to change,
and rotate the DATA dial to specify the copy source track number.
The currently selected track will blink. Rotate the DATA dial to select the copy source track
number (1–4) or “-”. If you select “-, the corresponding track of the copy destination will be
blank (silent).
Tracks to copyRecording mode
REC MODE
4T:1234 2T:12
Copy source song
Vocal
Guitar
Bass
Drums
4
3
2
1
Copy destination song
Bass
Drums
2
1
78 Advanced recording techniques
—Owner’s Manual
For example if you specified “4T:3421, the order of copy destination tracks would be as fol-
lows.
Executing the Song Copy
7. When you have nished making settings, press the ENTER button.
The display will indicate Copy to BX (X is the number of a blank area).
8. Rotate the DATA dial to specify the copy destination blank area.
9. Press the ENTER button.
The display will ask “Copy EXE?” If you decide to cancel the Song Copy, press the EXIT but-
ton.
10. Press the ENTER button to execute the Song Copy operation.
The display will indicate CopyTo X” (X is the song number of the copy destination) for a
time, and when the copy is completed, the TOC will be updated automatically and the MD4S
will select the copy destination song and then stop.
Erasing a song (Song Erase)
Song erase is a function that erases an entire song. The song that was erased will become a
blank area. Use this function when you need to increase disc space in order to record a new
song.
1. Press a SONG SEARCH button to select the song you wish to erase.
2. Press the EDIT button, and rotate the DATA dial to make the display read
Song Erase. Then press the ENTER button.
The display will indicate “Song No. X” (X is the number of the song to be erased). At this time
you can rotate the DATA dial to select a different song.
3. Press the ENTER button.
The display will ask “Erase EXE?” If you decide to cancel the Song Erase operation, you can
press the EXIT button now.
Tip: You can specify the same track number more than once. For example if you specify
“4T:3422” the contents of copy source track 2 will be copied to tracks 3 and 4.
4T:1234 4T:3421
Copy source song
Vocal
Guitar
Bass
Drums
4
3
2
1
Copy destination song
Drums
Bass
Vocal
Guitar
4
3
2
1
Editing functions 79
—Owner’s Manual
4. Press the ENTER button once again to execute the Song Erase operation.
The display will indicate “Erase EXE.., and the TOC will be updated automatically when the
song has been erased.
Splitting a song into two (Song Divide)
Song Divide is a function that splits a song into two parts. The Program Play function
(page 71) can be used to rearrange the playback order of the newly-divided parts.
1. Locate to the point at which you wish to divide the song, and stop or pause
playback.
2. Press the EDIT button. Then rotate the DATA dial to make the display read
Song Divide, and press the ENTER button.
The display will ask “Divide EXE?” If you decide to cancel the Song Divide operation, press the
EXIT button now.
3. Press the ENTER button once again to execute the Song Divide operation.
When the song has been divided, the TOC will automatically be updated.
If markers had been placed in the original song, markers earlier than the Divide point will
remain in the original song, and markers following the Divide point will be renumbered as
markers of the new song.
Tip: If there are three consecutive songs as shown in the following diagram, erasing the
middle song will create a new blank area that is independent of the other blank area. Now you
can either record a new song in the blank area, or extend the length of Song 1.
Note: When you erase a song, the numbers of all subsequent songs will be updated.
Song 1 Song 2 Song 3 Blank area 1
Song 1 Blank area 2 Song 2 Blank area 1
Erase song 2
80 Advanced recording techniques
—Owner’s Manual
Joining divided songs together (Song Combine)
Song Combine is an operation that joins two previously-divided songs to create a single song.
1. Press the EDIT button, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read Song
Combn, and press the ENTER button.
The display will indicate the numbers of the two songs that are to be joined.
2. Rotate the DATA dial to select the songs that will be joined.
To join songs 3 and 4, select Cmbn 3+4. If the display indicates “Cmbn *+*” the Song Com-
bine operation cannot be executed.
3. Press the ENTER button.
The display will ask “Cmbn EXE?” If you decide to cancel the Song Combine operation at this
point, press the EXIT button.
4. Press the ENTER button once again to execute the Song Combine operation.
After the songs have been combined, the TOC will automatically be updated.
If markers have been placed in the two songs being joined, the marker locations will remain in
the newly-joined song. (Marker numbers will be updated automatically.) However since the
point at which the songs were joined will be inserted as a new marker, the total number of
markers in the song will be one more than the total number of markers in the two songs.
Note: When a song is divided, the song numbers of all subsequent songs will be updated. For
example if you divide song 1, the first part of the divided song will be Song 1, the remainder
will be Song 2, and the previous Song 2 will be renumbered as Song 3.
Note: Separately-recorded songs cannot be joined.
Song 1 before division
Song 1 after division
Divide point
Song 2
1 2 3 4ES
1ES
1 2 3ES
Song numbers to join
Editing functions 81
—Owner’s Manual
Moving a song (Song Move)
Song Move is a function that moves a song to a blank area. This is convenient when you wish
to record additional material to extend a previously-recorded song, or to organize the blank
area on a disc.
1. Use the SONG SEARCH buttons to select the song that you wish to move.
2. Press the EDIT button, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read Song
Move, and press the ENTER button.
The display will ask “Move X?” (X is the number of the song that will be moved). At this time
you can rotate the DATA dial to select a different song.
3. Press the ENTER button.
The display will read “Move to BX (X is the number of the blank area to which the song will
be moved).
4. Rotate the DATA dial to select the blank area to which the song will be
moved.
Note: If the total number of markers in the song (including the marker added at the point
where the songs were joined) is eleven or more, it will not be possible to recall the eleventh
or subsequent markers. However the locations of the eleventh and subsequent markers will
still be remembered, and if one or more of the first ten markers is deleted, these later markers
will once again become available. For the procedure of deleting a marker, refer to page 65.
Note: When you combine a song, the numbers of subsequent songs will be updated
automatically. For example if you combine songs 1 and 2 into song 1, the following song
number 3 will be renumbered as song number 2.
Note: It will not be possible to select a blank area that is shorter than the song being moved.
Song 1
after combining
Song 1
before combining
Point at which songs were joined
Song 2
before combining
1ES
1 2 3ES
1 2 4 53ES
82 Advanced recording techniques
—Owner’s Manual
5. Press the ENTER button.
The display will ask “Move EXE?” If you decide to cancel the Song Move operation, press the
EXIT button.
6. Press the ENTER button once again to execute the Song Move operation.
The display will indicate “MoveTo BX” (X is the number of the blank area to which the song
will be moved) for a time. When the song has been moved, the TOC will automatically be
updated.
When a song is moved, its location on disc will change, but the song numbers will not be
exchanged.
Exchanging the order of songs (Song Renumber)
Song Renumber is an operation that rearranges the numbers of the songs on disc. After you
have used the Song Move operation, you can use the Song Renumber if you want the song
numbers to match their sequence on disc.
1. Press the EDIT button, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read Song
Renum, and press the ENTER button.
The display will ask “Renum EXE?” If you decide to cancel the Song Renumber operation,
press the EXIT button.
Tip: If you wish to record additional material to extend the length of an existing song, there
must be a blank area following that song. If as shown in the following diagram, you have
recorded song 1 and then recorded song 2 following it, there will be no blank area following
song 1, and therefore it will not be possible to record additional material to extend the length
of song 1. In such cases, you can move song 1 to blank area 1 so that additional material can
be recorded onto the end of song 1.
Tip: Before performing the Song Move operation, it is a good idea to check Disc Information
to see the arrangement of songs and blank areas. For details refer to page 86.
Tip: To avoid confusion, we recommend that you assign a name to your songs before using
the Song Renumber operation. See “Titling discs and songs” on page 85 for more information.
Song 1 Song 2 Blank area 1
Move song 1 to blank area 1
Now the length of song 1 can be extended
Blank area 2 Song 1Song 2 Blank area 1
Blank area 2 Song 1Song 2 Blank area 1
Editing functions 83
—Owner’s Manual
2. Press the ENTER button to execute the Song Renumber operation.
When the songs have been renumbered, the TOC will automatically be updated.
Note: Some MD recorders other than the Yamaha MD4S, MD4 or MD8 divide the song data
into multiple areas on the disc. Song Renumber cannot be used on such songs.
Song 1 Song 5Song 3 Song 4
Song 1
Song 3
Song 2
Before
Song Renumber
After
Song Renumber
Song 2
Song 4 Song 5
84 Advanced recording techniques
—Owner’s Manual
Other functions
The following pages explain other functions of the MD4S.
Adjusting the record/playback pitch (Pitch function)
The Pitch function lets you adjust the record/playback pitch. This is useful when you need to
record a instrument that cannot be easily tuned (such as an acoustic piano) together with pre-
viously-recorded instruments.
The Pitch function is available when the MD4S is recording, playing, stopped, or paused.
Turning the Pitch function on/off
1. Press the PITCH button.
The display will indicate the Pitch setting. With the factory settings, the display will indicate
“FIX +00.00%”
2. Rotate the CURSOR shuttle to turn the Pitch function on (VARI) or off (FIX).
FIX (fixed)................ The display will blink “FIX, and the FIX pitch indicator will light. The
Pitch function will be turned off, and the pitch will be fixed at the nor-
mal setting.
VARI (variable)....... The display will blink “+00.00%” and the VARI pitch indicator will
light. The Pitch function will be on.
Adjusting the pitch
3. With VARI (variable) selected, rotate the DATA dial to adjust the amount of
pitch change.
The pitch can be adjusted over a range of “–10.10%” to “+10.11%”. Lowering the pitch will
slow down the recording/playback speed, and raising the pitch will speed up the rec/playback
speed.
4. When you have nished setting the Pitch function, press the ENTER button to
return to normal operation.
Note: At a setting of “+00.00%” the result is the same as when FIX is selected.
Note: The amount of pitch change for VARI (variable) is remembered even if the MD4S is
turned off. However, the next time that the power is turned on, this function will
automatically be set to FIX.
Note: After you use the Pitch function to record, don’t forget to return the setting to FIX
(fixed) before the next recording. In particular, you should check the Pitch indicator before
you start recording a new song.
Amount of VARI
(variable) pitch change
FIX (fixed)
Other functions 85
—Owner’s Manual
Titling discs and songs
A title of up to 127 characters can be assigned to each disc and to each song on the disc. This
provides a convenient way to distinguish discs and songs.
Titling a disc
1. Press the EDIT button, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read Disc
Name, and press the ENTER button.
If no title has been assigned to the disc, the display will blink “No Title.
2. Use the CURSOR shuttle to move to the location where you wish to input a
character, and use the DATA dial to select the character.
The input location is shown by a blinking character (or a character). The following char-
acters are available.
Spaces can be inserted between characters.
3. When you have nished inputting the title, press the EDIT button once again
to return to normal operation.
4. Press the TOC WRITE key to update the TOC.
Titling a song
1. Use the SONG SEARCH buttons to select the song that you wish to title.
2. Press the EDIT button, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read Song
Name, and press the ENTER button.
The display will indicate the number and title of the selected song. If no title has been
assigned, the display will blink “No Name. At this time you can rotate the DATA dial to select
a different song number.
3. Rotate the CURSOR shuttle toward the right.
Now you will be able to input the song title.
4. Use the CURSOR shuttle to specify the location at which to input a character,
and use the DATA dial to select a character.
The blinking character (or character) indicates the input location. The available charac-
ters are the same as in the table shown above.
5. When you nish making settings, press the EDIT button once again to return
to normal operation.
Note: When a titled disc is inserted into the MD4S, the title will appear in the display for a
time.
( indicates a space)
86 Advanced recording techniques
—Owner’s Manual
6. Press the TOC WRITE button to update the TOC.
Erasing a disc (Disc Erase)
Disc Erase is a function that erases all the songs on a disc. When you execute the Disc Erase
function, the entire disc will be a blank area. Before a MD DATA disc that was used to store
computer data can be used with the MD4S, you must first execute the Disc Erase operation on
that disc.
1. Press the EDIT button, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read Disc
Erase, and press the ENTER button.
The display will ask “Erase EXE?” If you decide to cancel the Disc Erase operation at this
point, press the EXIT button.
2. Press the ENTER button once again.
The display will ask “Really?” so that you can confirm the operation. You can cancel the Disc
Erase operation by pressing the EXIT button.
3. Press the ENTER button once again, and the Disc Erase operation will be exe-
cuted.
When Disc Erase has been completed, the TOC will be updated automatically. The display will
indicate “Blank Disc.
Viewing disc contents
The Disc Info function allows you to view how the songs and blank areas on a disc are orga-
nized. For example when you wish to record additional material onto the end of a song, you
can use this function to check the available blank areas.
1. Press the UTILITY button, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read Disc
Info, and press the ENTER button.
The display will show the order of songs and blank areas. Numbers indicate song numbers,
and numbers prefixed by “B” are blank area numbers.
For example if you have executed the Song Move function so that songs and blank areas are
arranged on the disc as shown above, the display will indicate the first two blocks as “1B2”.
2. Rotate the DATA dial to view the contents of the entire disc.
As you rotate the DATA dial toward the right, the display will indicate “1B2”,B23”,
3,”2B1” etc.
Note: When you use the SONG SEARCH buttons to select a song that already has a title, the
song title will appear in the display beside the song number. However, only the first seven
characters of the song title will be displayed.
Song 1 Blank area 2 Song 3 Song 2
Blank area 1
Other functions 87
—Owner’s Manual
3. Press the UTILITY button once again to return to normal operation.
Changing the recording mode
The MD4S allows you to choose from three recording modes: 4TR mode, 2TR mode, and
MONO mode. When 2TR mode or MONO mode are selected, fewer tracks can be recorded,
but the available recording time will be longer. There is no difference in audio quality between
the modes.
1. Press the SONG SEARCH [ ] button to select a blank area.
The display will indicate “BLANK X (X is the blank area number).
2. Press the UTILITY button, rotate the CURSOR shuttle to make the display read
REC MODE, and press the ENTER button.
The display will indicate the current recording mode.
3. While watching the display, use the DATA dial to select the desired recording
mode.
4TR MODE ...............(4 track recording)
2TR MODE ...............(2 track recording)
MONO MODE ........(monaural recording)
4. Press the ENTER button to nalize the recording mode.
5. Press the UTILITY button once again to return to normal operation.
Note: Some MD recorders other than the Yamaha MD4S, MD4 or MD8 divide the song data
into multiple areas on the disc. When Disk Information for a disc including such songs is
viewed on the MD4S, songs that are divided will be indicated by a “#” character. Songs that
are indicated by “#” cannot be directly edited by the MD4S. However if you use the Song
Copy function (page 76) to copy that song, the copy destination song can be edited by the
MD4S.
Recording mode
Number of
tracks
Available
recording time
(minutes)
MD DATA MiniDisc
4TR (4 track recording) 1, 2, 3, 4 37
2TR (2 track recording) 1, 2 74 ❍❍
MONO (monaural recording) 1 148 ❍❍
Note: Set the recording mode before you begin a new recording. It is not possible to change
the recording mode of an already-recorded song. You may change the recording mode for
each song.
Note: If you select 2TR mode, recording will be possible only on tracks 1 and 2. If you select
MONO mode, recording will be possible only on track 1.
Note: 8TR mode songs that were recorded on the Yamaha MD8 cannot be edited on the
MD4S. However, songs that were converted by the MD8 into 4TR/2TR/MONO modes can
be played back by the MD4S.
88 Advanced recording techniques
—Owner’s Manual
Adjusting the display brightness
The brightness of the display can be adjusted over five steps.
1. Press the UTILITY button, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read Disp
Dimmer, and press the ENTER button.
The display will indicate “Dimmer X (X will be a number between 1–5).
2. Rotate the DATA dial to adjust the brightness.
The range of this parameter is 1–5, and higher settings will increase the brightness. The fac-
tory setting is 5.
3. Press the ENTER button to nalize the display brightness setting.
4. Press the UTILITY button or the EXIT button to return to normal operation.
Selecting the type of Frame display
The frame display of the display counter can be switched to either 86 frames/second (Mini-
Disc/MD DATA audio frames) or 30 frames/second (MTC frames).
1. Press the UTILITY button, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read
Frame Disp, and press the ENTER button.
The display will indicate XX Frame (XX will be either 86 or 30).
2. Rotate the DATA dial to select either 86 or 30.
If “86” is selected, the “FRAMES” indicator will light in the Frame area of the time counter. If
“30” is selected, the “MTC FRAMES indicator will light.
3. Press the ENTER button to nalize the frame display setting.
4. Press the UTILITY button or the EXIT button to return to normal operation.
Note: The recording mode setting is not reset when the power is turned off. If a recordable
MiniDisc is inserted into the MD4S, it will automatically switch to 2TR mode, meaning that
if you later insert an MD DATA disc and wish to perform 4 track recording, you will need to
reset the recording mode to 4TR.
Tip: This setting is remembered when the MD4S power is turned off.
Tip: This setting is remembered when the MD4S power is turned off.
Other functions 89
—Owner’s Manual
Using a Foot switch
If an optional FC5 foot switch is connected to the PUNCH I/O jack, you can use the foot
switch to perform not only punch-in/out but a variety of other transport operations. When
the foot switch is pressed, the MD4S will perform the following operations.
On z Flashing
1. [PAUSE] button operation.
2. Effective only when a [REC SELECT] button is pressed.
3. [STOP] button operation.
4. After locating the Pre-Roll point, the Auto Punch In/Out sequence starts.
Mode Before Mode After
Indicators Indicators
REHE REC PLAY REHE REC PLAY
Stop
———
Play
——
Play
——
Play Pause
1
——
z
Play Pause
——
z
Play
——
Cue/Review
——
Play
——
Record Pause
z
Play Record Wait
z
Rehearse Pause
z
——
Play Rehearse Wait
z
Play Record Wait
z
Record
2
●●
Play Rehearse Wait
z
Rehearse
Record
●●
Play
——
Rehearse
Play
——
New Record Pause
z
New Record
●●
New Record
●●
Stop
3
———
Auto Punch Record
Standby
z
Auto Punch Record
Wait
4
z
Auto Punch
Rehearse Standby
z
——
Auto Punch
Rehearse Wait
4
z
Note: For the optional Yamaha FC5 Footswitch, operation is initiated when the footswitch
is pressed, not when it’s released. This may differ, however, with other footswitches.
90 Advanced recording techniques
—Owner’s Manual
MIDI functions
The MD4S is an ideal device for recording vocals, guitar, or other acoustic instruments, but by
using its MIDI functionality you can synchronize it with a MIDI sequencer or with another
MD4S, or control the transport of the MD4S from an external MIDI device. This section
explains how to use the MIDI functionality of the MD4S.
Synchronizing the MD4S with a MIDI sequencer
The MD4S allows you to select either “MTC” or “MIDI Clock” synchronization data for out-
put from its MIDI OUT connector. This synchronization data can be transmitted to a MIDI
sequencer to make the MIDI sequencer follow and synchronize to the MD4S. In this type of
synchronized MIDI system, the MD4S will be the master and the MIDI sequencer will be the
slave.
Connecting the MD4S with a MIDI system
The MD4S can be connected to a synchronized MIDI sequencer system in a wide variety of
ways, but the most common setup is for acoustic sounds to be recorded on the MD4S, and
other parts to be played by the sequencer on a MIDI tone generator. In such a system, you
would monitor the sounds of the MIDI tone generator as you recorded vocals and guitar to
the MD4S. Then during mixdown, you would mix the playback of the MD4S with the sound
from the MIDI tone generator (See page 42).
MIDI keyboard
LR
LR
MIDI IN
MIDI IN
MIDI
OUT
MIDI OUT
MIDI OUT 1
MIDI OUT 2
MIDI IN 1
or MTC IN
MTC/MIDI Clock
MIDI IN 2
MIDI tone generator
5 / 6 7 / 8
STEREO
MONITOR LEVEL
CUE
STEREO
2TR IN
CUE MIX TO STEREO
MONITOR SELECT
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TOC WRITE
REHE REC PLAY STOP
PAUSE
IN OUT
SONG SEARCH
LAST REC SEARCH
MARK SEARCHREPEAT
AUTO
PUNCH I/O
AB
DATA CURSOR
PHONES PUNCH I/O
PITCH
EJECT
ADJUST EDIT UTILITY
CH1
BUS
CH2
REC SELECT
CH3 CH4
LRLR
PEAK HOLD DISPLAY
010
MIN MAX
010
MULTITRACK MD RECORDER
IN THRUOUT
MIDI
MIC/LINE INPUT
3
21
4 5678
LINE INPUT
AUX SEND
INSERT
I/O
INSERT
I/O
TRACK
DIRECT OUT
STEREO
OUT
2TR IN MONITOR
OUT
12
1234
EXIT
ENTER
SET
MARK
1
1
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
2
2
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
3
3
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
4
4
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
15 +15
MID
15 +15
LOW
15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
MIDI functions 91
—Owner’s Manual
About MTC and MIDI Clock
MTC and MIDI Clock are different types of MIDI messages used for synchronization between
MIDI devices.
MTC transmits absolute time information in units of a “frame” (1/30 of a second). If you start
a MD4S song at the “5 minutes 10 seconds” location, the MIDI sequencer will also play in syn-
chronization from the “5 minutes 10 seconds location. Since the MIDI sequencer simply plays
according to the time data that it receives, synchronization will not be affected if the tempo of
the sequence data changes. Nearly all high-end computer-based sequencers support MTC.
MIDI Clock transmits Clock messages according to the tempo. In other words, the MIDI
sequencer will synchronize to the Tempo data (tempo map) that was created on the MD4S.
When you create a tempo map on the MD4S, the time display will indicate measures/beats/
clocks just as on a MIDI sequencer. In this case if you start the MD4S song from measure 10,
the MIDI sequencer will synchronize and start playing from “measure 10. If you need to syn-
chronize the MD4S to a MIDI sequencer or MIDI rhythm machine that does not support
MTC, you should use MIDI Clock synchronization.
Synchronization using MTC
Transmit MTC from the MIDI OUT connector of the MD4S
Make MIDI Sync settings so that the MIDI OUT connector of the MD4S will transmit MTC
messages.
1. Press the UTILITY button, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read MIDI
Sync, and press the ENTER button.
The display will indicate the currently selected MIDI Sync setting. If MIDI Sync is off, the dis-
play will indicate “Sync OFF.
2. Rotate the DATA dial to make the display read MTC MASTER.
The MIDI indicator in the display will light to indicate “MTC SYNC MASTER. With this setting,
MTC messages will be transmitted from the MIDI OUT connector when the MD4S is running.
3. Press the UTILITY button once again to return to normal operation.
Note: When inputting MIDI Time Code sent from the MD4S to the MIDI sequencer, it is
best to use a dedicated MTC input connector or a separate MIDI IN connector. The reason
for this is that if MIDI musical (playback) data is sent together with MTC to the same MIDI
IN connector of the sequencer, synchronization may be disrupted.
Tip: If your MIDI sequencer supports MMC (MIDI Machine Control), you can make the
MD4S receive MMC data so that the principle transport functions of the MD4S can be
controlled by the MIDI sequencer. Even in this case, the MD4S will still be the
synchronization master of the MIDI system, but you will have the convenience of being able
to control MD4S operations such as Record (including punch-in/out), Playback, and Locate
to specified measures from the MIDI sequencer. For details on setting the MD4S to receive
MMC, refer to “Controlling the MD4S by MMC” on page 98.
Note: If you are using MIDI Clock and the slave device does not support the MIDI Song
Position Pointer message, it will not be possible to synchronize from the middle of the song.
In this case, you must always start synchronizing from the beginning of the song.
92 Advanced recording techniques
—Owner’s Manual
MIDI sequencer settings
To use MTC, your MIDI sequencer must be set to synchronize to the MTC messages it
receives. In this case, you must set the frame rate to 30 frames/second. For details on making
this setting, refer to the owner’s manual of your MIDI sequencer.
Synchronization using MIDI Clock
Transmit MIDI Clock from the MIDI OUT connector of the MD4S
Make MIDI Sync settings so that the MIDI OUT connector of the MD4S will transmit MIDI
Clock messages.
1. Press the UTILITY button, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read MIDI
Sync, and press the ENTER button.
The display will indicate the currently selected MIDI Sync setting. If MIDI Sync is off, the dis-
play will indicate “Sync OFF.
2. Rotate the DATA dial to make the display read MIDI CLOCK.
The MIDI indicator in the display will light to indicate “MIDI CLOCK.
3. Press the UTILITY button once again to return to normal operation.
Programming a tempo map
Tempo and meter (time signature) data can be programmed into a MD4S song. For each
song, you can program 26 steps (A–Z) each of tempo data and meter data, allowing you to
change tempo and meter during the song.
Before you start programming a tempo map, it will be convenient to use the “Tempo Map
Chart” on page 111 to make a note of the measures at which the tempo or meter changes.
1. Press the ENTER button, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read Song
Tempo, and press the ENTER button.
The display will indicate “Meter Setup or Tempo Setup.
2. Rotate the DATA dial to select Meter if you wish to program time signature
data or Tempo if you wish to program tempo data. Then press the ENTER
button.
The display will indicate “Edit Meter” or “Edit Tempo.
3. Rotate the DATA dial to make the display read Edit if you are editing an
existing tempo map or New if you are programming a new tempo map.
Then press the ENTER button.
The display will indicate step A at the first measure. The character A that indicates the step
will be blinking.
MIDI functions 93
—Owner’s Manual
4. Rotate the CURSOR shuttle to the right to select the meter/tempo parameter,
and rotate the DATA dial to set the meter or tempo.
It is not possible to set the measure location of step A. The range of settings is as follows.
Meter ........................1–99/2, 4, 8, 16
Tempo ...................... =20–300
5. Press the ENTER button.
The character (A) that indicates the step will blink.
6. Rotate the DATA dial to the right to select the next step (B).
7. Use the CURSOR shuttle to select the measure at which the tempo map will
be inserted and the meter/tempo parameters, and rotate the DATA dial to set
the value.
For steps other than step A, setting the measure location to “000” will erase the tempo map
that had been specified for that step.
• To specify a 3/4 time signature from measure 5, set “B 005 3/4”.
• To specify a tempo of =90” from measure 10 beat 3, set “B010-3 090”.
• To erase the current step “B012-3 110”, set “B000-0 110”.
8. Press the ENTER button.
The step B meter data has now been inserted (or deleted, if you specified “000” as the measure
location).
9. Repeat steps 68 to continue programming the tempo map.
10. Press the EDIT button once again to return to normal operation.
11. Press the TOC WRITE button to update the TOC.
If you edited an existing tempo map, it is not necessary to update the TOC.
Note: The tempo map is saved independently for each song. When you select a song, the tem-
po map that has been programmed for that song will be loaded automatically. However,
please be aware that the number of tempo maps that can be stored on a disc is limited, and will
depend on the number of steps that have been programmed. If a display of “Save Warn!” ap-
pears when you update a tempo map, the disc area provided for tempo maps has been used up.
Note: A tempo map can be saved only on an MD DATA disc. It cannot be saved on a
MiniDisc.
MeterStep Measure
When setting Meter
(time signature) data
Measure/beat
Step Tempo
When setting Tempo data
STEP NO.
STEP NO.
94 Advanced recording techniques
—Owner’s Manual
MIDI sequencer settings
When using MIDI Clock, you will need to make settings on your MIDI sequencer so that it
will synchronize to MIDI Clock messages. For details on making this setting, please refer to
the owner’s manual of your MIDI sequencer.
Synchronizing two MD4S recorders
The MD4S is able to synchronize to MTC received from an external device. For example if you
have two MD4S recorders, and set one MD4S to transmit MTC messages and the other MD4S
to receive these MTC messages, the two units will act as a single 8-track multi-track recorder.
In this case, the MD4S that transmits the MTC will be the MTC Master and the MD4S that
receives the MTC will be the MTC Slave. When the MTC Master MD4S runs, the MTC Slave
MD4S will follow the MTC Master and run in synchronization. In this setup, you can connect
the STEREO OUT jacks of the MTC Slave MD4S to LINE INPUT jacks 5 and 6 of the MTC
Master MD4S so that the signals of the ST bus of both units can be combined by the MTC
Master MD4S.
Tip: If the measure location of a new step is set earlier than the measure location of an
existing step, the subsequent steps will automatically be reordered. Similarly if you set the
measure location of an existing step to 000 to delete it, the subsequent steps will automatically
be reordered.
Song
Delete
Insert
C 008 3/4
A 001 4/4 B 016 5/4
Song
A 001 4/4 B 016 5/4
Song
A 001 4/4 B 008 3/4 C 016 5/4
Song
A 001 4/4 B 008 3/4
B 008 3/4
C 016 5/4
MIDI functions 95
—Owner’s Manual
Connect the two MD4S recorders as follows.
Settings for the MTC Slave MD4S
1. Press the UTILITY button, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read MIDI
Sync, and press the ENTER button.
The display will indicate the current MIDI Sync setting.
2. Rotate the DATA dial to make the display read MTC SLAVE.
Set the master MD4S to indicate “MTC SLAVE.
3. Press the UTILITY button once again to return to normal operation.
• MARK SEARCH buttons • LAST REC SEARCH buttons • PITCH button
• ADJUST button • PAUSE button • Locate to a specified time
• Shuttle playback • Repeat playback • Auto punch-in/out
• Punch-in/out using a foot switch • MMC reception • x1/2 playback
Synchronized recording on a slave MD4S
If you first put the MTC slave MD4S into Record-Pause mode, then you will be able to per-
form Record-Start and Pause operations from the MTC master MD4S.
1. On the slave MD4S, press a REC SELECT button or the BUS button + REC
SELECT button to select the track(s) for recording.
2. Press the REC button of the slave MD4S.
The slave MD4S will enter record-pause mode. If you press the REHE button instead of the
REC button, it will enter rehearsal-pause mode.
Tip: The MTC Master device can be a Yamaha MD8 or MD4 as well as another MD4S.
Note: On the MD4S that is being used as the slave, the following buttons and functions
cannot be used.
Note: When the slave MD4S is in record-pause or rehearsal-pause mode, its EDIT,
UTILITY, and SONG SEARCH buttons cannot be used.
5 / 6 7 / 8
CUE MIX TO STEREO
CH1
BUS
CH2
REC SELECT
CH3 CH4
LRLR
010010
IN THRUOUT
MIDI
MIC/LINE INPUT
3
21
4 5678
LINE INPUT
AUX SEND
INSERT
I/O
INSERT
I/O
TRACK
DIRECT OUT
STEREO
OUT
2TR IN MONITOR
OUT
12
1234
1
GAIN
CUE
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
PB
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
2
GAIN
CUE
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
PB
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
3
GAIN
CUE
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
PB
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
4
GAIN
CUE
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
PB
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
5 / 6 7 / 8
CUE MIX TO STEREO
CH1
BUS
CH2
REC SELECT
CH3 CH4
LRLR
010010
IN THRUOUT
MIDI
MIC/LINE INPUT
3
21
4 5678
LINE INPUT
AUX SEND
INSERT
I/O
INSERT
I/O
TRACK
DIRECT OUT
STEREO
OUT
2TR IN MONITOR
OUT
12
1234
1
GAIN
CUE
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
PB
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
2
GAIN
CUE
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
PB
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
3
GAIN
CUE
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
PB
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
4
GAIN
CUE
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
PB
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
MIDI
OUT
MIDI IN
STEREO OUT
MTC
MTC SYNC
MASTER
MTC SYNC
SLAVE
MTC master MTC slave
96 Advanced recording techniques
—Owner’s Manual
3. Start the master MD4S (playback/record/rehearsal).
The slave MD4S will receive the MTC messages, and will record/rehearse in synchronization
with the location of the master.
4. When you press the STOP button on the master MD4S, the slave MD4S will
also stop.
Synchronized playback of a slave MD4S
If you first set the MTC slave MD4S to playback-pause mode, playback-start and pause opera-
tions can be performed from the MTC master MD4S.
1. Press the PLAY button on the slave MD4S.
The slave MD4S will enter playback-pause mode.
2. Start the master MD4S running (play/record/rehearsal).
The slave MD4S will receive MTC, and will begin playing in synchronization with the master
MD4S.
3. Press the STOP button on the master MD4S, and the slave MD4S will return
to playback-pause mode.
At this time if you start the master MD4S running, the slave MD4S will chase to the location
of the master and will resume synchronized playback.
Tip: It is also possible to manually punch-in/out on the slave MD4S. In this case, press the
PLAY button instead of the REC button in step 2, and then start the MTC master MD4S.
When you reach the desired punch-in point, press the REC button of the slave unit. When
you reach the punch-out point, press the PLAY button of the slave unit.
Note: The MTC slave MD4S will require a certain length of time after receiving MTC before
it reaches a stable state of synchronization. If you will be recording on the MTC slave MD4S,
start the master unit running (play/record/rehearsal) at least 10 seconds ahead of the location
where you wish to begin recording.
Note: If the Pitch function of the MTC master MD4S is turned on, the MTC slave MD4S
may be unable to synchronize accurately. As far as possible, please turn off the Pitch function
of the MTC master.
Note: When you first record a new song on the MTC slave MD4S, you must begin
synchronized operation from the beginning of the song (the “000:00:00” location) on the
MTC master MD4S.
Note: The MTC slave MD4S is able to receive an MTC frame rate of 30 frames/second. If
you are using a device other than an MD4S as the MTC master, you must set the frame rate
to 30 frames/second.
Note: If you are synchronizing to an MTC master other than another MD4S (i.e., a MIDI
sequencer etc.), you must use a dedicated MTC output connector on the MTC master, or
output the MTC from a separate MIDI output connector. If MIDI playback data is merged
with MTC data, the MTC slave MD4S may be unable to synchronize accurately.
MIDI functions 97
—Owner’s Manual
Synchronizing to MTC with a specied offset (time difference)
When using the MD4S as an MTC slave, you can assign an offset (time difference) that will be
applied to the MTC time data received from the external device.
1. If the MTC slave MD4S is in record/playback/rehearsal-pause mode, press the
STOP button to defeat pause mode.
2. On the slave unit, press the UTILITY button, rotate the DATA dial to make the
display read MTC Offset, and press the ENTER button.
The display will indicate the current offset value as hours/minutes/seconds/frames. With the
factory settings, this will read “00:00:00.00.
3. Use the CURSOR shuttle to select the hours/minutes/seconds/frames parame-
ters, and rotate the DATA dial to specify the value.
You can specify an offset in the range of “00:00:00.00” to “23:59:59.29.
For example if you specify an offset value of “00:01:00.00, an MTC master location of
“00:01:00.00” will be considered by the MTC slave MD4S as a location of “00:00:00.00” (the
display will indicate “000:00.00”) for synchronization purposes.
If you specify an offset value of “23:59:00.00, an MTC master location of “23:59:00.00” will be
considered by the MTC slave MD4S as a location of “00:00:00.00” (the display will indicate
“000:00.00”), and an MTC master location of “00:00:00.00” will be considered by the slave as
“00:01:00.00” (the display will indicate “001:00.00”).
4. Press the UTILITY button to return to normal operation.
Note: The offset setting affects only the MTC slave MD4S. Even if you specify an offset for
the MTC master MD4S, it will not affect the MTC that is transmitted from the MTC master.
FramesSecondsMinutesHours
00:01:00.00
(MTC)
00:00:00.00
(MD4S display)
00:00:00.00
(MTC)
001:00.00
(MD4S display)
23:59:00.00
(MTC)
000:00.00
(MD4S display)
00:01:00.00
With an offset setting of
23:59:00.00
With an offset setting of
MTC master
MTC slave
MTC master
MTC slave
98 Advanced recording techniques
—Owner’s Manual
Controlling the MD4S by MMC
MMC (MIDI Machine Control) is a type of MIDI message that allows the transport of an
audio/video recorder etc. to be controlled by an external MIDI device. Since the MD4S is able
to receive MMC, an MMC-compatible MIDI sequencer or other device can control the trans-
port of the MD4S. In this case, the device that transmits MMC data will be the MMC Master,
and the device that receives MMC data will be the MMC Slave.
The MD4S supports the following MMC messages.
Switching MMC reception on/off
You can specify whether or not the MD4S will receive MMC.
1. Press the UTILITY button, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read
MMC Receive, and press the ENTER button.
The display will indicate the current MMC reception setting. With the factory settings this is
off, and the display will indicate “MMC Rx OFF.
2. Rotate the DATA dial to switch the setting ON or OFF.
When this is “ON, MMC can be received.
3. Press the ENTER button to conrm the setting.
Function MMC# MD4S operation
Stop Command 01
If this command is received during recording,
rehearsal, or playback etc., that operation will be
halted.
Playback Command 02, 03
When this command is received, playback will
begin. If this command is received during record-
ing or rehearsal, that operation will be halted.
Fast-forward Command 04
Skip to the next song. If this command is received
during recording or rehearsal, that operation will
be halted.
Rewind Command 05
Skip to the previous song. If this command is
received during recording or rehearsal, that opera-
tion will be halted.
Record Strobe Command 06
If this command is received when stopped, record-
ing will begin. If this command is received during
playback, punch-in will be performed. If received
while paused, this command will be ignored.
End Record Command 07 Record mode will be turned off.
Paus Command 09
Enter pause mode. If received during record or
rehearsal, stop.
MMC Reset Command 0D
Reset MMC data to the initial settings (the condi-
tion at power-on).
Write Command 40 Write data to the specied data eld.
Locate Command 44 Locate to the specied time code location.
Record Mode Data eld 4C Switch between REHE and REC.
Track Record Ready Data eld 4F
Select the track to be recorded by Record
Strobe.
MIDI functions 99
—Owner’s Manual
4. Press the UTILITY button or the EXIT button to return to normal operation.
If MMC reception was turned on, the MD4S will be the MMC Slave, and can be operated by
MMC messages received from the external device.
Setting the MMC Device ID
If there is more than one MMC slave, a single command will control all MMC slaves since
MMC commands are common to all devices. However in some cases (such as when specifying
the tracks for recording), you may wish to control only a specific MMC slave device. In such
cases, you can set the MMC Device ID so that the MMC master will control only a specific
MMC slave device.
1. Press the UTILITY button, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read
MMC Dev ID, and press the ENTER button.
The display will indicate the currently selected Device ID. With the factory settings, the Device
ID is set to 1, and the display will indicate “DEV ID 1.
2. Rotate the DATA dial to select the Device ID (1127).
3. Press the ENTER button to conrm the selection.
4. Press the UTILITY button or the EXIT button to return to normal operation.
Tip: This setting is remembered even if the power is turned off.
Note: Set the MMC Master device so that it will transmit MMC to the ID you specified here.
Tip: This setting is remembered even if the MD4S is turned off.
100 Appendix
—Owner’s Manual
Appendix
Q&A Section
This section is intended to answer your questions about the MD4S and MD DATA discs.
Whats the difference between MiniDiscs and MD DATA Discs?
MiniDiscs were designed to store mono and stereo sound data. MD DATA discs were origi-
nally designed to store computer data. Ideal for use with digital cameras. However, they can
also be used to store mono, stereo, and four-channel sound data. Thats how MD4S uses them.
Can the MD4S use normal MiniDiscs?
Yes, but only for 2-track or mono recording and playback. MiniDiscs recorded on the MD4S
can be played on normal MiniDisc decks.
Are Yamaha MD8 and MD4 discs compatible with the MD4S?
All discs recorded on the Yamaha MD4 can be used by the MD4S. Discs recorded on the
Yamaha MD8 can be used by the MD4S if they are converted by the MD8 to 4TR mode.
What happens if I insert an MD DATA Disc into a MiniDisc deck?
The disc will not be recognized. MiniDisc decks cannot use MD DATA discs.
How long is the life of an MD DATA disc?
So long as the disc is not damaged physically, it has an infinite life span. Even after one million
record and playback operations there is no signal degradation.
Do I need to format an MD DATA Disc before recording with the MD4S?
Yes and no. The MD4S uses MD DATA discs straight out of the wrapper. No fuss. An
MD DATA disc that has been used to store computer data, however, must be erased before use
with MD4S.
What is the available recording time?
This depends on the Recording mode: 37 minutes for four-track (4TR), 74 minutes for stereo
(2TR), and 148 minutes for mono (MONO).
What is the frame counter?
A frame is an integral part of the MD DATA disc format. One frame can hold 11.6 ms of data
(i.e., 512 samples of ATRAC sound data at 44.1 kHz). There are approximately 86 frames to a
second. Using the FrameDisp function you can select between 86 (MD) and 30 (MTC) frames
per second.
Is the sound quality affected by repeated ping-pong operations?
No—thanks to digital recording technology. Note, however, that the MD4S mixer is analog, so
after many ping-pong operations slight signal degradation may occur, although this is still
insignificant when compared to tape-based analog recorders.
Troubleshooting 101
—Owner’s Manual
Do I have to sacrice one track to record timecode?
No. The MD4S generates MTC (MIDI Timecode) or MIDI Clock from the disc’s internal sync
signals. So even in a synchronized MIDI system, all eight tracks are available for sound record-
ing.
How many songs can I store on an MD DATA disc?
Up to 254.
Do I have to clean the MD4S heads?
No.
Troubleshooting
If you’re having difficulty operating the MD4S or if it doesn’t seem to work as expected, look
up the symptoms in the following table and follow the advice provided.
Symptom Advice
The MD4S cannot be turned
on!
Make sure the power cord is connected to a suitable AC wall outlet
and plugged into the AC IN connector at the rear of the MD4S.
Make sure that the MD4S POWER switch is set to the ON position.
If you still cannot turn on your MD4S, contact your Yamaha dealer.
Cannot listen to a connected
music source!
Make sure that the MONITOR LEVEL control is raised, and that the
FLIP switches and MONITOR SELECT switches are set appropriately.
If the FLIP switch is in the MIC/LINE ( ) position, raise the fader
of the corresponding input channel and the STEREO fader, and turn
on the MONITOR SELECT STEREO switch. If the FLIP switch is in the
PB ( ) position, raise the CUE LEVEL control of the correspond-
ing input channel and the STEREO fader, and turn on the MONI-
TOR SELECT CUE switch.
Cannot record four tracks!
Are you using a MiniDisc? Please use MD DATA discs.
Make sure that the 4TR recording mode is selected.
Cannot record!
Make sure the discs write protect tab is set to unprotect.
Make sure that the x1/2 Play function is not on.
Press a REC SELECT button, or the BUS button + REC SELECT button,
and make sure that the track is ready to record.
Make sure that the signal that you wish to record has been selected
as the recording source for the appropriate track. Use the CUE LEVEL
control to check whether the signal is actually being sent to the
track.
Cannot rehearse!
You cannot rehearse the rst recording on a blank disc or blank area.
Record something rst, then use the Rehearse function.
The level meters do not indi-
cate signal levels!
Press a REC SELECT button, or the BUS button + REC SELECT button,
and make sure that the desired track is ready to record. Next, press
the REC button or the REHE button, and make sure that the MD4S is
in record-pause or rehearsal-pause mode.
Cannot use the Auto Punch
In/Out function!
Make sure that the track you wish to record has been selected.
Make sure that the auto punch-in/out points have been specied. If
they have been specied, the IN and OUT point indicators will be lit.
Make sure that the auto punch-out point has not been set at a loca-
tion that is earlier than the auto punch-in point.
102 Appendix
—Owner’s Manual
Cannot use the punch-in/out
or ping-pong recording
function!
In some cases, punch-in or ping-pong recording may not be possi-
ble on a song that was edited on an MD recorder other than the
MD4S or the Yamaha MD8/MD4. Use the Song Copy function to
copy the song, and perform the punch-in/out or ping-pong record-
ing operation on the copy.
If the song was recorded on an MD recorder other than the MD4S
or the Yamaha MD8/MD4, it is possible that the song may be copy-
protected (by SCMS). In this case, it will not be possible to perform
punch-in or ping-pong recording.
Recordings play back at the
wrong pitch!
Make sure that the Pitch function is not set to VARI.
Make sure that the 1/2 Play function is turned off.
Cannot use Part Copy or Part
Erase!
Make sure that the Last Record In/Out points have been set. If they
have been set, the IN/OUT point indicators will light.
Make sure that the Last Record Out point has not been set in a loca-
tion earlier than the Last Record In point.
The signal of the input chan-
nel is not output from the
AUX SEND jacks!
Rotate the AUX control toward 1 or 2, and raise the channel fader.
Since the signal sent to the AUX SEND jacks is post-fader, no signal
will be sent to the AUX SEND jacks unless the channel fader is raised.
Cannot play the Cue List!
Make sure not all steps in the Cue List are set for zero repeats (n=0).
Make sure that the specied ranges within the cue list are correct.
Make sure that no non-existent markers are selected in the cue list.
MIDI sequencer does not
synchronize to the MD4S!
Make sure that your MIDI sequencer supports MTC or MIDI Clock.
Make sure that the MIDI sequencer has been set to synchronize to
incoming MTC or MIDI Clock messages.
If you are using MIDI Clock, make sure that a tempo map has been
programmed in the MD4S.
(If the measure/beat display does not appear when you press the
DISPLAY button, a tempo map has not been set.)
Make sure that the MD4S has been set to transmit MTC or MIDI
Clock messages from its MIDI OUT connector. When MTC is being
transmitted, the MTC SYNC MASTER indicator will light. When MIDI
Clock is being transmitted, the MIDI CLK indicator will light.
Make sure that X1/2 Play is turned off. If X1/2 Play is on, synchroni-
zation is not possible.
If you are using a Repeat function such as A-B Repeat, some time
may be required for the MIDI sequencer to synchronize during a
repeat, due to the slowness of the MD4S locate function.
Symptom Advice
Display Messages 103
—Owner’s Manual
Display Messages
Message Meaning
ADJST Stop
The STOP button was pressed, so the Adjust function was cancelled.
BLANK X The MD4S is located at the Blank Top position.
Blank Disc The disc is blank.
Cant Combn
MD4S cannot combine these two songs because they were not split using the
Song Divide function, or MD4S cannot edit this type of song.
Cant Copy This song cannot be copied because its copy protected.
Cant REC
The MD4S cannot record over this type of song, so you cannot overwrite this
song.
Cant Rehe
The MD4S does not have permission to record in this mode, so you cannot
rehearse a recording that would overwrite this song.
CLK OFF!
MIDI Clock was turned OFF automatically because you selected the Program
Play or Cue List function.
Copy Stop
The STOP button was pressed, so the Song Copy, Track Copy, Part Copy, or Cue
List Copy function was cancelled.
DiscErr xx A disc scratch or defect was discovered while recording. Replace the disc.
Disc FULL
The disc is full. You cannot record any more data or additional takes (Multi Take
Auto Punch In).
Erase Stop
The STOP button was pressed, so the Track Erase or Part Erase function was can-
celled.
Erase Warn!
This song has been write protected by another recorder. Press the ENTER button
to erase or the EXIT button to cancel.
Error xx A fatal error occurred. Contact your Yamaha dealer.
IN/OUT Err The IN or OUT point is not valid, so you cannot use Auto Punch In/Out.
InvalidSong Since this song is not compatible with the MD4S, it cannot be played.
List Error The cue list is invalid.
MARK Failed
No more markers can be inserted because the song contains the maximum of
eight, or you tried to insert a marker at the position of an existing marker.
Move Stop The STOP button was pressed, so the Song Move function was cancelled.
MTC OFF!
MTC was turned OFF automatically because you selected the Program Play or
Cue List function.
No Blank No blank area can be found for further recording.
No Disc No disc is loaded.
PNCH Abort
Because the STOP button was pressed, the off-line punch-in/out function was
aborted.
Protected The discs write protect tab is set to protect, so you cannot record.
Reading TOC The MD4S is reading the TOC from disc.
Reload Disc The MD4S is waiting for you to reload the disc.
Save Warn ! Not all the Tempo Map steps can be saved because the data area is full.
UTOC FULL The TOC area is full, so not all of the song title or Tempo Map could be saved.
Writing TOC The MD4S is writing the TOC to disc.
104 Appendix
—Owner’s Manual
Modes of the MD4S transport
On z Flashing
Mode
Indicators
MD4S operating Status
REHE REC PLAY
Stop ———No activity.
Play —— Normal playback
Play Pause ——
z
Playback is paused.
Cue FF ——
High-speed playback at 1/2 speed or 2X, 4X,
8X, 16X or 32X speed.
Review ——
High-speed reverse playback at 2X, 4X, 8X,
16X or 32X speed.
Record Pause
z
Recording is paused.
Record ●●Recording in progress.
Rehearse Pause
z
——Rehearsal is paused.
Rehearse Rehearsal in progress.
New Record ●●A new song is being recorded.
New Record Pause
z
New song recording is paused.
Auto Punch Record Standby
z
The Auto Punch In/Out function has been acti-
vated and the MD4S is standing by to start the
Auto Punch recording sequence.
Play Record Wait
z
The Auto Punch recording sequence has
started and is currently between the Pre-Roll
point and the Punch IN point.
Auto Punch Rehearse Standby
z
——
The Auto Punch In/Out Rehearse function has
been activated and the MD4S is standing by to
start the Auto Punch rehearsal sequence.
Play Rehearse Wait
z
The Auto Punch rehearsal sequence has
started and is currently between the Pre-Roll
point and the Punch IN point.
Specifications 105
—Owner’s Manual
Specications
Recorder
Mixer
0 dB is referenced to 0.775 V r.m.s.
Digital/Audio
Sampling Frequency: 44.1 kHz Compression: ATRAC
Frequency Response: 20 Hz20 kHz, +1 dB, 3 dB
THD+N: Less than 0.02% (1 kHz)
S/N: 96 dB typ.
Rec/Play
4-track independent simultaneous record/play (Recording time: 37 min)
Dubbing with 4-track playback
Auto & Manual Punch In/Out (11.6 ms accuracy)
Four-track (37 min), Stereo (74 min), or Mono (148 min) record/play
Repeat play A-B, Single song, All song
Vari-pitch (±10%)
Locate
Start and End point of Song Direct Time Locate
10 Marker locate points for each song Last Recording In/Out point
Cue & review 0.5x, 2x, 4x, 8x, 16x, 32x play speed
Disc Editing Disc Erase
Song Editing Copy, Move, Divide, Combine, Renumber, Erase
Track Editing Track Copy, Part Copy, Track Erase, Part Erase
Title Editing Disc title, Song title
Panel Controls
REC SELECT buttons 14, BUS button
Transport buttons: PLAY, STOP, PAUSE, REC, REHE, SONG SEARCH, EJECT
Mode buttons: AUTO PUNCH I/O, EDIT, UTILITY, ADJUST, PITCH, PEAK HOLD, DIS-
PLAY, EXIT
CURSOR shuttle/DATA dial
Locate buttons: MARK, MARK SEARCH, LAST REC (IN/OUT), SEARCH, SET, REPEAT,
AB
MIDI MIDI IN, OUT, THRU jacks
Display FLD (Fluorescent Display)
Inputs
MIC/LINE IN (CH1, 2) Balanced phone jack x2 (10 to 50 dB)
MIC/LINE IN (CH1, 2) Balanced XLR x2 (10 to 50 dB)
MIC/LINE INPUT (CH34) Unbalanced phone jack x2 (10 to 50 dB)
LINE INPUT (CH58) Unbalanced phone jack x4 (10 dB)
INSERT IN/OUT (CH 1, 2) TRS phone jack x2 (10 dB)
2TR IN (L, R) Phono x2 (10 dB)
Outputs
TRACK DIRECT OUT (14) Phono x4(10 dB)
STEREO OUT (L, R) Phono x2 (10 dB)
MONITOR OUT (L, R) Phono x2 (10 dB)
AUX SEND (1, 2) Phone jack x2 (10 dB)
PHONES OUT Stereo phone jack (840 )
Frequency response 20 Hz20 kHz +1, 3 dB
EQ
3-band, ±15 dB (LOW: 100 Hz shelving, MID: Peaking (2.5 kHz), HIGH: 10 kHz Shelv-
ing)
MASTER Channel
Features
Stereo Fader (45 mm), Monitor Level control, Monitor Select buttons (2TR IN, STEREO,
CUE), CUE MIX TO STEREO buttons
106 Appendix
—Owner’s Manual
General
Dimensions
Specifications subject to change without notice.
Power Requirements USA & Canada: 120 V/60 Hz, Others: 230 V/50 Hz
Power Consumption 24 W
Dimensions (W x H x D) 413 x 109.5 x 388 mm
Weight 5.2 kg
Operating Conditions Temperature: 5˚C35˚C (41˚F95˚F), Humidity: 10%95%
Supplied Accessories AC power cord, Owner’s Manual
Optional Accessories FC5 Footswitch
W: 413
H: 109.5
D: 388
Unit: mm
Block Diagram 107
—Owner’s Manual
Block Diagram
REC
* MIC/LINE INPUT jacks 1 and 2 accept either phone or XLR plugs.
2
CH4
CH3
CH2
(PB)
Tr 2
Tr 3
Tr 4
2 *
1 *
R
L
2TR IN
2TR IN
CUE
CUE MIX TO STEREO
STEREO
MONITOR LEVEL
RL
CUE
LINE
INPUT
7/8
8
7
6
5/6
5
DIRECT OUT
TRACK
4
3
4
3
GAIN
HA
LOW
HIGH
PA N
REC
Recorder
PB
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
3 Band EQ
MID
to Meter
OFF
AUX
CUE LEVEL CUE PAN
PB
GAIN
HA
LOW
HIGH
PA N
REC
Recorder
PB
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
3 Band EQ
MID
to Meter
OFF
AUX
CUE LEVEL CUE PAN
PB
GAIN
HA
INSERT I/O
LOW
HIGH
PA N
REC
Recorder
PB
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
3 Band EQ
MID
INPUT
MIC/LINE
to Meter
OFF
AUX
CUE LEVEL CUE PAN
PB
PB
CUE PANCUE LEVEL
AUX
1
CH1
OFF
to Meter
from
Tr 1
Tr 2
Tr 3
Tr 4
STEREO
MID
3 Band EQ
LINE
MIC/
FLIP
PHONES
MONITOR
OUT
R
L
R
L
OUT
STEREO
PB
Tr 1
Recorder
REC
PA N
21
AUX
RL
ST
HIGH
LOW
INSERT I/O
HA
GAIN
AUX SEND
L
R
1
2
L
R
Only one plug can be inserted in each jack.
108 Appendix
—Owner’s Manual
Glossary
This section explains the technical terms used in this owner’s manual.
ATRAC—An acronym for Adaptive Transform Acoustic Coding. This is the compression
technique used to fit the same amount of data as that of a 120 mm CD on a 64 mm MiniDisc.
Using the ATRAC system, the MD4S provides an 4-track recording time of 37 minutes.
ATRAC uses established psychoacoustic principles to compress audio data to approximately
one-fifth of its original size, with virtually no loss in sound quality. The threshold of hearing
principle states that the sensitivity of the human ear is frequency dependent. Two tones of the
same level but at different frequencies will not be heard at the same loudness. Another princi-
ple used is the masking effect. That is, softer sounds become inaudible when louder sounds at
similar frequencies are present.
Bus—A “bus” is a route for audio signals to which the signal from each input channel can be
distributed, and which can be sent to its own output jack. The MD4S has the following buses.
ST bus: Input channel signals are mixed in stereo to the stereo bus, and output from the STE-
REO OUT jacks.
CUE bus: Signals from each input channel and the track playback are mixed in stereo to the
Cue bus, and output from the MONITOR OUT jacks and the PHONES jack. The output sig-
nal of this bus is mainly used to monitor signals during recording.
AUX bus: Signals from each input channel are mixed in monaural to the AUX buses, and
output from the AUX OUT jacks. The output signal of these buses are mainly used as sends to
external effect processors, etc.
Clipping—The unwanted distortion effect of overloading an audio circuit with a signal that
is too large. Care must be taken when setting the MD4S GAIN controls so as not to overload
the recording circuits. See “Recording the first track (Direct Recording)” on page 26.
Cue List—The Cue List function allows you to compile a cue list (i.e., a sequence of cues for
playback) using markers. Cues are loaded into memory for continuous, uninterrupted play-
back. A new song can be created from the Cue List using the Cue List Copy function. See “Cue
List playback on page 68 for more information.
DAT—An acronym for Digital Audio Tape. DAT recorders are especially popular in recording
studios for recording the final stereo mix.
EQ—An acronym for an audio equalizer. The MD4S input channels feature three-band EQ.
Foot switch—A foot operated switch. Several MD4S transport functions and the punch in/
out function can be controlled using an optional footswitch.
Frame—An integral unit of the MD DATA disc format. One frame can hold 11.6 ms of data
(i.e., 512 samples of ATRAC sound data at 44.1 kHz). There are approximately 86 frames in a
second. Using the FrameDisp function you can select between 86 (MD) and 30 (MTC) frames
per second.
Input channel—An “input channel” is a section of the mixer that individually processes an
input signal. After a signal is input to an input channel, it is sent through the EQ to adjust its
tone, its volume level is adjusted, and then it is routed to a variety of output jacks.
Locate—To “locate” means to move to a specific point in the song. The MD4S provides a
variety of Locate functions that allow you to jump instantly to the desired location. See “Quick
search functions on page 61 for more information.
MD DATA—A compact data storage medium designed to store computer-type data.
Although similar to MiniDiscs, they are not interchangeable. MD DATA discs come in two
varieties: playback only and rewritable. MD4S uses the rewritable type for recording. See
“Buying discs for the MD4S” on page 10 for more information.
Glossary 109
—Owner’s Manual
MIDI—An acronym for Musical Instrument Digital Interface. An internationally agreed stan-
dard that allows electronic musical instruments and audio equipment to communicate.
MIDI Clock—A clock signal transmitted as MIDI data. MIDI Clock refers to a timing signal
and Start, Continue, and Stop commands. The MD4S can supply MIDI Clock to a MIDI
sequencer for synchronized operation.
MIDI Song Position Pointer—A type of MIDI message that is used to derive position
information from a MIDI Clock signal. The MD4S generates MIDI Song Position Pointers. So
no matter where you start playback in a song, your MIDI sequencer will locate to that point
and then play along in synchronization.
MIDI Timecode (MTC)—An addition to the MIDI Standard that allows audio equipment
to be synchronized. MIDI Timecode contains clock and position information. MD4S can sup-
ply MTC to a MIDI sequencer for synchronized operation.
MiniDisc—A compact data storage medium designed to store music. MiniDiscs come in two
varieties: playback only and recordable. MiniDiscs can only be used for 2-track or mono
recording with the MD4S. MiniDiscs recorded on the MD4S can be played on a normal Mini-
Disc deck. See also Random Access, ATRAC, and MD DATA Disc.
Mixdown—“Mixdown (also called “track-down”) is the process of mixing two or more pre-
viously-recorded tracks into a stereo mix, and recording the result on an external master
recorder.
Monitor CUE—The cue monitor allows you to monitor individual tracks as they are being
recorded or played back. In Record Pause mode and during recording, the CUE monitor
source is the signal being recorded (i.e., the input signal). For playback the CUE monitor
source is from disc (i.e., the signal that was recorded to disc). This is useful with the punch in/
out functions, because you can monitor the recorded signal up to the specified IN point, and
then the new signal that’s being recorded up to the OUT point.
Overdub Recording—“Overdubbing” is the process of recording a new performance while
monitoring other previously-recorded tracks.
Panning—A technique used to position sounds in a stereo mix.
PB—An abbreviation for Playback. This abbreviation appears next to the input selector
switch on each input channel and is used to select the disc signal as the source for the input
channel.
Phone Jack—A 1/4-inch socket commonly used on audio equipment.
Phono Jack—Also know as an RCA jack, this type of connector is often used on semiprofes-
sional audio and video equipment.
Ping-Pong—“Ping-pong” recording is the process of mixing two or more previously-
recorded tracks, and re-recording the mix to one or two other tracks.
Pre-Roll Time—For Auto Punch In/Out, this is the time before the IN point at which play-
back starts. See “Setting the pre-roll/post-roll times on page 55 for more information.
Post Fader—A point in the signal path after a fader. The signals for the MD4S AUX controls
are sourced post-fader. So as well as turn up the AUX control, you must also raise the fader.
This has the advantage that the level of the processed signal from the external effects processor
depends on the level of the unprocessed signal that is controlled by the fader.
Post-Roll Time—For Auto Punch In/Out, this is the time after the OUT point at which play-
back stops. See “Setting the pre-roll/post-roll times on page 55 for more information.
Punch In/Out—A recording technique that allows you to rerecord specific sections of an
existing track. The MD4S provides both manual and automatic punch in/out operations.
Random Access—The ability to access data instantly. The MD4S quick locate functions
allow you to locate any point instantly. Tape-based recorders do not have random access capa-
bilities because they have to wind a tape, which takes time.
110 Appendix
—Owner’s Manual
SCMS (Serial Copy Management System)—A protection system intended to prevent
illegal copying of music. SCMS allows one-time serial copying of copy-protected material. If
the source is not copy protected, it’s possible to make any number of digital-to-digital copies
of the material. If the source is copy protected, however, its possible to make a first-generation
copy, but further copies cannot be made from the first-generation copy. SCMS is only effective
when copying via digital connections. Recordings made via analog connections are not
affected.
Signal to Noise Ratio (S/N)—In an audio system, the difference between the nominal sig-
nal level and the residual noise floor, usually expressed as a ratio in decibels. It’s used as a mea-
sure of an audio systems noise performance.
Tempo Map—A map containing the tempo and meter information for a song.
TOC—An acronym for Table Of Contents. An area of the MD DATA disc used to store infor-
mation about what is recorded on the disc, the disc title, song titles, and so on.
Tracking—A “track” is an area used to record and playback an individual audio signal. The
MD4S has four tracks, each of which can be recorded/played independently. Recorders like the
MD4S which have multiple tracks are called “multi-track recorders” (MTR).
Unity Gain—A gain of one. That is, the signal is output from a circuit at the same level at
which it entered. Once passed the MIC/LINE amplifier, a unity gain system minimizes signal
noise and distortion. The unity gain position for the MD4S faders is at the 7–8 mark.
Tempo Map Chart 111
—Owner’s Manual
Tempo Map Chart
Meter
Tempo
Step
Measure
Time
Signature
Step Measure -Beat Tempo
A
001 /
A
0011
B
/
B
C
/
C
D
/
D
E
/
E
F
/
F
G
/
G
H
/
H
I
/
I
J
/
J
K
/
K
L
/
L
M
/
M
N
/
N
O
/
O
P
/
P
Q
/
Q
R
/
R
S
/
S
T
/
T
U
/
U
V
/
V
W
/
W
X
/
X
Y
/
Y
Z
/
Z
YAMAHA [Multitrack Recorder] Date: 11 02 1998
Model: MD4S
MIDI Implementation Chart
Version: 1.0
Function... Transmitted Recognized Remarks
Basic
Channel
Default
Changed
X
X
X
X
Mode
Default
Messages
Altered
X
X
**************
X
X
X
Note
Number True Voice
X
**************
X
X
Velocity
Note On
Note Off
X
X
X
X
After
Touch
Keys
Chs
X
X
X
X
Pitch bend X X
Control
Change
XX
Prog
Change :True#
X
**************
X
X
System Exclusive X O *1
System
Common
:Song Pos
:Song Sel
:Tune
O
X
X
X
X
X
*2
System
Real Time
:Clock
:Commands
O
O
X
X
Aux
Messages
:Local ON/OFF
:All Notes OFF
:Active Sense
:Reset
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Notes
MTC quarter frame messages are received in MTC Sync slave mode
MTC quarter frame messages are transmitted in MTC Sync master
mode.
*1: MMC
*2: During MIDI Clock synchronization
Mode 1: OMNI ON, POLY
Mode 3: OMNI OFF, POLY
Mode 2: OMNI ON, MONO
Mode 4: OMNI OFF, MONO
O: Yes
X: No
Index 113
—Owner’s Manual
Index
Numerics
2TR IN jacks
23
2-track (2TR)
11
4-track (4TR)
11
A
A B button
68
A-B Repeat
68
A B repeat button
17
AC IN
23
Adding sounds during mixdown
42
ADJUST button
18
63
65
Advanced recording techniques
35
All Song Repeat
67
Applying an effect during ping-pong
recording
48
Applying an effect only to the monitor
signal
50
Applying effects
44
Applying effects during mixdown
47
ATRAC
108
AUTO PUNCH I/O button
17
Auto punch indicator
21
auto punch-in point
55
auto punch-in/out
55
56
58
auto punch-in/out points
62
auto punch-out point
55
AUX bus
108
AUX control
14
AUX SEND 1, 2 jacks
23
AUX SEND jacks
46
B
backward (review)
66
blank area
12
27
Bus
108
BUS button
17
C
Check the recording level
27
Clipping
108
CUE bus
108
Cue List
68
69
70
108
cue mix function
15
43
CUE MIX indicator
20
CUE MIX TO STEREO switch
15
43
CUE PAN/CUE LEVEL controls
14
Cue/Review
66
CURSOR shuttle
18
D
DAT
108
DATA dial (DATA+ –)
18
DATA dial and CURSOR shuttle
61
direct recording
26
disc
10
disc contents
86
Disc Erase
86
Disc transport buttons
16
Display
19
display brightness
88
DISPLAY button
18
Display Massages
103
E
EDIT button
18
Editing functions
73
EJECT button
17
end marker
63
ENTER button
18
EQ
108
EQ controls
14
EXIT button
18
extend the length of Song
12
79
81
86
F
Fader
14
Find a blank area
27
FIX (fixed)
84
FLIP switch
13
Foot switch
54
89
108
Frame
88
108
Function buttons
18
G
GAIN control
13
I
IN, OUT indicators
21
Input channel
108
INSERT I/O jacks
22
44
Inserting a marker
62
L
LAST REC SEARCH [IN] button
62
LAST REC SEARCH [IN]/[OUT]
button
17
LAST REC SEARCH [OUT] button
62
last record in point
55
62
last record out point
55
62
Level (5/6), (7/8) controls
15
LINE INPUT 5~8 jacks
22
Locate
108
M
Manual punch-in/out
52
53
54
MARK button
17
62
MARK SEARCH [ ]/[ ] button
17
62
Marker indicators
21
63
Markers
62
MD DATA
10
108
MIC/LINE INPUT 1,2 jacks
22
MIC/LINE INPUT 3, 4 jacks
22
MIDI
109
Implementation chart
112
MIDI Clock
91
92
109
MIDI functions
90
MIDI IN connector
24
MIDI IN, OUT, THRU connectors
24
MIDI indicators
20
MIDI OUT connector
24
MIDI Song Position Pointer
91
109
MIDI THRU connector
24
MIDI Timecode (MTC)
109
MiniDisc
10
109
Mixdown
32
109
Mixing multiple channels as you
record
36
MMC (MIDI Machine Control)
98
MMC Device ID
99
MMC Master
98
114
Index
—Owner’s Manual
MMC Slave
98
monaural (MONO)
11
Monitor CUE
109
MONITOR LEVEL control
15
MONITOR OUT jacks
23
MONITOR SELECT switches
15
Monitor/Master section
15
Mono Inputs
13
MTC
91
94
MTC Master
94
MTC Slave
94
Multi-take
58
O
One Song Repeat
67
Overdub Recording
109
Overdubbing
30
P
PAN control
14
Part Copy
73
Part Erase
74
PAUSE button
16
PB
109
PEAK HOLD button
18
Phone Jack
109
PHONES jack
24
Phono Jack
109
Ping-Pong
109
Ping-pong recording
39
PITCH button
18
Pitch function
84
Pitch indicator
19
PLAY button
16
play forward (cue)
66
PLAY indicator
16
post-fader
14
109
post-roll point
55
Post-Roll Time
109
POWER switch
23
pre-roll point
55
Pre-Roll Time
109
pre-roll/post-roll times
55
Program Play
71
PUNCH I/O jack
24
89
Punch-in/out
52
53
54
109
Q
Quick search functions
61
R
Random Access
109
REC button
16
REC indicator
16
REC SELECT buttons
17
recording mode
11
76
87
Recording the first track
26
REHE button
16
REHE indicator
16
rehearsal function
52
Rehearsing
57
58
REPEAT button
17
67
Repeat function
67
Repeat indicator
21
S
SCMS
110
SET button
17
Signal to Noise Ratio
110
Single-take
56
Song Combine
80
Song Copy
76
Song Divide
79
Song Erase
78
Song Move
81
Song Renumber
82
SONG SEARCH [ ]/[ ]
buttons
17
61
songs
12
ST bus
108
start marker
63
Status indicators
19
STEREO fader
15
Stereo Inputs
15
Stereo level meter
20
STEREO OUT jacks
23
STOP button
11
STOP/TOC WRITE button
17
T
Tempo Map
92
110
Time counter
21
Time counter mode
20
Title and function display
19
Titling
85
TOC
11
110
TOC EDIT indicator
11
19
TOC WRITE button
11
Track Copy
75
TRACK DIRECT OUT 1~4 jacks
23
Track Erase
76
Track level meters
20
Track recording indicators
20
Tracking
110
U
Unity gain
14
110
UTILITY button
18
V
VARI (variable)
84
X
x1/2 Play
67
Source: Source: Source: Source: Source: Source:
1234
Tracking Sheet
Title:
Date:
Step:
Process:
Notes:
Session Info
Track List
Mixer Setup
Step Section Repeat
Cue List
Marker Log
5 / 6 7 / 8
STEREO
MONITOR LEVEL
CUE
STEREO
2TR IN
CUE MIX TO STEREO
MONITOR SELECT
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
010
MIN MAX
010
1
1
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
–15 +15
MID
–15 +15
LOW
–15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
2
2
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
–15 +15
MID
–15 +15
LOW
–15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
3
3
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
–15 +15
MID
–15 +15
LOW
–15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
4
4
GAIN
CUE
HIGH
LINE
FLIP
MIC/
LINE
MIC
LR
010
–15 +15
MID
–15 +15
LOW
–15 +15
PAN
LR
AUX
12
PB
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P
A
N
L
E
V
E
L
1
2
3
4 E10S
6
7
8
95
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
N
O
P
Q
R
S
T
U
V
W
X
Y
Z
YAMAHA CORPORATION
V291240 R2 1 IP 116 Pro Audio & Digital Musical Instrument Division
P.O. Box 3, Hamamatsu, 430-8651, Japan
01 03 1500 CP Printed in Japan

Transcripción de documentos

MULTITRACK MD RECORDER Owner’s Manual IN OUT MIDI 1 THRU MIC/LINE INPUT INSERT 3 I/O INSERT I/O 1 GAIN TRACK DIRECT OUT 2TR IN STEREO OUT 1 MONITOR OUT 2 AUX SEND 2 LINE MIC MIC/ LINE 2 GAIN LINE MIC MIC/ LINE PB FLIP LINE L 0 L 0 10 0 10 CH1 L CH4 0 1 2 3 4 L R L R PEAK HOLD DISPLAY EDIT UTILITY BUS R L E V E L 10 HIGH REC SELECT CH2 CH3 CUE MIX TO STEREO P A N R 0 7/8 PB L E V E L 10 HIGH 0 8 FLIP L E V E L 10 7 5/6 P A N R L E V E L 6 CUE P A N R 5 MIC MIC/ LINE CUE P A N HIGH LINE PB FLIP CUE 4 4 GAIN MIC MIC/ LINE PB FLIP CUE L 3 GAIN LINE INPUT MONITOR SELECT 10 EJECT 2TR IN HIGH MULTITRACK MD RECORDER –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 PITCH STEREO ADJUST CUE EXIT 1 2 PAN 1 2 PAN 1 2 PAN 1 2 L R ENTER MONITOR LEVEL PAN REPEAT L R L R L R MIN MARK SEARCH MAX MARK 10 10 10 10 10 10 9 9 9 9 9 9 8 8 8 8 8 8 7 7 7 7 7 7 6 6 6 6 6 6 5 5 5 5 5 5 4 4 4 4 4 4 3 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 A B LAST REC SEARCH IN AUTO PUNCH I/O REHE OUT SONG SEARCH REC PLAY SET PAUSE STOP DATA CURSOR TOC WRITE 1 2 3 4 STEREO PHONES PUNCH I/O E FCC INFORMATION (U.S.A.) 1. IMPORTANT NOTICE: DO NOT MODIFY THIS UNIT! This product, when installed as indicated in the instructions contained in this manual, meets FCC requirements. Modifications not expressly approved by Yamaha may void your authority, granted by the FCC, to use the product. 2. IMPORTANT: When connecting this product to accessories and/or another product use only high quality shielded cables. Cable/s supplied with this product MUST be used. Follow all installation instructions. Failure to follow instructions could void your FCC authorization to use this product in the USA. 3. NOTE: This product has been tested and found to comply with the requirements listed in FCC Regulations, Part 15 for Class “B” digital devices. Compliance with these requirements provides a reasonable level of assurance that your use of this product in a residential environment will not result in harmful interference with other electronic devices. This equipment generates/uses radio frequencies and, if not installed and used according to the instructions found in the users manual, may cause interference harmful to the operation of other electronic devices. Compliance with FCC regulations does not guarantee that interference will not occur in all installations. If this product is found to be the source of interference, which can be determined by turning the unit “OFF” and “ON”, please try to eliminate the problem by using one of the following measures: Relocate either this product or the device that is being affected by the interference. Utilize power outlets that are on different branch (circuit breaker or fuse) circuits or install AC line filter/s. In the case of radio or TV interference, relocate/reorient the antenna. If the antenna lead-in is 300 ohm ribbon lead, change the lead-in to coaxial type cable. If these corrective measures do not produce satisfactory results, please contact the local retailer authorized to distribute this type of product. If you can not locate the appropriate retailer, please contact Yamaha Corporation of America, Electronic Service Division, 6600 Orangethorpe Ave, Buena Park, CA 90620 Laser Diode Properties * Material : GaAlAs * Wavelength : 780–790 nm * Emission Duration : Continuous * Laser Output Power : Less than 44.6 µW (Note) Laser output is measured at a distance of 20cm from the object lens on the optical pick-up head. CLASS 1 LASER PRODUCT LUOKAN 1 LASERLAITE KLASS 1 LASERAPPARAT This unit is classified as a Class 1 laser product. This label is located on the exterior. Klassmärkning för Finland. CAUTION : INVISIBLE LASER RADIATION WHEN OPEN. AVOID EXPOSURE TO BEAM. VARNING : OSYNLIG LASERSTRÅLNING NÄR DENNA DEL ÄR ÖPPEND. STRÅLEN ÄR FARLIG. VARO! : NÄKYMÄTÖNTÄ AVATTAESSA OLET ALTTIINA LESERSÄTEILYLLE. ÄLÄ KATSO SÄTEESEEN. VARNING : OSYNLIG LASERSTRÅLNING NÄR DENNA DEL ÄR ÖPPNAD. BETRAKTA EJ STRÅLEN. VORSICHT! : UNSICHTBARE LESERSTRAHLUNG WENN ABDECKUNG GEÖFFNET. NICHT DEM STRAHL AUSSETZEN. • On USA or Canadian models do not have this label. • This label is located on the interior. • Varningsanvisning för laserstrålning. Placerad i apparaten. The above statements apply ONLY to those products distributed by Yamaha Corporation of America or its subsidiaries. IMPORTANT Please record the serial number of this unit in the space below. Serial No.: CAUTION USE OF CONTROLS OR ADJUSTMENTS OR PERFORMANCE OF PROCEDURES OTHER THAN THOSE SPECIFIED HEREIN MAY RESULT IN HAZARDOUS RADIATION EXPOSURE. The serial number is located on the bottom or rear of the unit. Retain this Owner's Manual in a safe place for future reference. ADVARSEL Usynlig laserstråling ved åbning. Undgå udsaettelse for stråling. IMPORTANT THE WIRES IN MAINS LEAD ARE COLOURED ACCORDANCE WITH THE FOLLOWING CODE: BLUE : BROWN : IN NEUTRAL LIVE As the colours of the wires in the mains lead of this apparatus may not correspond with the coloured markings identifying the terminals in your plug proceed as follows: The wire which is coloured BLUE must be connected to the terminal which is marked with the letter N or coloured BLACK. The wire which is coloured BROWN must be connected to the terminal which is marked with the letter L or coloured RED. Making sure that neither core is connected to the earth terminal of the three pin plug. * This applies only to products distributed by YAMAHA KEMBLE MUSIC (U.K.) LTD. VAROITUS Laitteen käyttäminen muulla kuin tässä käyttöohjeesa mainitulla tavalla saattaa altistaa käyttäjän turvallisuusluokan 1 ylittävälle näkymättömälle lasersäteilylle. VARNING Om apparaten används på annat sätt än i denna bruksanvisning specificerats, kan användaren utsättas för osynlig laserstrålning, som överskrider gränsen för laserklass 1. • Explanation of Graphical Symbols CAUTION RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK DO NOT OPEN CAUTION: TO REDUCE THE RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO NOT REMOVE COVER (OR BACK). NO USER-SERVICEABLE PARTS INSIDE. REFER SERVICING TO QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL. The above warning is located on the bottom or rear of the unit The exclamation point within an equilateral triangle is intended to alert the user to the presence of important operating and maintenance (servicing) instructions in the literature accompanying the product. The lightning flash with arrowhead symbol within an equilateral triangle is intended to alert the user to the presence of uninsulated “dangerous voltage” within the product’s enclosure that may be of sufficient magnitude to constitute a risk of electric shock to persons. SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS 1. Read Instructions — All the safety and operating instructions should be read before the appliance is operated. 2. Retain Instructions — The safety and operating instructions should be retained for future reference. 3. Heed Warnings — All warnings on the appliance and in the operating instructions should be adhered to. 4. Follow Instructions — All operating and use instructions should be followed. 5. Water and Moisture — The appliance should not be used near water – for example, near a bathtub, washbowl, kitchen sink, laundry tub, in a wet basement, or near a swimming pool, and the like. 6. Carts and Stands — The appliance should be used only with a cart or stand that is recommended by the manufacturer. 6A An appliance and cart combination should be moved with care. Quick stops, excessive force, and uneven surfaces may cause the appliance and cart combination to overturn. 7. Wall or Ceiling Mounting — The appliance should be mounted to a wall or ceiling only as recommended by the manufacturer. 8. Ventilation — The appliance should be situated so that its location or position does not interfere with its proper ventilation. For example, the appliance should not be situated on a bed, sofa, rug, or similar surface that may block the ventilation openings; or, placed in a built-in installation, such as a bookcase or cabinet that may impede the flow of air through the ventilation openings. 9. Heat — The appliance should be situated away from heat sources such as radiators, heat registers, stoves, or other appliances (including amplifiers) that produce heat. 10. Power Sources — The appliance should be connected to a power supply only of the type described in the operating instructions or as marked on the appliance. 11. Grounding or Polarization — The precautions that should be taken so that the grounding or polarization means of an appliance is not defeated. 12. Power-Cord Protection — Power-supply cords should be routed so that they are not likely to be walked on or pinched by items placed upon or against them, paying particular attention to cords at plugs, convenience receptacles, and the point where they exit from the appliance. 13. Cleaning — The appliance should be cleaned only as recommended by the manufacturer. 14. Nonuse Periods — The power cord of the appliance should be unplugged from the outlet when left unused for a long period of time. 15. Object and Liquid Entry — Care should be taken so that objects do not fall and liquids are not spilled into the enclosure through openings. 16. Damage Requiring Service — The appliance should be serviced by qualified service personnel when: A. The power-supply cord or the plug has been damaged; or B. Objects have fallen, or liquid has been spilled into the appliance; or C. The appliance has been exposed to rain; or D. The appliance does not appear to operate normally or exhibits a marked change in performance; or E. The appliance has been dropped, or the enclosure damaged. 17. Servicing — The user should not attempt service the appliance beyond that described in the operating instructions. 4 Important Important Read the Following Before Operating the MD4S Warnings • Do not place a container with liquid or small metal objects on top of this unit. Liquid or metal objects inside this unit are a fire and electrical shock hazard. • Do not allow water to enter this unit or allow the unit to become wet. Fire or electrical shock may result. • Connect this unit is power cord only to an AC outlet of the type stated in this Owner’s Manual or as marked on the unit. Failure to do so is a fire and electrical shock hazard. • Do not scratch, bend, twist, pull, or heat the power cord. A damaged power cord is a fire and electrical shock hazard. • Do not place heavy objects, including this unit, on top of the power cord. A damaged power cord is a fire and electrical shock hazard. In particular, be careful not to place heavy objects on a power cord covered by a carpet. • If you notice any abnormality, such as smoke, odor, or noise, or if a foreign object or liquid gets inside the unit, turn it off immediately. Remove the power cord from the AC outlet. Consult your dealer for repair. Using the unit in this condition is a fire and electrical shock hazard. • Should this unit be dropped or the cabinet be damaged, turn the power switch off, remove the power plug from the AC outlet, and contact your dealer. If you continue using the unit without heeding this instruction, fire or electrical shock may result. • If the power cord is damaged (i.e., cut or a bare wire is exposed), ask your dealer for a replacement. Using the unit with a damaged power cord is a fire and electrical shock hazard. • Do not remove the unit’s cover. You could receive an electrical shock. If you think internal inspection, maintenance, or repair is necessary, contact your dealer. • Do not modify the unit. Doing so is a fire and electrical shock hazard. • Do not insert or drop metal or flammable objects into the disc loading slot of this unit. Fire or electrical shock may result. Cautions • Allow enough free space around the unit for normal ventilation. This should be: 10 cm at the sides, and 10 cm behind. These distances should also be adopted when rack-mounting the unit. For normal ventilation during use, remove the rear of the rack or open a ventilation hole. If the airflow is not adequate, the unit will heat up inside and may cause a fire. • Keep this unit away from the following locations: — Locations exposed to oil splashes or steam, such as near cooking stoves, humidifiers, etc. — Unstable surfaces, such as a wobbly table or slope. — Locations exposed to excessive heat, such as inside a car with all the windows closed, or places that receive direct sunlight. — Locations subject to excessive humidity or dust accumulation. • This unit has ventilation holes at the top, and bottom to prevent the internal temperature rising too high. Do not block them. Blocked ventilation holes are a fire hazard. —Owner’s Manual Important 5 • Turn off all musical instruments, audio equipment, and speakers when connecting to this unit. Use the correct connecting cables and connect as specified. • Always lower the volume control to minimum before turning on the power to this unit. A sudden blast of sound may damage your hearing. • Hold the power cord plug when disconnecting it from an AC outlet. Never pull the cord. A damaged power cord is a potential fire and electrical shock hazard. • Do not touch the power plug with wet hands. Doing so is a potential electrical shock hazard. • Do not raise the volume of headphones or speakers to a level that makes you feel uncomfortable. Listening to loud music for long periods can damage your hearing. • Do not look at the laser beam. You may damage your vision. Operating Notes • The digital circuits of this unit may induce a slight noise into nearby radios and TVs. If noise occurs, relocate the affected equipment. • XLR-type connectors are wired as follows: pin 1: ground, pin 2: hot (+), and pin 3: cold (–). • Insert TRS phone jacks are wired as follows: sleeve: ground, tip: send, and ring: return. • The performance of components with moving contacts, such as switches, rotary controls, faders, and connectors, deteriorates over time. The rate of deterioration depends on the operating environment and is unavoidable. Consult your dealer about replacing defective components. • This unit must not be operated in a tilted position. Doing so can cause malfunctions. Copyright © 1998 Yamaha Corporation. All rights reserved. No part of the MD4S software or this Owner’s Manual may be reproduced or distributed in any form or by any means without the prior written authorization of Yamaha Corporation. Trademarks: MD DATA and MiniDisc are trademarks of Sony Corporation. US and foreign patents licensed from Dolby Laboratories Licensing Corporation. All other trademarks are the property of their respective holders. Keep This Manual For Future Reference —Owner’s Manual 6 Contents Contents Welcome to the MD4S ......................................... 9 MD4S Features ............................................................................................9 Mixer............................................................................................................ 9 Recorder ...................................................................................................... 9 Buying discs for the MD4S.........................................................................10 MD DATA and MiniDisc .......................................................................... 10 MD4S TOC .................................................................................................11 To update the TOC .................................................................................... 11 Recording modes and recording times......................................................11 MD4S songs and blank areas .....................................................................12 Front and rear panel...................................................................................13 Mono Inputs............................................................................................... 13 Stereo Inputs .............................................................................................. 15 Monitor/Master section............................................................................. 15 Disc transport section ................................................................................ 16 Display ........................................................................................................ 19 Top panel connectors ................................................................................ 22 Rear panel ................................................................................................... 23 Front panel ................................................................................................. 24 Basic operation.................................................... 25 Before you begin .........................................................................................25 Example connections ................................................................................. 25 Turning on the MD4S................................................................................ 26 Inserting a disc ........................................................................................... 26 Recording the first track (Direct Recording) ............................................26 Preparations for recording ........................................................................ 26 Start recording............................................................................................ 28 Overdubbing...............................................................................................30 Mixdown .....................................................................................................32 After completing the Basic Operation section ..........................................34 Advanced recording techniques ......................... 35 Advanced techniques on the MD4S ..........................................................35 Mixing multiple channels as you record ...................................................36 Ping-pong recording ..................................................................................39 Adding sounds during mixdown...............................................................42 —Owner’s Manual Contents 7 Applying effects...........................................................................................44 Using the INSERT I/O jacks.......................................................................44 Using the AUX SEND jacks .......................................................................46 Applying effects during mixdown .............................................................47 Applying an effect during ping-pong recording .......................................48 Applying an effect only to the monitor signal...........................................50 Punch-in/out...............................................................................................52 Manual punch-in/out.................................................................................52 Auto punch-in/out .....................................................................................55 Quick search functions...............................................................................61 Searching for songs.....................................................................................61 Locating to a specified time........................................................................61 Locating to the Last Record In/Out Point.................................................62 Searching for Markers ................................................................................62 Adjusting the location of a marker or auto punch-in/out point .............63 Erasing a marker or auto punch-in/out point ..........................................65 Various playback functions........................................................................66 Play forward/backward at various speeds (Cue/Review) .........................66 Playback at half speed (x1/2 Play)..............................................................67 Playing a song repeatedly (One Song Repeat/All Song Repeat)...............67 Repeating a specific portion of a song (A-B Repeat) ................................68 Cue List playback........................................................................................68 Programming the song playback order (Program Play) ..........................71 Editing functions ........................................................................................73 Copying a portion of a track (Part Copy) .................................................73 Erasing a section of a track (Part Erase) ....................................................74 Copying an entire track to another track (Track Copy)...........................75 Erasing an entire track (Track Erase) ........................................................76 Copying/converting a song (Song Copy) ..................................................76 Erasing a song (Song Erase) .......................................................................78 Splitting a song into two (Song Divide) ....................................................79 Joining divided songs together (Song Combine)......................................80 Moving a song (Song Move)......................................................................81 Exchanging the order of songs (Song Renumber)....................................82 Other functions...........................................................................................84 Adjusting the record/playback pitch (Pitch function) .............................84 Titling discs and songs................................................................................85 Erasing a disc (Disc Erase) .........................................................................86 Viewing disc contents.................................................................................86 Changing the recording mode ...................................................................87 Adjusting the display brightness ................................................................88 Selecting the type of Frame display............................................................88 Using a Foot switch ....................................................................................89 MIDI functions ...........................................................................................90 Synchronizing the MD4S with a MIDI sequencer ....................................90 About MTC and MIDI Clock ....................................................................91 Synchronization using MTC......................................................................91 Synchronization using MIDI Clock...........................................................92 Synchronizing two MD4S recorders..........................................................94 Synchronizing to MTC with a specified offset (time difference) .............97 Controlling the MD4S by MMC................................................................98 —Owner’s Manual 8 Contents Appendix ............................................................ 100 Q&A Section ..............................................................................................100 Troubleshooting ........................................................................................101 Display Messages ................................................................................... 103 Modes of the MD4S transport ..................................................................104 Specifications .............................................................................................105 Recorder .................................................................................................... 105 Mixer.......................................................................................................... 105 General....................................................................................................... 106 Dimensions................................................................................................ 106 Block Diagram ...........................................................................................107 Glossary......................................................................................................108 Tempo Map Chart.....................................................................................111 MIDI Implementation Chart .............................. 112 Index................................................................... 113 —Owner’s Manual Welcome to the MD4S 9 Welcome to the MD4S MD4S Features Mixer The mixer section is an analog mixer with four MIC/LINE and four LINE inputs. • Continuously variable GAIN controls are provided on input channels 1–4, accepting signals ranging from mic input to line level. • Of the four MIC/LINE inputs, two are balanced, allowing the use of either TRS phone plugs or XLR plugs. • Input channels 1 and 2 provide INSERT I/O jacks that allow external effects such as a compressor to be connected. • Input channels 1–4 provide three-band EQ (HIGH/MID/LOW) that has been specially engineered for musical applications. • Two AUX SEND jacks allow external effects such as reverb to be connected. • Signals sent from input channels 1–4 to the CUE bus (a signal route for monitoring) can be monitored in stereo. • The mixer features an in-line design that allows the input signal and the track playback sound to be controlled simultaneously. While using the CUE bus to monitor each track, you can make full use of input channels 1–4 as you record. During mixdown, a total of eight sources (including track playback signals) can be mixed. • TRACK DIRECT OUT jacks are provided for direct output of the playback from each track. Recorder The recorder features a 4-track recorder based on the MD DATA audio format. This provides many advantages over tape-based multitrack recorders. • You can choose from three recording modes: 4 track, 2 track, monaural. • Negligible decrease in audio quality even after repeated ping-pong operations. • Ping-pong is possible even if all four tracks have been recorded. • A variety of locate functions allow you to move instantly to any location in the song. • Accurate auto punch-in/out can be performed with 11.6-millisecond accuracy. • A variety of editing functions allow you to copy or erase songs and tracks. • A variety of repeat functions allow songs or portions of a song to be repeated seamlessly. • The multi-take auto punch-in/out function lets you repeat auto punch-in/out several times, and select the best take afterward. • Shuttle playback allows rapid playback / reverse-playback at speeds of 1/2, 2x, 4x, 8x, 16x, or 32x normal speed. (Forward playback only for 1/2 speed.) • Program Play function lets you program the playback order of songs. In addition, Cue List Playback lets you freely program the playback order between markers. —Owner’s Manual 10 Welcome to the MD4S • The recording/playback pitch can be adjusted up to a maximum of ± 10%. In addition, you can use the x1/2 play function to playback at half-speed with a pitch that is one octave lower. • MIDI Time Code (MTC) / MIDI Clock data can be transmitted from the MIDI OUT connector. This allows synchronization with a MIDI sequencer or rhythm machine without using up a recording track. In addition, MTC from an external device can be received at the MIDI IN connector, allowing the MD4S to be synchronized to external video/audio devices. • MIDI Machine Control (MMC) can be received, allowing the transport of the MD4S to be controlled from a MIDI sequencer or other external device. Buying discs for the MD4S The MD4S can use two types of disc: MD DATA and MiniDisc. MD DATA discs can be used for 4-track recording/playback, and MiniDiscs can be used for recording/playback of up to two tracks. (They cannot be used for 4-track recording/playback.) MD DATA and MiniDisc MD DATA are widely used for computer data storage, and the MD4S uses the audio format of this type of disc. MiniDiscs (also known as MD) are used only for music. Type MD DATA MiniDisc Logo 4-track recording/ playback Yes (37 minutes per track) No 2-track recording/ playback Yes (74 minutes) Yes (74 minutes) Monaural recording/ playback Yes (148 minutes) Yes (148 minutes) Notes —Owner’s Manual • These discs are for computer storage applications, and can be purchased at computer shops. Two types are available: playback-only and rewritable. Use the rewritable type with the MD4S. • MD DATA discs recorded on the MD4S cannot be played back on a conventional MD player. • MD DATA discs that have been used to store computer data cannot be used as is by the MD4S. Such discs must first be formatted for audio use. See “Erasing a disc (Disc Erase)” on page 86 for more information. • Songs that were recorded in 8track mode on a recorder such as the MD8 cannot be played back on the MD4S. • These discs are for music. Two types are available: playback-only and rewritable. If you use the rewritable type, you can record up to two tracks. • MiniDiscs recorded on the MD4S can be played back on a conventional MD player. • MiniDiscs recorded on a conventional MD recorder can be edited on the MD4S, but if the music includes a song that was digitally copied from a copy-protected music CD, editing will not be possible. MD4S TOC 11 MD4S TOC TOC refers to the Table of Contents area on the disc. The TOC contains information about what is recorded on the disc, the disc title, song titles, and so on. When you record a new song or edit the song title, the TOC EDIT indicator of the MD4S will light to indicate that the TOC needs to be updated. TOC EDIT If the TOC EDIT indicator is lit, you must update the TOC before turning off the power of the MD4S. If the power is turned off when the TOC EDIT indicator is lit, the data you recorded or edited will be lost. To update the TOC Press the STOP button, and with the MD4S stopped, press the TOC WRITE button. (The STOP button and the TOC WRITE button are the same button.) STOP TOC WRITE The display will show “Writing TOC,” indicating that the TOC is being written to disc. When the TOC has been updated, the “Writing TOC” display and the TOC EDIT indicator will go dark. Note: If you press the EJECT button while the TOC EDIT indicator is lit, the TOC will automatically be updated before the disc is ejected. Recording modes and recording times The MD4S offers three recording modes: 4-track (4TR), 2-track (2TR), and monaural (MONO). The times available for recording on a single disc will depend on the recording mode. Available recording/playback times will be 37 minutes in 4TR mode, 74 minutes in 2TR mode, and 148 minutes in MONO mode. You can use a different recording mode for each song, which allows you to make the most efficient use of each disc. 37 minutes 4TR mode 74 minutes 2TR mode 148 minutes MONO mode —Owner’s Manual 12 Welcome to the MD4S MD4S songs and blank areas On the MD4S, recordings are made in units called “songs.” Each song is assigned a number indicating the order in which it was recorded. For example if you have recorded two songs on a disc, song 2 will be recorded immediately after song 1, as shown in the following diagram. Song 1 Song 2 Blank area 1 When you record a new song or record additional material onto a previously-recorded song to lengthen it, the new recording is done only on the unrecorded portion of the disc; the “blank area.” In the diagram above, it is possible to record a new song (song 3) in the blank area, or to record additional material onto song 2 to lengthen it. However since there is no blank area immediately after song 1, it is not immediately possible to record additional material to song 1 to lengthen it. Tip: If you wish to lengthen song 1, you will need to use a song editing function to move song 1 to the blank area. If three songs (songs 1, 2, and 3) are recorded consecutively on disc as shown in the following diagram, and the middle song is erased, there will be a blank area corresponding to the length of that song. Song 1 Song 2 Song 3 Blank area 1 Song 3 Blank area 1 Erase song 2 Song 1 Blank area 2 * Blank areas are also assigned a “blank area number” in the order in which they are created. If you then record a song in the situation shown above, you will be able to select either blank area 1 or blank area 2 in which to record. However if you select blank area 2, the time available for recording will be limited to the length of the song that was erased. —Owner’s Manual 13 Front and rear panel Front and rear panel This section explains the names and functions of each part of the MD4S. Mono Inputs A GAIN control 1 GAIN This adjusts the input sensitivity of the MIC/LINE input jack (jacks 1 and 2 on the top panel). Input channels 1–4 can accommodate signals of any level from mic input to the line level signals produced by devices such as synthesizers. 1 LINE 2 MIC MIC/ LINE PB FLIP CUE P A N 3 L R L E V E L 0 10 HIGH –15 MID +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 AUX +15 4 5 1 2 L R PAN 6 B FLIP switch This switch selects the signal source for the input channel and the signal source that is sent to the CUE bus for monitoring. When this switch is in the MIC/LINE position ( ), the signal from the MIC/LINE jack will be sent to the input channel, and the track signal (the signal currently being recorded or played back) will be sent to the CUE bus. When this switch is in the PB position ( ), the signal from the track will be sent to the input channel, and the signal from the MIC/LINE jack will be sent to the CUE bus. Signal input to the MIC/LINE INPUT jack from an instrument etc. Signal input to the MIC/LINE INPUT jack from an instrument etc. 10 9 8 7 6 MD4S track signal 5 7 4 3 MD4S track signal 2 1 0 1 When the FLIP switch is in the MIC/LINE position ( ) GAIN LINE GAIN MIC LINE MIC/ LINE When the FLIP switch is in the PB position ( ) MIC MIC/ LINE PB FLIP PB FLIP CUE CUE P A N L R 0 10 P A N L R 0 10 L E V E L HIGH L E V E L HIGH –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 +15 –15 +15 To the ST bus, tracks etc. To the CUE bus To the ST bus, tracks etc. To the CUE bus —Owner’s Manual Welcome to the MD4S C CUE PAN/CUE LEVEL controls These two controls adjust the pan and signal level of the signal that is sent to the CUE bus. The signal that is sent to the CUE bus will depend on the setting of the FLIP switch 2. D EQ controls These controls are used to adjust the high, middle, and low frequency bands. Each can boost (amplify) or cut (attenuate) the frequency bands shown below over a range of ±15 dB. Each knob is detented at the 12 o’clock position, which produces a flat response (no boost or cut). +15 +10 Response [dB] 14 +5 0 –5 –10 –15 20 100 1k 10k 20k Frequency [Hz] HIGH (high range): 10 kHz (shelving) MID (mid range): 2.5 kHz (peaking) LOW (low range): 100 Hz (shelving) E AUX control This control sends the signal from the input channel to the AUX SEND jacks. Rotating the knob toward the “1” position will sent the signal from the input channel to the AUX SEND 1 jack, and rotating the knob toward the “2” position will send the signal to the AUX SEND 2 jack. The knob is detented at the 12 o’clock position, and at this position no signal will be sent to either AUX SEND jack 1 or 2. The AUX controls are normally used to adjust the signal level that is sent to external effect devices. Note: The AUX control is “post-fader”; i.e., it adjusts the level of the signal that has passed through the fader 7. This means that if the fader has been lowered, the AUX control will have no effect. F PAN control This control adjusts the pan (left/right position) of the input channel signal that is sent to the ST bus. If you are recording via the ST bus, rotating this control to the L position will assign the input signal to odd-numbered tracks (tracks 1 and 3), and rotating it to the R position will assign the input signal to even-numbered tracks (tracks 2 and 4). During mixdown, use this control to adjust the stereo position of the playback for each track. G Fader During recording (when the FLIP switch is at MIC/LINE), use the fader to adjust the input level of the signal being recorded on the track. During mixdown (when the FLIP switch is at PB), use the fader to adjust playback level of each track. The fader will be at unity gain when located between 7 and 8. Unity gain: This refers to a condition where the output signal and input signal levels are the same, which will produce the least distortion and the optimal S/N ratio. —Owner’s Manual 15 Front and rear panel Stereo Inputs H Level (5/6), (7/8) controls These controls adjust the level of the signals input from STEREO INPUT jacks 5/6 or 7/8. These input signals are always sent to the ST bus, and are mixed with the signals from input channels 1–4 and the playback signals of the tracks. 5/6 7/8 8 0 10 0 10 Monitor/Master section I CUE MIX TO STEREO switch This switch turns the cue mix function on/off. When the switch is pressed in ( ), the CUE MIX indicator in the display will light, and the signal from the CUE bus will be mixed into the ST bus. The cue mix function can be used only during playback, and is normally used when adding sounds during mixdown (page 42). CUE MIX TO STEREO 9 MONITOR SELECT J MONITOR SELECT switches These switches select the signal that will be monitored from the MONITOR OUT jacks (rear panel 4) and the PHONES jack (front panel 1). When the switch is pressed in, the corresponding source is selected (on). When the switch is up, the signal will not be selected (off). The three switches can be turned on/off independently. 2TR IN ................... Monitor the signal that is input from the 2TR IN jacks (rear panel 6). STEREO ............... Monitor the ST bus signal that is output from the STEREO OUT jacks (rear panel 5). CUE ....................... Monitor the CUE bus signal. K MONITOR LEVEL control This control adjusts the output level of the monitor signal that is sent to the MONITOR OUT jacks (rear panel 4) and the PHONES jack (front panel 1). L STEREO fader This adjusts the output level of the ST bus that is output from the STEREO OUT jacks (rear panel 5). The fader will be at unity gain when located between 7 and 8. 2TR IN STEREO J CUE MONITOR LEVEL K MIN L MAX 10 10 9 9 8 8 7 7 6 6 5 5 4 4 3 3 2 2 1 1 0 0 STEREO Unity gain: Refer to the explanation of 7 Fader. —Owner’s Manual 16 Welcome to the MD4S Disc transport section 9 CH1 REC SELECT CH2 CH3 CH4 1 2 3 4 L R L R PEAK HOLD DISPLAY EDIT UTILITY J BUS EJECT MULTITRACK MD RECORDER PITCH ADJUST K L M N O 8 EXIT ENTER 7 6 5 4 3 2 REPEAT P MARK SEARCH MARK A B LAST REC SEARCH IN AUTO PUNCH I/O REHE OUT SONG SEARCH REC PLAY Q R SET PAUSE STOP 1 DATA CURSOR TOC WRITE PHONES PUNCH I/O * Please remove the protective film from the panel. If the film is left on, the adhesive may break down and soil the unit. A Disc transport buttons REHE button ...... This button is used to rehearse punch-in/out. During rehearsal the REHE indicator located above the button will light, and while rehearsal is paused the indicator will blink. REC button ......... This button is used to record. When you press the REC button during playback, recording will begin from that location on any recordable track(s). (See “Manual punch-in/out” on page 52 for more information.) The REC indicator located above the button will light during recording, and will blink to indicate record pause. PLAY button .......This button is used to begin normal playback, recording, and rehearsal. After pressing the REHE button, pressing the PLAY button will enter rehearsal mode. After pressing the REC button, pressing the PLAPY button will begin recording. If you press the PLAY button without pressing the REHE or REC button, normal playback will begin. During playback/ recording/rehearsal, the PLAY indicator located above the button will light. When playback/recording/rehearsal is paused, the PLAY indicator will blink. PAUSE button.... This button temporarily halts (pauses) playback/recording/rehearsal. After operation has been paused, pressing the PAUSE button once again will resume playback/recording/rehearsal from that location. If you do not operate any buttons for about 10 minutes while the unit is in Pause or Rec Pause mode, the mode will be canceled automatically. —Owner’s Manual Front and rear panel 17 STOP/TOC WRITE button ........... This button stops playback/recording/rehearsal. When stopped, this button functions as the TOC WRITE button to update the TOC (page 11). B AUTO PUNCH I/O button This button turns the auto punch-in/out function on/off. When auto punch-in/out is on, the auto punch indicator in the display (display K) will light. C SONG SEARCH [ ]/[ ] buttons These buttons search for the starting locations of songs or blank areas. They are used to search for and move to the beginning of songs. DA B repeat button This button sets the A and B points of the A-B repeat function (page 68). E LAST REC SEARCH [IN]/[OUT], SET buttons The LAST REC SEARCH [IN]/[OUT] buttons locate to the points at which recording or rehearsal were last started (last record IN point) or last ended (last record OUT point). In conjunction with the SET button, these buttons can be used to specify any desired location in a song as the last record in/out point (punch-in/out point). F REPEAT button This button is used to select functions such as “one song repeat” which repeatedly plays back a single song, or “all song repeat” which repeatedly plays back all songs on the disc, and is also used to switch the repeat function on/off. The repeat indicator (display O) will light to indicate the repeat function that is selected. G MARK SEARCH [ ]/[ ], MARK buttons The MARK SEARCH buttons are used to locate to the Start marker (beginning of the song), End marker (end of the song), or to markers that you can set at desired locations in the song. The MARK button is used to insert a marker into the desired location of a song. H Disc compartment An MD DATA or MiniDisc can be inserted here. I BUS button This button is used in conjunction with the REC SELECT buttons J to specify the tracks on which the ST bus signal will be recorded. J REC SELECT buttons These buttons select/defeat recording tracks. Tracks selected for recording will be indicated by the track record indicators (display J) in the display. When you press only a REC SELECT button Recording will be enabled for the corresponding track, and the signal from input channels 1– 4 will be sent directly to the track (direct recording). When you hold down the BUS button and press a REC SELECT button Recording will be enabled for the corresponding track. The L channel of the ST bus will be sent to tracks 1 and 3, and the R channel of the ST bus signal will be sent to tracks 2 and 4. K EJECT button This button ejects the disc from the MD4S. If you press the EJECT button while the TOC EDIT indicator (display 1) is lit, the TOC will be updated before the disc is ejected. —Owner’s Manual 18 Welcome to the MD4S L PEAK HOLD button This button turns the peak hold function on/off. When the peak hold function is on, a segment of the track/stereo level meters will remain lit to indicate the maximum level that was reached. When the peak hold function is on, pressing the PEAK HOLD button once again will turn off the peak hold function, and the segment that had remained lit will be reset. M DISPLAY button This button selects the time counter mode (ELAPSE TIME / TOTAL TIME / REMAIN TIME). The selected time counter mode will be shown in the display (display 5). If a tempo map has been programmed for the MD4S, this button will switch the time counter between measure/ beat/clock displays. N Function buttons These buttons are used to access a variety of functions. When a button is pressed to access the corresponding function, the indicator located above the button will light. PITCH button...... Selects functions to adjust the pitch for playback and recording (page 84). According to the setting, the pitch indicator in the display will indicate “FIX” (fixed) or “VARI” (variable). ADJUST button.. Allows you to make fine adjustments to the markers or last recording in/ out points that you have set within a song (page 63). EDIT button ........ Accesses a variety of editing functions, and allows you to specify a disc title or song title. UTILITY button... Allows you to use MIDI functions, adjust the display contrast, and change the recording mode etc. O EXIT button Use this button to cancel a function or mode. P ENTER button Use this button to set functions. Q DATA dial (DATA+ –) When the MD4S is stopped or paused, rotating the DATA dial will move through the song in frame steps. When editing various functions (when one of the function buttons has been pressed), the DATA dial is used to modify parameter values. R CURSOR shuttle When the MD4S is stopped or paused, rotating the CURSOR shuttle allows you to rapidly rewind or fast-forward through the song. During playback, the CURSOR shuttle allows you to review (play backward) or cue (play forward) at a variety of speeds (Shuttle playback functions: page 66). While editing various functions, the CURSOR shuttle is used to select parameters. —Owner’s Manual Front and rear panel 19 Display 4 3 SONG NO. REC MODE STEP NO. 5 7 8 +12 +9 +6 +3 0 –3 –6 –12 –20 CLIP –3 –6 –9 –12 REMAIN TIME MTC SYNC –15 MASTER SLAVE –18 MIDI CLK MMC –27 –39 `1234567890 PITCH REC HALF FIX VARI ELAPSE TIME TOTAL TIME MEASURE MIN BEAT SEC 2 REHE TOC EDIT 1 6 REPEAT A1ALL B S 1 2 3 O 4 5 6 N 7 AUTO PUNCH MTC FRAMES SINGLE MULTI 8 9 10 E M IN TRK 1 DIR 1 OUT BUS L K L 2 3 4 2 R 3 L 4 R J dB L R STEREO CUE MIX 9 A TOC EDIT indicator This indicator will light when the TOC (table of contents) needs to be updated, such as after a new recording or edit. If the power of the MD4S is turned off while the TOC EDIT indicator is lit, the recorded or edited content may be lost. When you update the TOC, the indicator will go dark. B Status indicators These indicators show the current operating mode. Indicator Meaning Normal playback Cue or Review Playback is paused REHE REHE Rehearsal Pause mode Rehearsal in progress REC Record Pause mode REC Recording in progress C Pitch indicator This indicator shows the current pitch mode. The status of the x1/2 Play function is also shown here. HALF ..................... Lights when the x1/2 Play function is on. FIX ......................... Lights when the Pitch function is off. VARI ...................... Lights when the Pitch function is on. D Title and function display Song numbers, song/disc titles, the currently selected function, or other messages will appear here. —Owner’s Manual 20 Welcome to the MD4S E Time counter mode This indicates the time counter mode that was selected by the DISPLAY button (disc transport M). However if a tempo map has been programmed and the time counter is showing measure/beat/clock, all of these indicators will be dark. ELAPSE TIME ...... The time counter will show the current elapsed time within the song. TOTAL TIME......... The time counter will show the time position within the entire disc. REMAIN TIME ...... The time counter will show the remaining time within the son F MIDI indicators The status of various MIDI functions is shown here. MTC SYNC MASTER .......... This will light when you enable MTC transmission. In this case, the MD4S will transmit MTC and will function as the master of a synchronized MIDI system. MTC SYNC SLAVE .............. This will light when you enable MTC reception. In this case, the MD4S will receive MTC and will function as a slave in a synchronized MIDI system. MIDI CLK .............. This will light when you enable MIDI Clock transmission. In this case, the MD4S will transmit MIDI Clock and will function as the master of a synchronized MIDI system. MMC ...................... This will light when you enable MMC (MIDI Machine Control) reception. In this case, the MD4S can be controlled from an external device such as a MIDI sequencer. G Track level meters These indicate the recording/playback level of each track. The range from –39 dB to CLIP is shown in nine steps. The CLIP indicator will light to indicate that digital clipping has occurred in the signal. If no disc is inserted, these meters will indicate the input levels of input channels 1–4. H Stereo level meter This meter indicates the output level of the STEREO OUT jacks. The range from –20 dB to +12 dB is shown in nine steps. I CUE MIX indicator This indicates the on/off status of the cue mix function. If you record while the cue mix function is on, this indicator will blink, indicating that the cue mix function has been temporarily turned off. J Track recording indicators These indicate the recording status of each track. When a indicator is blinking, the corresponding track is ready to record. When recording begins, the blinking indicator will light solidly. DIR/1–4 ................. These indicate tracks that have been selected for direct recording (in which the signal from the input channel is recorded directly). BUS/L, R ............... These indicate tracks that have been selected for recording the signal from the ST bus (L or R channel). —Owner’s Manual Front and rear panel 21 K Auto punch indicator This indicator shows the status of the auto punch-in/out function. AUTO PUNCH SINGLE....... This will light when you select Single Take Auto Punch-in/out (in which auto punch-in/out will occur only once). AUTO PUNCH MULTI ......... This will light when you select Multi Take Auto Punch-in/out (in which you can perform auto punch-in/out repeatedly, and then select the best take). L IN, OUT indicators These show the status of the last record in (IN)/out (OUT) points. IN ........................... This will light if the Last Record In Point (auto punch-in point) has been set. During auto punch-in/out, this indicator will go dark when the song reaches or passes the specified IN point. OUT ....................... This will light if the Last Record Out Point (auto punch-out point) has been set. During auto punch-in/out, this indicator will go dark when the song reaches or passes the specified OUT point. M Time counter This indicates time locations on the disc in minutes/seconds/frames. When transmitting MIDI Clock data, the minutes/seconds/frames display can be changed to measures/beats/ clocks. (In this case, the MEASURE and BEAT indicators will light.) N Marker indicators These indicate the status of the various markers that have been set within the song. When a marker is set, the corresponding indicator will light. When a song passes a marker point that has been set, the corresponding indicators will blink. S ............................ Start marker (beginning of the song) 1–10 ...................... Marker numbers 1–10 that were set at desired locations in the song using the MARK button. E ............................ End marker (end of the song) O Repeat indicator This indicates the repeat function that has been selected by the REPEAT button (disk transport 6, or the A B button (disk transport 4). REPEAT 1 ............ One Song Repeat REPEAT ALL ....... All Song Repeat REPEAT A B ........ A-B repeat REPEAT + auto punch indicator K ........... Auto punch-in/out is rehearsed repeatedly —Owner’s Manual 22 Welcome to the MD4S Top panel connectors 1 1 3 4 2 MIC/LINE INPUT INSERT 3 I/O INSERT I/O LINE INPUT 4 5 6 7 8 2 A MIC/LINE INPUT 1,2 jacks Balanced dynamic mics or line-level devices with balanced output can be connected to these inputs. Unbalanced outputs such as on synthesizers can also be connected here. These jacks will accommodate either XLR plugs or TRS phone plugs. B INSERT I/O jacks These are TRS phone jacks for connecting external effect devices. By connecting an external effect such as a compressor or noise gate to these jacks, you can process the signal of input channels 1 and 2. External effect unit (compressor, noise gate etc.) INPUT OUTPUT 1 2 INSERT I/O MIC/LINE INPUT INSERT 3 I/O 4 C MIC/LINE INPUT 3, 4 jacks These are 1/4" phone jacks used to connect electronic instruments such as a synthesizer or an unbalanced mic. D LINE INPUT 5–8 jacks These are 1/4" phone jacks used to connect line-level devices such as synthesizers or CD players. They can also be used as effect return jacks to input the effect sound from external effect units such as reverb. —Owner’s Manual Front and rear panel 23 Rear panel POWER ON/ OFF AC IN AUX SEND 1 2 MONITOR STEREO OUT OUT L L R 1 2 3 R 2TR IN L R 4 5 6 TRACK DIRECT OUT 3 1 4 THRU MIDI OUT IN 2 7 8 CAUTION TO PREVENT ELECTRIC SHOCK, MATCH WIDE BLADE OF PLUG TO WIDE SLOT, FULLY INSERT. A POWER switch This switch is used to turn the MD4S on and off. B AC IN Connect the included power cable here. C AUX SEND 1, 2 jacks These are 1/4" phone jacks that output the signals from the input channels as adjusted by the AUX controls (input channel 5). Normally they are used as effect send jacks to send signals to external effect processors (page 45). D MONITOR OUT jacks These are RCA phono jacks that output the monitor signal selected by the MONITOR SELECT switch (monitor/master J). Connect them to your hi-fi system or to amplified monitor speakers. E STEREO OUT jacks These are RCA phono jacks that output the signal of the ST bus that has passed through the STEREO fader (monitor/master L). During mixdown, connect these jacks to the inputs of your master recorder. F 2TR IN jacks These are RCA phono jacks for connecting a line-level stereo device. Normally they are connected to the output jacks of your DAT or other master recorder. G TRACK DIRECT OUT 1–4 jacks These are RCA phono jacks which individually output the signals from tracks 1–4 (the signals currently being recorded/played). Normally they are used to connect the MD4S to the input jacks of a large mixer when you wish to use an external mixer to mix the playback of the MD4S recorder tracks. —Owner’s Manual 24 Welcome to the MD4S H MIDI IN, OUT, THRU connectors These connectors are used to exchange MIDI messages with external MIDI devices. MIDI OUT connector.......... MIDI Clock and MIDI Time Code (MTC) is output from this connector. This is used when synchronizing the MD4S with a MIDI sequencer or rhythm machine. MIDI IN connector.............. MTC or MMC (MIDI Machine Control) is received at this connector. This is used when controlling the transport of the MD4S from an external MIDI sequencer. MIDI THRU connector ....... MIDI messages received at the MIDI IN connector are retransmitted without change from this connector to another external MIDI device. Front panel A PHONES jack A pair of stereo headphones can be connected here for monitoring. This jack will output the same signal as the MONITOR OUT jacks. B PUNCH I/O jack A Yamaha FC5 (sold separately) can be connected here, allowing you to use a foot switch to start/pause playback, start/pause rehearsal, or punch-in/out. (See “Using a Foot switch” on page 89 for more information.) —Owner’s Manual 1 2 Basic operation 25 Basic operation This chapter explains the process of recording instruments separately on each of the four tracks, and finally mixing down to a master recorder. Before you begin Example connections Master recorder AC outlet Guitar Synthesizer L R Guitar effects processor YAMAHA POWER ON/ OFF AC IN AUX SEND 1 2 MONITOR STEREO OUT OUT L L R R 2TR IN L R TRACK DIRECT OUT 3 1 4 MIDI OUT THRU IN 2 Microphone IN OUT MIDI 1 THRU 1 GAIN TRACK DIRECT OUT 2TR IN STEREO OUT 1 MONITOR OUT 2 AUX SEND 2 MIC/LINE INPUT INSERT 3 I/O INSERT I/O LINE MIC/ LINE 2 GAIN MIC LINE MIC/ LINE PB FLIP LINE P A N 0 L 0 0 0 10 VOL PB CH1 P A N L L E V E L 10 HIGH REC SELECT CH2 CH3 CH4 0 1 2 3 4 L R L R PEAK HOLD DISPLAY EDIT UTILITY VOL Amplified monitor speakers BUS R L E V E L 10 HIGH 7/8 10 CUE MIX TO STEREO R L E V E L 10 8 FLIP P A N R 7 0 CUE P A N L L E V E L 6 5/6 MIC MIC/ LINE PB CUE R HIGH LINE FLIP CUE 5 4 GAIN MIC MIC/ LINE PB FLIP CUE L 3 GAIN MIC LINE INPUT 4 MONITOR SELECT 10 EJECT 2TR IN HIGH MULTITRACK MD RECORDER –15 MID +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 MID +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 MID +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 MID +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 AUX +15 PITCH STEREO ADJUST CUE EXIT 1 2 PAN 1 2 PAN 1 2 PAN 1 2 L R ENTER MONITOR LEVEL PAN REPEAT L R L R L R MIN MARK SEARCH MAX MARK 10 10 10 10 10 10 9 9 9 9 9 9 8 8 8 8 8 8 7 7 7 7 7 7 6 6 6 6 6 6 5 5 5 5 5 5 4 4 4 4 4 4 3 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 A B LAST REC SEARCH IN AUTO PUNCH I/O REHE OUT SONG SEARCH REC PLAY SET PAUSE STOP DATA CURSOR TOC WRITE 1 2 3 4 STEREO PHONES PUNCH I/O Headphones —Owner’s Manual 26 Basic operation Turning on the MD4S Inserting a disc Make sure that the write protect slider of the disc is in the write permit position. 1. Plug the power cable into an AC outlet. 2. Press the POWER switch located on the rear panel of the MD4S. When the power is turned on, the display will light. To turn off the MD4S, press the POWER switch again. 1. With the arrow printed on the disc pointing away from yourself, slide the disc gently into the disc compartment. The disc will be pulled in automatically. If not, check that the arrow is pointing the correct direction. When a disc is inserted into the MD4S, the TOC will be read to see what the disc contains. If the disc is new, the display will indicate “Blank Disc.” If songs have already been recorded on the disc, the disc title will appear for several seconds, and then the number of songs on the disc (e.g., “Total 004”) will appear. Recording the first track (Direct Recording) On the MD4S, the signals that are input to the MIC/LINE INPUT jacks 1–4 can be recorded directly to tracks 1–4 (direct recording). Since you simply need to connect the audio source to MIC/ LINE INPUT jack 1 if you wish to record on track 1, or to MIC/LINE INPUT jack 3 if you wish to record on track 3, this method is convenient when you will be recording each part separately. In this example, we will explain how to record your first audio source on track 1. Preparations for recording IN 2 86 3 OUT MIDI 1 1 GAIN LINE MIC/LINE INPUT INSERT 3 I/O MIC/ LINE 2 GAIN MIC LINE LINE 2TR IN STEREO OUT 1 MONITOR OUT 2 AUX SEND L 0 0 0 7/8 10 0 10 CH1 L CH4 0 1 2 3 4 L R L R PEAK HOLD DISPLAY EDIT UTILITY BUS R L E V E L 10 HIGH REC SELECT CH2 CH3 CUE MIX TO STEREO P A N R 0 8 PB L E V E L 10 HIGH 5/6 P A N L 7 FLIP L E V E L 10 6 CUE R L E V E L 5 MIC MIC/ LINE PB FLIP P A N R HIGH LINE CUE P A N LINE INPUT 4 4 GAIN MIC MIC/ LINE PB FLIP CUE L 3 GAIN MIC MIC/ LINE PB FLIP CUE 0 TRACK DIRECT OUT THRU 2 INSERT I/O MONITOR SELECT 10 EJECT 2TR IN HIGH 4 MULTITRACK MD RECORDER B –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 PITCH STEREO ADJUST 9 CUE EXIT 1 A 7 2 PAN 1 2 PAN 1 2 PAN 1 2 L R ENTER MONITOR LEVEL PAN REPEAT L R L R L R MIN MARK SEARCH MAX MARK 10 10 10 10 10 10 9 9 9 9 9 9 8 8 8 8 8 8 7 7 7 7 7 7 6 6 6 6 6 6 5 5 5 5 5 5 4 4 4 4 4 4 3 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 A B LAST REC SEARCH IN AUTO PUNCH I/O REHE OUT SONG SEARCH REC PLAY SET PAUSE STOP DATA CURSOR TOC WRITE 1 2 3 4 STEREO PHONES 5 1 —Owner’s Manual PUNCH I/O Recording the first track (Direct Recording) ■ Find a blank area ■ Select the track for recording A new song can be recorded only on a blank area. If you wish to record a new song on a disc that already contains recorded material, you must begin by finding a blank area. Unrecorded area Song 1 Song 2 27 Blank area 1 Press the SONG SEARCH [ ] button several times to find the blank area. When a blank area has been found, the display will indicate “BLANK X” (where X is the number of the blank area). Note: Since new discs (or discs that have been erased) are entirely blank, this step is not necessary. Note: With normal recording operations, there will be only one blank area. However if you move or delete songs, multiple blank areas may be created. (See “Editing functions” on page 73 for more information.) If there is more than one blank area, the time available for consecutive recording may differ depending on the size of the blank area. (See “MD4S songs and blank areas” on page 12 for more information.) Tip: If you press the DISPLAY button to set the display time counter mode to REMAIN TIME, the length of available recording time for each blank area will be shown when you search to that blank area. 2 Connect your audio source to MIC/LINE INPUT jack 1. Normally, you will record the rhythm instruments (rhythm machine, drums, or rhythm guitar etc.) first. 3 Set the FLIP switch of input channel 1 to “MIC/LINE ( ).” When you set the FLIP switch to the “MIC/LINE ( )” position, the input signal from the MIC/ LINE INPUT jack will be sent to the corresponding input channel. 4 Press REC SELECT button 1. The REC SELECT buttons are switches that select the recording source for each track. When you press REC SELECT button 1, track 1 will be ready for recording, and the signal from input channel 1 will be sent directly to track 1. The track recording indicator (DIR) for track 1 will blink. ■ Check the recording level To insure the best audio quality for the recording, it is important to set an appropriate recording level. Always be sure to adjust the recording level before you begin recording. 5 Press the REC button. The REC indicator will blink, and the MD4S will be in record-pause mode. The display will indicate the number of the song to be recorded (001), and if this is the first time you are recording the song, the display will indicate “NEW REC.” 6 Rotate the GAIN control of input channel 1 all the way to the LINE position. 7 Set the input channel 1 fader between the 7 and 8 marks. 8 While playing your audio source, watch the track level meter and rotate the GAIN control once again to adjust the recording level. Ideally, the track level meter will indicate about –3 for the loudest sounds. If the recording level is too high even when the GAIN control is rotated all the way to the LINE position, lower the output level of the audio source. Tip: If you press PEAK HOLD to turn on the Peak Hold function, the level meter will hold the maximum level that was reached. For details on the PEAK HOLD button, refer to page 18. —Owner’s Manual 28 Basic operation ■ Monitor the signal being recorded on the track CUE bus (for tracks that are in record/recordpause mode this will be the recording source, or for tracks that are playing back this will be the playback sound of the track). 9 Press the MONITOR SELECT CUE switch to turn it on. The MONITOR SELECT switches choose the signal source that will be monitored. When the CUE switch is on, the signal from the CUE bus will be sent to the PHONES jack and the MONITOR OUT jacks, allowing you to monitor the sound through headphones or monitor speakers. A While listening to your headphones or monitor speakers, adjust the MONITOR LEVEL control to an appropriate volume. B As desired, use the EQ controls to adjust the tone. Adjusting the EQ controls will affect the recording level. When you finish adjusting the EQ controls, use the GAIN control to re-adjust the recording level as necessary. 0 Raise the CUE LEVEL control of input channel 1 to the 7–8 mark. The CUE LEVEL controls of input channels 1–4 adjust the signal that is sent from tracks 1–4 to the Start recording IN OUT MIDI 1 1 GAIN TRACK DIRECT OUT THRU 2TR IN STEREO OUT 1 MONITOR OUT 2 AUX SEND 2 MIC/LINE INPUT INSERT 3 I/O INSERT I/O LINE MIC/ LINE 2 GAIN MIC LINE PB MIC/ LINE FLIP LINE PB MIC/ LINE FLIP CUE CUE 0 PB MIC/ LINE L L 0 7/8 10 0 10 CH1 L CH4 R 0 1 2 3 4 L R L R PEAK HOLD DISPLAY EDIT UTILITY BUS L E V E L 10 HIGH REC SELECT CH2 CH3 CUE MIX TO STEREO P A N R 0 8 PB L E V E L 10 7 0 CUE R HIGH 6 5/6 MIC P A N L E V E L 10 5 FLIP CUE L E V E L HIGH LINE P A N R 4 4 GAIN MIC FLIP P A N L 3 GAIN MIC LINE INPUT MONITOR SELECT 10 EJECT 2TR IN HIGH 6 MULTITRACK MD RECORDER –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 PITCH STEREO ADJUST CUE EXIT 1 2 L R PAN 1 2 L R PAN 1 2 L R PAN 1 2 L R ENTER MONITOR LEVEL PAN REPEAT MIN MARK SEARCH MAX MARK 10 10 10 10 10 10 9 9 9 9 9 9 8 8 8 8 8 8 7 7 7 7 7 7 6 6 6 6 6 6 5 5 5 5 5 5 4 4 4 4 4 4 3 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 A B LAST REC SEARCH IN AUTO PUNCH I/O REHE OUT SONG SEARCH REC PLAY SET PAUSE STOP DATA CURSOR TOC WRITE 1 2 3 4 STEREO PHONES 4 ■ Begin recording 1 Make sure that the REC indicator is blinking. If it is not blinking, press the REC button. 2 Press the PLAY button. Recording will begin, and the track 1 track record indicator and the REC indicator will change from blinking to lit. Begin playing the audio source that you wish to record first. —Owner’s Manual PUNCH I/O 1 53 2 3 When you finish recording, press the STOP button. The transport will stop, and the track record indicator of track 1 will change to blinking. The display will indicate “Writing TOC” for a short time, and then the TOC EDIT indicator will go dark, indicating that the TOC has been updated automatically. Recording the first track (Direct Recording) ■ Listening to the first track 4 Press the LAST REC SEARCH [IN] button. This will locate to the point at which the previous recording was begun. (For details on the LAST REC SEARCH buttons, refer to page 17.) If this was the first recording, you will always return to the “00:00.00” location. 5 Press the PLAY button. If the input channel 1 FLIP switch is in the “MIC/ LINE ( )” position, the playback of track 1 can be monitored (via the CUE bus) from the PHONES jack or MONITOR OUT jacks. 29 If you decide to re-record this take, press the LAST REC SEARCH [IN] button, and repeat steps 1–4. If you wish to re-record just a portion of the track, you can use punch-in/out. See “Punch-in/out” on page 52 for more information. 6 If you are satisfied with the recording on track 1, press the REC SELECT switch. The track 1 track record indicator (DIR) will go dark. Note: If you forget to press the REC SELECT switch, track 1 will be erased when you record the next track. 1 GAIN LINE MIC MIC/ LINE MONITOR OUT L PB CUE Bus FLIP CUE P A N L R PHONES L E V E L 0 R 10 HIGH –15 MID +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 AUX +15 1 2 L R PAN Track 1 10 9 8 7 6 Track 2 5 4 3 2 Track 3 1 0 Track 4 Signal flow during track recording —Owner’s Manual 30 Basic operation Overdubbing Now that you have finished recording track 1, let’s record additional audio sources on other tracks while listening to the playback of this track. The basic procedure is the same as in “Recording the first track.” 1 IN OUT MIDI MIC/LINE INPUT INSERT 3 I/O INSERT I/O 1 GAIN LINE 2 LINE MIC MIC/ LINE 2 GAIN LINE 2TR IN STEREO OUT 1 MONITOR OUT 2 AUX SEND L 0 L 0 0 7/8 10 0 10 CH1 P A N L CH4 0 1 2 3 4 L R L R PEAK HOLD DISPLAY EDIT UTILITY BUS R L E V E L 10 HIGH REC SELECT CH2 CH3 CUE MIX TO STEREO R 0 8 PB L E V E L 10 HIGH MIC MIC/ LINE 7 FLIP L E V E L 10 HIGH 6 5/6 P A N R L E V E L 5 CUE P A N R 4 LINE PB FLIP CUE P A N LINE INPUT 4 GAIN MIC MIC/ LINE PB FLIP CUE L 3 GAIN MIC MIC/ LINE PB FLIP CUE 6 TRACK DIRECT OUT THRU 2 1 MONITOR SELECT 10 EJECT 2TR IN HIGH 30 MULTITRACK MD RECORDER –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 PITCH STEREO ADJUST CUE EXIT 1 2 L R PAN 1 2 L R 1 2 L R PAN PAN 1 2 L R ENTER MONITOR LEVEL PAN REPEAT MIN MARK SEARCH MAX MARK 10 10 10 10 10 10 9 9 9 9 9 9 8 8 8 8 8 8 7 7 7 7 7 7 6 6 6 6 6 6 5 5 5 5 5 5 4 4 4 4 4 4 3 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 A LAST REC SEARCH B IN AUTO PUNCH I/O REHE OUT SONG SEARCH REC PLAY SET PAUSE STOP DATA CURSOR TOC WRITE 1 2 3 4 STEREO PHONES 5 8 ■ Select the track to record 1 Connect the audio source to MIC/LINE INPUT jack 2. 2 Set the input channel 2 FLIP switch to the MIC/LINE ( ) position. At this time, leave the input channel 1 FLIP switch in the MIC/LINE ( ) position. 3 Press REC SELECT button 2. The track 2 track record indicator (DIR) will blink, and track 2 will be ready to record. Note: You must make sure that the track 1 record indicator (DIR) is dark. If it is blinking, press REC SELECT button 1. —Owner’s Manual PUNCH I/O 4 7 9 4 Press the REC button to enter record-pause mode. 5 While watching the track level meter, use the GAIN control and fader of input channel 2 to set the recording level. Overdubbing ■ Simultaneously monitoring the recording source and the track playback 31 ■ Listen to the recording 8 Press the LAST REC SEARCH [IN] button to 6 While playing the audio source that you wish to record, raise the CUE LEVEL control of input channel 2. Use the CUE LEVEL control of input channel 2 to adjust the monitor level of the signal that will be recorded on track 2. While listening to the sound in your headphones or monitor speakers, adjust the monitor level as desired. If you begin recording now, the playback sound from track 1 will be mixed with the track 2 recording source, and can be monitored via the CUE bus. ■ Start recording move to the location where you began recording track 2. If you wish to start listening from the beginning of the song, press the SONG SEARCH [ ] button. 9 Press the PLAY button to playback, and listen to the recording. 0 If you are satisfied with the recording, press the REC SELECT 2 button. The track 2 track recording indicator (DIR) will go dark. Go ahead and record the remaining tracks 3 and 4 by overdubbing in the same way. 7 Press the PLAY button to begin recording. When you finish recording, press the STOP button. 2 1 GAIN 2 GAIN LINE MIC LINE MIC/ LINE PB MIC/ LINE FLIP MIC CUE bus CUE P A N L P A N R L R L E V E L 0 PHONES L E V E L 10 HIGH MONITOR OUT L PB FLIP CUE 0 R 10 HIGH –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 1 2 PAN 1 2 L R PAN L R 10 10 9 9 8 8 7 7 6 6 5 5 4 4 3 3 2 2 1 1 0 0 1 Track 1 Track 2 Track 3 Track 4 2 Signal flow during overdubbing —Owner’s Manual 32 Basic operation Mixdown When you have finished recording the four tracks, let’s mixdown the recorded tracks to stereo, and record the mix on a master recorder. 1 MONITOR STEREO OUT OUT L L AUX SEND 1 2 1 MONITOR OUT AC IN 2TR IN L STEREO OUT POWER ON/ OFF 4 2 MIDI OUT THRU TRACK DIRECT OUT 3 1 IN 1 LINE 2 2TR IN 2 AUX SEND 2 MIC/LINE INPUT INSERT 3 I/O INSERT I/O GAIN R TRACK DIRECT OUT R THRU R OUT MIDI IN 1 MIC/ LINE 2 GAIN MIC LINE PB MIC/ LINE FLIP LINE PB MIC/ LINE CUE 0 PB MIC/ LINE 0 7/8 10 0 10 CH1 L CH4 0 1 2 3 4 L R L R PEAK HOLD DISPLAY EDIT UTILITY BUS R L E V E L 10 MONITOR SELECT 10 EJECT 2TR IN HIGH HIGH REC SELECT CH2 CH3 CUE MIX TO STEREO P A N R 0 8 PB L E V E L 10 7 0 CUE L HIGH 6 5/6 MIC P A N R L E V E L 10 5 FLIP P A N L L E V E L HIGH LINE CUE P A N R 4 4 GAIN MIC FLIP FLIP CUE L 3 GAIN MIC LINE INPUT MULTITRACK MD RECORDER –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 LOW –15 AUX +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 AUX –15 MID +15 +15 –15 LOW +15 +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 MID +15 +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 AUX PITCH STEREO ADJUST 9 3 CUE EXIT 1 2 L R PAN 1 2 L R 1 2 L R PAN PAN ENTER 1 2 L R MONITOR LEVEL PAN REPEAT MIN MARK SEARCH MAX MARK 10 10 10 10 10 10 9 9 9 9 9 9 8 8 8 8 8 8 7 7 7 7 7 7 6 6 6 6 6 6 5 5 5 5 5 5 4 4 4 4 4 4 3 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 A B LAST REC SEARCH IN AUTO PUNCH I/O REHE OUT SONG SEARCH REC PLAY SET PAUSE STOP DATA 6 1 2 3 4 STEREO PHONES 4 ■ Connecting a master recorder 1 Connect the STEREO OUT jacks of the MD4S to the input jacks of your master recorder. Connect the output jacks of your master recorder to the 2TR IN jacks of the MD4S. ■ Adjust the mix balance of each track 2 Set the FLIP switches of input channels 1–4 to the “PB ( )” position. When the FLIP switches are set to the “PB ( )” position, the playback sound of the corresponding track will be sent to the input channel, allowing you to use the EQ controls to adjust the tone, and use the PAN control to set the stereo (left/right) position. The signals of input channels 1–4 (the —Owner’s Manual CURSOR TOC WRITE 5 7 PUNCH I/O 8 track playback sound) will be mixed in stereo, and output via the ST bus to the STEREO OUT jacks. 3 Turn on the MONITOR SELECT STEREO switch. The ST bus will be selected as the signal source for monitoring. Now you can use headphones or monitor speakers connected to the PHONES jack or MONITOR OUT jacks to monitor the same signal as is being output from the STEREO OUT jacks. 4 Set the STEREO fader to the 7–8 mark. 5 Press the SONG SEARCH [ ] button to locate to the beginning of the song (the start point), and press the PLAY button to begin playback. Mixdown 33 ■ Record to your master recorder 6 While listening through the headphones or monitor speakers, use the faders, PAN controls, and EQ controls of input channels 1–4 to adjust the mixdown. First, use the PAN controls to set the left/right balance. Next, adjust the faders to set the volume balance of each track. At the ideal level, the +12 mark of the stereo level meter should light occasionally. Make fine adjustments to the STEREO fader as necessary. Finally, use the EQ controls as desired to adjust the tone, and re-adjust the volume levels if necessary. When the mix balance is complete, you can record the result to your master recorder. 7 Put your master recorder in record mode, and playback the MD4S song from the beginning. 8 When the mixdown is finished, stop the MD4S and the master recorder. ■ Listen to the master recording 9 Press the MONITOR SELECT 2TR IN switch. Now the playback of your master recorder that is being sent to the 2TR IN jacks will be sent to the PHONES jack and the MONITOR OUT jacks. 0 Playback your master recorder from the beginning of the song and listen to the master recording. Use the MONITOR LEVEL control to adjust the monitor level. Track 1 Track 2 1 GAIN LINE MIC/ LINE 2 GAIN MIC LINE PB MIC/ LINE FLIP 3 GAIN MIC LINE PB MIC/ LINE FLIP CUE CUE R 0 10 LINE PB MIC/ LINE CUE L R 0 10 Track 4 PB CUE P A N L R 0 10 L E V E L HIGH MIC FLIP P A N L E V E L HIGH Track 3 MIC FLIP P A N L 4 GAIN P A N L R 0 10 L E V E L HIGH L E V E L HIGH –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 MONITOR OUT L STEREO OUT L R R PHONES 1 2 PAN 1 2 PAN L R 1 2 PAN L R 1 2 ST bus PAN L R L 10 10 10 10 9 9 9 9 8 8 8 8 7 7 7 7 6 6 6 6 5 5 5 5 4 4 4 4 3 3 3 3 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 R 10 10 9 9 8 8 7 7 6 6 5 5 4 4 3 3 2 2 1 1 0 0 STEREO 1 2 3 4 Signal flow during mixdown —Owner’s Manual 34 Basic operation After completing the Basic Operation section In the preceding pages, you have learned the basic procedure for recording four parts, mixing them in stereo, and mixing down to a master recorder. However by taking full advantage of the functionality that the MD4S provides, you can use more sophisticated recording methods and editing techniques. The following page, “Advanced techniques on the MD4S,” introduces the wide variety of functionality provided by the MD4S. You can look through the list to find a topic in which you are especially interested, and continue reading from the appropriate page. —Owner’s Manual Advanced recording techniques 35 Advanced recording techniques In this chapter we will introduce more advanced topics, such as more sophisticated recording techniques and editing techniques. Advanced techniques on the MD4S In addition to the functionality described on the preceding pages, the MD4S provides the functionality listed below. These functions are actually the core capabilities of the MD4S, and by taking full advantage of them, you will find that the expressive power of the MD4S will take a dramatic leap. Please become familiar with these advanced techniques so that you can enjoy the full potential of the MD4S. • Record a greater number of parts → Mixing multiple channels as you record ..............page 36 → Ping-pong recording..............................................page 39 → Adding sounds during mixdown ..........................page 42 • Apply effects while you record/mixdown → Applying effects ......................................................page 44 • Re-record over a mistake → Punch-in/out..........................................................page 52 • Jump immediately to a specific location in a song → Quick search functions ..........................................page 61 • Playback a song repeatedly • Program the playback order of the songs → Various playback functions....................................page 66 • Edit a song you recorded → Editing functions....................................................page 73 • Modify the pitch as you record/playback → Other functions......................................................page 84 • Record with a MIDI sequencer • Control the MD4S from a MIDI sequencer → MIDI functions ......................................................page 90 —Owner’s Manual 36 Advanced recording techniques Mixing multiple channels as you record By combining multiple parts into a pair of tracks, you can record more than four parts on the MD4S. For example if you have recorded drums, bass, and rhythm guitar, you can re-record these three parts in stereo onto two tracks, and then record two other parts on the remaining two tracks. To do this, you will mix the signals of the input channels to the ST bus and record them on either one or two tracks.. MD4S Stereo mix Track 1 Drums+Guitar+ Bass Drums Track 2 Track 3 Track 4 Guitar Bass As an example, the following will explain how four audio sources connected to MIC/LINE INPUT jacks 1–4 can be mixed in stereo and recorded onto tracks 1 and 2. 1 IN OUT MIDI 1 6 2 9 8 1 GAIN TRACK DIRECT OUT THRU 2TR IN STEREO OUT 1 MONITOR OUT 2 AUX SEND 2 MIC/LINE INPUT INSERT 3 I/O INSERT I/O LINE MIC/ LINE GAIN GAIN MIC LINE PB MIC/ LINE FLIP LINE PB MIC/ LINE CUE CUE L MIC/ LINE 0 0 8 7/8 10 0 3 10 PB CH1 P A N L CH4 L E V E L 10 0 1 2 3 4 L R L R PEAK HOLD DISPLAY EDIT UTILITY BUS R L E V E L HIGH REC SELECT CH2 CH3 CUE MIX TO STEREO R 0 7 5/6 MIC P A N L 10 HIGH 6 FLIP L E V E L 10 5 CUE R L E V E L 0 PB P A N R HIGH LINE CUE P A N L MIC FLIP FLIP 4 4 GAIN MIC LINE INPUT MONITOR SELECT 10 EJECT 2TR IN HIGH MULTITRACK MD RECORDER 7 –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 PITCH STEREO ADJUST CUE EXIT 1 2 L R PAN 1 2 L R 1 2 L R PAN PAN 1 2 L R ENTER MONITOR LEVEL PAN REPEAT MIN MARK SEARCH MAX MARK 10 10 10 10 10 10 9 9 9 9 9 9 8 8 8 8 8 8 7 7 7 7 7 7 6 6 6 6 6 6 5 5 5 5 5 5 4 4 4 4 4 4 3 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 A B LAST REC SEARCH IN AUTO PUNCH I/O REHE OUT SONG SEARCH REC PLAY SET PAUSE STOP DATA CURSOR TOC WRITE 1 2 3 4 STEREO PHONES 5 —Owner’s Manual C 4 AB C PUNCH I/O Mixing multiple channels as you record 1 Connect the audio sources to MIC/LINE INPUT jacks 1–4. If necessary, you can also mix line level devices such as synthesizers connected to LINE INPUT jacks 5 and 6 or 7 and 8. 2 Set the FLIP switch of input channels 1–4 to “MIC/LINE ( ).” 3 While holding down the BUS button, press REC SELECT buttons 1 and 2. The track recording indicators for tracks 1 and 2 (BUS/L,R) will blink. The signal of an input channel whose FLIP switch is set to “MIC/LINE ( )” will be sent to the ST bus. Also, if the REC SELECT button of a track is pressed while holding down the BUS button, the signal from the ST bus will be selected as the recording source for that track. In this case, the L channel signal of the ST bus will be assigned to track 1, and the R channel signal of the ST bus will be assigned to track 2. 4 Press the REC button. The REC indicator will blink, and the MD4S will be in record-pause mode. 5 Set the faders of input channels 1–4 and the STEREO fader to the 7–8 mark. 6 Watch the track level meters, and use the GAIN control and faders of input channels 1– 4 and the STEREO fader to adjust the recording level. Use the PAN controls of input channels 1–4 to adjust the stereo position of each audio source. Tip: You may find it easiest to first adjust the GAIN controls while you play each audio source separately, then use the input channel faders to adjust the volume balance, and finally use the STEREO fader to adjust the overall recording level. 37 9 Rotate the CUE PAN controls of input channels 1 and 2 to far left and far right respectively. This makes the CUE bus signal stereo, and allows you to monitor the same sound image as is being recorded. Note: In this situation, the CUE bus and the ST bus have the same signal content. Be aware that if the MONITOR SELECT CUE switch and the STEREO switch are both on, the sound being monitored in the PHONES jack or the MONITOR OUT jacks will appear unnatural. 0 Listen to the headphones or monitor speakers, and adjust the volume and pan of each input channel. As necessary, use the EQ controls to adjust the tone. A Press the PLAY button to begin recording. The track recording indicators (BUS) of tracks 1 and 2 will change to steadily lit. B When you finish recording, press the STOP button. The TOC will be automatically updated, and the track recording indicators (BUS) of tracks 1 and 2 will change to blinking. C Press the LAST REC SEARCH [IN] button to locate to the point at which recording began, and press the PLAY button to hear the recording. If you are satisfied with the recording, press REC SELECT buttons 1 and 2. The track recording indicators (BUS/L,R) will go dark. 7 Turn on the MONITOR SELECT CUE switch. The signal of the CUE bus will be sent to the PHONES jack and the MONITOR OUT jacks. Turn off the MONITOR SELECT STEREO switch. 8 Set the CUE LEVEL controls of input channels 1 and 2 to the 7–8 range. This allows the recording source for tracks 1 and 2 (in this case, the signals from input channels 1–4) be monitored in the CUE bus. —Owner’s Manual 38 Advanced recording techniques 1 2 1 GAIN 3 2 GAIN 4 3 GAIN 4 GAIN LINE MIC LINE MIC LINE MIC LINE MIC MIC/ LINE PB MIC/ LINE PB MIC/ LINE PB MIC/ LINE PB FLIP FLIP CUE FLIP CUE P A N L L 0 P A N R L E V E L L 0 L R L E V E L 10 HIGH P A N R L E V E L 10 HIGH CUE P A N R 0 PHONES L E V E L 10 HIGH MONITOR OUT L CUE bus FLIP CUE 0 R 10 HIGH –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 L 1 2 PAN 1 2 PAN L R 1 2 PAN L R 1 2 L R L R Track 2 10 10 10 10 10 10 9 9 9 9 9 9 8 8 8 8 8 8 7 7 7 7 7 7 6 6 6 6 6 6 5 5 5 5 5 5 4 4 4 4 4 4 3 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 2 3 4 STEREO Signal flow when mixing multiple channels —Owner’s Manual Track 1 ST bus PAN R Track 3 Track 4 Ping-pong recording 39 Ping-pong recording The process of mixing two or more previously-recorded tracks and re-recording them onto one or two tracks is called “ping-pong recording.” By ping-ponging, you can free up other tracks to record additional parts, so this is a useful technique when you wish to record a larger number of parts than you have actual tracks. Since the MD4S records signals digitally, it is able to playback a track while recording onto the same track. Thus, while a conventional cassettetape type MTR needs one or two vacant tracks in order to ping-pong, the MD4S allows you to ping-pong even if there are no unused tracks. MD4S Stereo mix Track 1 Track 1 Drums Track 2 Guitar Track 3 Bass Track 3 Track 4 Vocal Track 4 Drums+Guitar+ Bass+Vocal Track 2 The following diagram shows the process of mixing four recorded tracks into a stereo pair, and continuing to overdub while ping-pong recording additional tracks. Ping-pong recording Overdubbing (parts E and F) Ping-pong recording Overdubbing (parts G and H) Track 1 A A (vacant) E E (vacant) G Track 2 B B (vacant) F F (vacant) H A+B+C+D +E+F A+B+C+D +E+F (STEREO) (STEREO) Track 3 Track 4 C L D R L A+B+C+D A+B+C+D (STEREO) (STEREO) R Mixdown (parts A~H) Note: Since the MD4S records data in digital form, repeated ping-pong recording as shown above will not impair the audio quality. However, please be aware that since the MD4S’s mixer section is analog, repeated ping-pong recording will result in a very small decrease in audio quality (although compared to the result of ping-pong recording on a tape MTR, this loss will be virtually undetectable). Tip: If you ping-pong record tracks 1–4 to tracks 3 and 4 as shown above, the content that had been recorded on tracks 3 and 4 will be erased. Before you ping-pong record, we recommend that you copy the song to backup the original. (See “Copying/converting a song (Song Copy)” on page 76 for more information.) —Owner’s Manual 40 Advanced recording techniques In the following, we will give an example of mixing previously-recorded tracks 1–4 into a stereo pair, and ping-pong recording them to tracks 3 and 4. IN OUT MIDI 1 1 GAIN LINE 1 TRACK DIRECT OUT THRU 2TR IN STEREO OUT 1 MONITOR OUT 2 AUX SEND 2 MIC/LINE INPUT INSERT 3 I/O INSERT I/O MIC/ LINE 2 GAIN MIC LINE PB MIC/ LINE FLIP LINE PB MIC/ LINE FLIP CUE P A N 0 PB MIC/ LINE L 0 0 7/8 10 0 2 10 CH1 P A N L CH4 0 1 2 3 4 L R L R PEAK HOLD DISPLAY EDIT UTILITY BUS R L E V E L 10 HIGH REC SELECT CH3 CH2 CUE MIX TO STEREO R 0 8 PB L E V E L 10 7 5/6 MIC P A N R HIGH 6 CUE L E V E L 10 5 FLIP P A N L L E V E L HIGH LINE CUE R 4 4 GAIN MIC FLIP CUE L 3 GAIN MIC LINE INPUT MONITOR SELECT 10 EJECT 2TR IN HIGH MULTITRACK MD RECORDER –15 MID +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 MID +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 MID +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 MID +15 –15 LOW +15 PITCH STEREO ADJUST 9 3 CUE EXIT –15 AUX +15 1 2 L R –15 AUX +15 1 2 L R PAN PAN –15 AUX +15 1 2 L R PAN –15 AUX +15 1 2 L R ENTER MONITOR LEVEL PAN REPEAT 7 MIN MARK SEARCH MAX MARK 10 10 10 10 10 10 9 9 9 9 9 9 8 8 8 8 8 8 7 7 7 7 7 7 6 6 6 6 6 6 5 5 5 5 5 5 4 4 4 4 4 4 3 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 A B LAST REC SEARCH IN AUTO PUNCH I/O REHE OUT SONG SEARCH REC PLAY A SET PAUSE STOP DATA CURSOR TOC WRITE 1 2 3 4 STEREO PHONES 0 4568 78 1 Set the FLIP switches of input channels 1–4 to “PB ( ).” The playback sound of tracks 1–4 will be sent via the input channels to the ST bus. Tip: If you use LINE INPUT jacks 5–8, the audio sources connected to LINE INPUT jacks 5–8 can be added to tracks 1–4 as you ping-pong record. The input level of LINE INPUT jacks 5–8 can be adjusted by the LEVEL controls 5/6 and 7/8. 2 While holding down the BUS button, press REC SELECT buttons 3 and 4. The ST bus will be selected as the recording source for tracks 3 and 4, and the track record indicators (BUS/L, R) will blink. Make sure that the track record indicators for tracks 1 and 2 are dark. 3 Turn on the MONITOR SELECT STEREO switch. The ST bus will be selected as the signal source for —Owner’s Manual PUNCH I/O 9 monitoring, allowing you to monitor the playback sound of tracks 1–4. Make sure that the MONITOR SELECT CUE switch is off. 4 Set the STEREO fader in the 7–8 range. 5 Press the SONG SEARCH [ ] button to locate to the beginning of the song. 6 Press the REHE button, and then press the PLAY button to begin rehearsing the pingpong recording. 7 While listening to your monitoring headphones or monitor speakers, use the faders and PAN controls of input channels 1–4 to adjust the mix balance of tracks 1–4. As necessary, use the EQ controls to adjust the tone. When you finish adjusting the mix balance, watch the track level meters of tracks 3 and 4 as you adjust the STEREO fader to set the recording level. (At the ideal level, the –3 segment of the meter will light at the peaks.) Ping-pong recording 8 When you have finished adjusting the mix 41 0 Set the faders of input channels 3 and 4 in balance and recording level, press the SONG SEARCH [ ] button to locate to the beginning of the song, and then press the REC button and PLAY button to begin ping-pong recording. the 7–8 range, and rotate the PAN controls to far left and far right respectively. Set all EQ controls to the 12 o’clock position (flat). At this time, lower the faders of input channels 1 and 2 to zero. 9 When ping-pong recording ends, press the A Press the LAST REC SEARCH [IN] button to STOP button, and then press REC SELECT buttons 3 and 4. locate to the point at which ping-pong recording began, and while using the MONITOR LEVEL control to adjust the monitor level, listen to the recorded content of tracks 3 and 4. Track 1 Track 2 1 GAIN 2 GAIN 3 GAIN 4 GAIN Track 3 LINE MIC LINE MIC LINE MIC LINE MIC MIC/ LINE PB MIC/ LINE PB MIC/ LINE PB MIC/ LINE PB FLIP FLIP CUE FLIP CUE P A N L L 0 L 0 L R L E V E L 10 HIGH P A N R L E V E L 10 HIGH P A N R L E V E L R CUE P A N R Track 4 FLIP CUE L 0 L E V E L 10 HIGH 0 MONITOR OUT L 10 HIGH –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 PHONES 1 2 PAN 1 2 PAN L R 1 2 PAN L R R 1 2 ST Bus PAN L R L R 10 10 10 10 10 10 9 9 9 9 9 9 8 8 8 8 8 8 7 7 7 7 7 7 6 6 6 6 6 6 5 5 5 5 5 5 4 4 4 4 4 4 3 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 2 3 4 STEREO Signal flow for ping-pong recording —Owner’s Manual 42 Advanced recording techniques Adding sounds during mixdown The mixer section of the MD4S features an “in-line” design that can simultaneously handle both the input signal from the MIC/LINE INPUT jack and the playback sound from the disk. For example, this allows you to add external input signals during mixdown. This is convenient, for example, when you wish to layer some sound effects onto the introduction of a song that you completed on the MD4S. MD4S Master recorder Track 1 Drums Track 2 Guitar Track 3 Bass Track 4 Vocal Stereo mix External audio source In the following, we will give an example of how audio sources connected to MIC/LINE INPUT jacks 1 and 2 can be added during mixdown. IN OUT MIDI 1 THRU TRACK DIRECT OUT 2TR IN STEREO OUT 1 MONITOR OUT 2 AUX SEND 2 MIC/LINE INPUT INSERT 3 I/O INSERT I/O LINE INPUT 4 5 6 7 8 2 6 1 GAIN LINE MIC/ LINE 2 GAIN MIC LINE MIC/ LINE PB FLIP LINE 0 0 10 HIGH L CH1 P A N R 0 10 L CH4 0 1 2 3 4 L R L R PEAK HOLD DISPLAY EDIT UTILITY BUS R L E V E L 10 HIGH REC SELECT CH2 CH3 CUE MIX TO STEREO L E V E L 10 HIGH 0 PB P A N R 7/8 10 FLIP L E V E L L E V E L 0 CUE P A N L 5/6 MIC MIC/ LINE PB FLIP P A N 4 LINE CUE R 4 GAIN MIC MIC/ LINE PB FLIP CUE CUE L 3 GAIN MIC MONITOR SELECT 10 EJECT 2TR IN HIGH 3 MULTITRACK MD RECORDER –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 PITCH STEREO ADJUST CUE EXIT 1 2 L R PAN 1 2 L R PAN 1 2 L R PAN 1 2 L R ENTER MONITOR LEVEL PAN REPEAT MIN MARK SEARCH MAX MARK 10 10 10 10 10 10 9 9 9 9 9 9 8 8 8 8 8 8 7 7 7 7 7 7 6 6 6 6 6 6 5 5 5 5 5 5 4 4 4 4 4 4 3 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 A B LAST REC SEARCH IN AUTO PUNCH I/O REHE OUT SONG SEARCH REC PLAY SET PAUSE STOP DATA CURSOR 5 TOC WRITE 1 2 3 4 STEREO PHONES 1 Make preparations for mixdown. See “Mixdown” on page 32, adjust the mix balance of each track, and complete the steps up until you are ready to mixdown (steps 1–6). 2 Connect your audio sources to MIC/LINE INPUT jacks 1 and 2. When the FLIP switch of the input channel is in —Owner’s Manual PUNCH I/O the “PB ( )” position, the tape playback sound will be set to the ST bus, and the input signal from the MIC/LINE INPUT jack will be sent via the CUE PAN/LEVEL control to the CUE bus. In this case, the input signals from MIC/LINE INPUT jacks 1 and 2 will be sent via the CUE PAN/LEVEL controls of input channels 1 and 2 to the CUE bus. Adding sounds during mixdown 3 Turn on the CUE MIX TO STEREO switch. 43 LEVEL control. If necessary, you can use the CUE PAN controls to adjust the stereo position. (If you are adding a stereo source, set the CUE PAN controls of input channels 1 and 2 to far left and far right respectively.) The cue mix function will be turned on, and the CUE MIX indicator in the display will light. With this setting, the signal of the CUE bus (the MIC/ LINE INPUT jack input signal) will be mixed into the ST bus. 7 After you have adjusted the input signal levels from MIC/LINE INPUT jacks 1 and 2, start recording on your master recorder, and playback the MD4S from the beginning of the song. When recording is completed, playback the master recorder to hear the recorded result. 4 Set the CUE LEVEL controls of input channels 1 and 2 in the 7–8 range. 5 Press the PLAY button to begin playback. If the MONITOR SELECT STEREO switch is on, you will be able to hear the track playback in your headphones or monitor speakers. Tip: The input signals from LINE INPUT jacks 5–8 can be added to the mix during mixdown. However since LINE INPUT jacks 5/6 and 7/8 are stereo pairs, LINE INPUT jacks 5 and 7 will be mixed directly to the L channel of the ST bus, and LINE INPUT jacks 6 and 8 will be mixed directly to the R channel of the ST bus. If you wish to use microphones or to adjust the pan, you should use the MIC/LINE INPUT jacks. 6 Play the audio sources that are connected to MIC/LINE INPUT jacks 1 and 2, and use the GAIN controls of input channels 1 and 2 to adjust the input level. Use the stereo level meter to check the input levels together with the track playback sound. If the level is too high even when the GAIN control is rotated all the way to the LINE position, lower the CUE Track 1 1 2 Track 2 Track 3 1 GAIN LINE GAIN MIC MIC/ LINE 2 LINE GAIN MIC MIC/ LINE PB FLIP LINE P A N 0 P A N R L 0 L R L E V E L 10 HIGH P A N R L E V E L 10 HIGH PB FLIP CUE P A N L E V E L MIC MIC/ LINE PB CUE L Track 4 LINE FLIP CUE R 4 GAIN MIC MIC/ LINE PB FLIP CUE L 3 0 L E V E L 10 HIGH 0 CUE Bus 10 HIGH –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 MONITOR OUT L STEREO OUT L R R CUE MIX TO STEREO PHONES 1 2 PAN 1 2 PAN L R 1 2 PAN L R 1 2 ST Bus PAN L R L R 10 10 10 10 10 10 9 9 9 9 9 9 8 8 8 8 8 8 7 7 7 7 7 7 6 6 6 6 6 6 5 5 5 5 5 5 4 4 4 4 4 4 3 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 2 3 4 STEREO Signal flow when adding external signals during mixdown —Owner’s Manual 44 Advanced recording techniques Applying effects Here we will explain how external effects can be applied as you record tracks or during mixdown. If you wish to apply effects to the input signal of an input channel or to the playback sound of a track, two methods are available: using the INSERT I/O jack or using the AUX SEND jack. Using the INSERT I/O jacks Input channels 1 and 2 of the MD4S provide INSERT I/O jacks for inserting external effect processors. By using these jacks, you can apply an effect only to a specific channel/track as you record a track or while you mixdown. Normally, the technique of applying an effect via the INSERT I/O jack is used for effects which affect the dynamics or tone of the original sound (e.g., compressor, limiter, noise gate, equalizer etc.). Applying an effect to a specific track as you record MD4S Track 1 Bass Bass Track 2 Track 3 Track 4 INSERT I/O jacks Effect processor The INSERT I/O jacks accommodate TRS (tip, ring, sleeve) phone plugs. The signal of the input channel is sent from the tip of the INSERT I/O jack to the external effect unit, and the signal that has been processed by the external effect unit is sent via the ring of the INSERT I/O jack back into the input channel. —Owner’s Manual Applying effects 0 45 10 HIGH –15 MID +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 AUX +15 Tip Ring Input jack of the external effect processor Sleeve INSERT I/O Sleeve 1 2 L R INSERT I/O jack PAN Tip Output jack of the external effect processor 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Signal flow through the INSERT I/O jack and the insertion cable In order to use the INSERT I/O jack to apply an external effect, you will a special insertion cable as shown in the above diagram. Use the insertion cable to connect the external effect processor as shown in the following diagram. External effect processor Input jack Output jack Insertion cable IN OUT MIDI 1 THRU 1 GAIN LINE MIC/LINE INPUT INSERT 3 I/O MIC/ LINE 2 GAIN MIC LINE LINE 2TR IN STEREO OUT 1 MONITOR OUT 2 AUX SEND L R 0 0 7 8 7/8 10 0 10 PB FLIP CH1 R L CH4 0 10 1 2 3 4 L R L R PEAK HOLD DISPLAY EDIT UTILITY BUS R L E V E L 10 HIGH REC SELECT CH2 CH3 CUE MIX TO STEREO P A N L E V E L 10 HIGH 0 CUE L 6 5/6 P A N L E V E L 10 5 MIC MIC/ LINE PB FLIP L E V E L HIGH LINE CUE P A N R LINE INPUT 4 4 GAIN MIC MIC/ LINE PB FLIP CUE P A N 0 3 GAIN MIC MIC/ LINE PB FLIP CUE L TRACK DIRECT OUT 2 INSERT I/O MONITOR SELECT EJECT 2TR IN HIGH MULTITRACK MD RECORDER –15 +15 –15 +15 –15 +15 –15 +15 PITCH ADJUST External effect connections when using an insertion cable After making these connections, you can record tracks or perform a mixdown in the same way as usual. When the FLIP switch is in the “MIC/LINE ( )” position, the effect will be applied to the input signal from MIC/LINE INPUT jack 1 or 2. When the FLIP switch is in the “PB ( )” position, the effect will be applied to the playback sound of track 1 or 2. —Owner’s Manual 46 Advanced recording techniques Using the AUX SEND jacks When the AUX SEND jacks of the MD4S are used, a single external effect processor can be used simultaneously by two or more input channels. For example when you are re-recording several channels to two tracks or when mixing down, you can use this method to apply an effect such as delay or reverb while adjusting the depth of the effect independently for each channel (track). Applying an effect with a different depth for each track as you mixdown MD4S Master recorder Track 1 Drums Track 2 Guitar Track 3 Bass Track 4 Vocal Stereo mix AUX SEND jacks Effect processor When using the AUX SEND jacks to connect an external effect processor, connect the AUX SEND jacks 1 or 2 to the input jacks of the external effect processor, and connect the output jacks of the effect processor to LINE INPUT jacks 5 and 6 or 7 and 8. Effect processor 1 Output jack L IN OUT MIDI 1 THRU 1 LINE MIC/LINE INPUT INSERT 3 I/O MIC/ LINE 2 GAIN MIC LINE LINE 2TR IN STEREO OUT 1 MONITOR OUT Output jack L R Input jack 2 AUX SEND 0 0 8 7/8 10 0 10 PB CH1 P A N R L CH4 0 10 1 2 3 4 L R L R PEAK HOLD DISPLAY EDIT UTILITY BUS R L E V E L 10 HIGH REC SELECT CH2 CH3 CUE MIX TO STEREO L E V E L 10 HIGH 7 FLIP L E V E L 10 HIGH 0 CUE L 6 5/6 P A N R L E V E L 5 MIC MIC/ LINE PB FLIP P A N L 4 LINE CUE P A N R LINE INPUT 4 GAIN MIC MIC/ LINE PB FLIP CUE 0 3 GAIN MIC MIC/ LINE PB FLIP CUE L TRACK DIRECT OUT Input jack 2 INSERT I/O GAIN R Effect processor 2 MONITOR SELECT EJECT 2TR IN HIGH MULTITRACK MD RECORDER –15 +15 –15 +15 –15 +15 –15 +15 PITCH ADJUST External effect connections when using the AUX SEND jacks With this setup, rotating the AUX controls of the input channels toward the 1 or 2 position will mix the signals from the input channels (in mono) and send them via the AUX SEND 1 or 2 jack to the external effect processor. The output signals from the effect processor will be mixed via the LINE INPUT jacks 5 and 6 (or 7 and 8) into the ST bus. Normally, the technique of using the AUX SEND jacks to apply effects is used for effects in which the original sound is mixed with the processed sound (e.g., delay, reverb, chorus etc.). In general, you should make settings on the effect processor so that it will output only the processed sound, and use the MD4S mixer to adjust the mix of the original sound (the signal sent from the input channel to the ST bus) and the effect sound (the signal sent via LINE INPUT jacks 5–8 to the ST bus). —Owner’s Manual Applying effects 47 Applying effects during mixdown Applying an effect such as reverb to each track during a mixdown is an example of a situation in which you would connect the external effect processor to the AUX SEND jack. In this case, you can use the AUX control of each input channel to adjust the effect depth for each track. 1 IN OUT MIDI 1 THRU MIC/LINE INPUT INSERT 3 I/O INSERT I/O 4 1 GAIN TRACK DIRECT OUT 2TR IN STEREO OUT 1 MONITOR OUT 2 AUX SEND 2 LINE MIC MIC/ LINE 2 GAIN LINE MIC MIC/ LINE PB FLIP LINE L 0 L 0 10 0 0 10 CH1 P A N L L E V E L 10 HIGH REC SELECT CH2 CH3 CH4 0 1 2 3 4 L R L R PEAK HOLD DISPLAY EDIT UTILITY BUS R L E V E L 10 HIGH 7/8 CUE MIX TO STEREO R L E V E L 10 0 8 PB P A N R L E V E L 7 FLIP CUE P A N R 6 5/6 MIC MIC/ LINE CUE P A N HIGH LINE PB FLIP CUE 5 4 4 GAIN MIC MIC/ LINE PB FLIP CUE L 3 GAIN LINE INPUT MONITOR SELECT 10 EJECT 2TR IN HIGH MULTITRACK MD RECORDER –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 LOW –15 AUX –15 MID +15 +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 AUX –15 MID +15 +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 PITCH STEREO ADJUST CUE EXIT 3 1 2 L R PAN 1 2 L R PAN 1 2 L R PAN 1 2 L R ENTER MONITOR LEVEL PAN REPEAT MIN MARK SEARCH MAX MARK 10 10 10 10 10 10 9 9 9 9 9 9 8 8 8 8 8 8 7 7 7 7 7 7 6 6 6 6 6 6 5 5 5 5 5 5 4 4 4 4 4 4 3 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 A B LAST REC SEARCH IN AUTO PUNCH I/O REHE OUT SONG SEARCH REC PLAY SET 5 PAUSE STOP DATA CURSOR TOC WRITE 1 2 3 4 STEREO PHONES 1 Connect the AUX SEND 1 jack to the input jack of your effect processor, and connect the output jacks of the effect processor to LINE INPUT jacks 5 and 6. Make settings on the effect processor so that its output jacks will output only the effect sound. 2 Prepare for mixdown. As described in “Mixdown” (page 32), adjust the mix balance of each track, and perform the steps leading up to mixdown (steps 1–6). PUNCH I/O 4 Raise level control 5/6. The effect sound processed by the external effect processor will be mixed into the ST bus. Raising the level control will increase the overall effect. 5 When you are finished adjusting the effect depth, press the SONG SEARCH [ ] button to locate to the beginning of the song, and begin the mixdown. 3 Press the PLAY button to playback the song, and for each input channel to which you wish to apply the effect, rotate the AUX control toward the “1” position. The signals from input channels 1–4 (the playback of tracks 1–4) will be sent to the external effect processor connected to the AUX SEND 1 jack. Adjust the input level of the effect processor if necessary. —Owner’s Manual 48 Advanced recording techniques Applying an effect during ping-pong recording By using the AUX SEND jacks you can apply spatial-type effects such as reverb or chorus during ping-pong recording as well. This technique is particularly useful when you wish to pingpong in stereo down to two tracks. The following will explain how to apply an effect to the playback of tracks 1–4 as you ping-pong them in stereo to tracks 3 and 4. 1 IN OUT MIDI 1 9 1 GAIN TRACK DIRECT OUT THRU 2TR IN STEREO OUT 1 MONITOR OUT 2 AUX SEND 2 MIC/LINE INPUT INSERT 3 I/O INSERT I/O LINE MIC/ LINE 2 GAIN MIC LINE PB MIC/ LINE FLIP LINE PB MIC/ LINE FLIP CUE CUE 0 PB MIC/ LINE L 0 L 7/8 10 0 2 10 CH1 L CH4 0 1 2 3 4 L R L R PEAK HOLD DISPLAY EDIT UTILITY BUS R L E V E L 10 HIGH REC SELECT CH3 CH2 CUE MIX TO STEREO P A N R 0 8 PB L E V E L 10 HIGH 5/6 CUE R 7 0 MIC P A N L E V E L 10 6 FLIP CUE L E V E L HIGH LINE P A N R 5 4 4 GAIN MIC FLIP P A N L 3 GAIN MIC LINE INPUT MONITOR SELECT 10 EJECT 2TR IN HIGH MULTITRACK MD RECORDER –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 PITCH STEREO ADJUST 3 CUE EXIT 8 –15 AUX +15 AUX 1 2 L R 1 2 L R PAN PAN –15 AUX AUX 1 2 L R PAN +15 1 2 L R ENTER MONITOR LEVEL PAN REPEAT 7 MIN MARK SEARCH MAX MARK 10 10 10 10 10 10 9 9 9 9 9 9 8 8 8 8 8 8 7 7 7 7 7 7 6 6 6 6 6 6 5 5 5 5 5 5 4 4 4 4 4 4 3 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 A B LAST REC SEARCH IN AUTO PUNCH I/O REHE OUT SONG SEARCH REC PLAY SET 6 PAUSE STOP DATA CURSOR TOC WRITE 1 2 3 4 STEREO PHONES 4 7 1 Connect the AUX SEND 1 jack to the input jack of your external effect processor, and connect the output jacks of the effect processor to the LINE INPUT jacks 5 and 6. Make settings on your effect processor so that only the processed sound is output. 2 Hold down the BUS button, and press REC SELECT buttons 3 and 4. The track record indicators (BUS/L, R) will blink. Make sure that the track record indicators for tracks 1 and 2 are dark. 3 Turn on the MONITOR SELECT STEREO switch. Make sure that the MONITOR SELECT CUE switch is off. —Owner’s Manual 5 PUNCH I/O 0 4 Set the STEREO fader in the 7–8 range. 5 Press the REHE button. 6 Press the SONG SEARCH [ ] button to locate to the beginning of the song, and press the PLAY button to begin rehearsal. 7 While listening to your monitor headphones or monitor speakers, use the input channel 1–4 faders and PAN controls to adjust the mix balance of tracks 1–4. If necessary, use the EQ controls to adjust the tone. When you have finished adjusting the mix balance, watch the track 3 and 4 track level meters as you make fine adjustments to the STEREO fader to set the recording level. (At the ideal level, the –3 segment will light when peaks occur.) Applying effects 49 8 On the input channels to which you wish to apply the effect, rotate the AUX control toward the “1” position. The signals from the input channels will be mixed in monaural according to the position of each AUX control, and will be sent via the AUX SEND 1 jack to the external effect processor. 9 Raise level control 5/6. The effect sound from the external effect processor will be sent via LINE INPUT jacks 5 and 6 and mixed into the ST bus. 0 When you have finished adjusting the mix balance, recording level, and effect amount, press the SONG SEARCH [ ] button to locate to the beginning of the song, and then press the REC button and PLAY button to start ping-pong recording. —Owner’s Manual 50 Advanced recording techniques Applying an effect only to the monitor signal By making skillful use of direct recording and the MONITOR SELECT switches, you can apply effects only to the monitor signal so that tracks are recorded without effects. For example when recording vocals, you can let the vocalist monitor their voice with reverb, but record the vocal on the track without effects. The following will explain the example of monitoring tracks 1–3 while you record a vocal on track 4. 2 IN OUT MIDI 1 THRU 1 GAIN MIC/LINE INPUT INSERT 3 I/O LINE MIC MIC/ LINE 2 GAIN LINE LINE 2TR IN STEREO OUT 2 MONITOR OUT L 0 L 7/8 10 0 10 CH1 P A N L CH4 0 1 2 3 4 L R L R PEAK HOLD DISPLAY EDIT UTILITY BUS R L E V E L 10 HIGH REC SELECT CH2 CH3 CUE MIX TO STEREO R 0 8 PB L E V E L 10 HIGH 0 MIC MIC/ LINE 7 5/6 P A N R 0 10 HIGH 6 FLIP L E V E L L E V E L 5 CUE P A N R 4 LINE PB FLIP CUE P A N LINE INPUT 4 GAIN MIC MIC/ LINE PB FLIP CUE L 3 GAIN MIC MIC/ LINE PB FLIP CUE 5 TRACK DIRECT OUT 2 INSERT I/O 7 3 1 MONITOR SELECT 10 EJECT 2TR IN HIGH 4 MULTITRACK MD RECORDER –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 LOW –15 AUX –15 MID +15 +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 AUX –15 MID +15 +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 AUX +15 PITCH STEREO ADJUST 8 CUE EXIT 6 1 2 PAN 1 2 PAN 1 2 PAN 1 2 L R ENTER MONITOR LEVEL PAN REPEAT L R L R L R MIN MARK SEARCH MAX MARK 10 10 10 10 10 10 9 9 9 9 9 9 8 8 8 8 8 8 7 7 7 7 7 7 6 6 6 6 6 6 5 5 5 5 5 5 4 4 4 4 4 4 3 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 A B LAST REC SEARCH IN AUTO PUNCH I/O REHE OUT SONG SEARCH REC PLAY SET PAUSE STOP DATA CURSOR TOC WRITE 1 2 3 4 STEREO PHONES 1 Connect the AUX SEND 1 jack to the input jack of your external effect processor, and connect the output jacks of the effect processor to the LINE input jacks 5 and 6. Make settings on your effect processor so that it will output only the processed sound. 2 Connect the vocal mic to MIC/LINE INPUT jack 4. 3 Set the FLIP switch of input channels 1–4 to “MIC/LINE ( ).” 4 Press REC SELECT button 4. The track record indicator (DIR 4) will blink, and the vocal will be recorded directly to track 4. Make sure that the other track record indicators are dark. —Owner’s Manual PUNCH I/O 5 Raise the CUE LEVEL controls of input channels 1–4. The recording source of track 4 (vocal without the effect) and the playback of tracks 1–3 can now be monitored via the CUE bus. 6 Rotate the AUX control of input channel 4 toward the “1” position. The vocal signal will be sent to the effect processor connected to the AUX SEND 1 jack. 7 Raise level control 5/6. Only the vocal effect sound will be sent to the ST bus. 8 Turn on the MONITOR SELECT CUE switch and MONITOR SELECT STEREO switch. With these settings, the signal of the CUE bus (the playback of tracks 1–3 and the unprocessed vocal) and the signal of the ST bus (vocal effect sound) can be monitored together. Applying effects 51 From the external effect processor 4 1 GAIN 2 GAIN 3 GAIN 5 4 GAIN 5/6 LINE MIC LINE MIC LINE MIC LINE MIC MIC/ LINE PB MIC/ LINE PB MIC/ LINE PB MIC/ LINE PB FLIP FLIP CUE FLIP CUE L L 0 L 0 L 0 L E V E L 10 HIGH 0 –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 MID +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 LOW +15 1 –15 AUX 2 PAN +15 1 L R –15 AUX 2 PAN +15 1 R –15 AUX 2 PAN L L R 10 10 10 9 9 9 9 8 8 8 8 7 7 7 7 6 6 6 6 5 5 5 5 4 4 4 4 3 3 3 3 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 2 +15 9 9 8 8 7 7 6 6 5 5 4 4 3 3 2 2 1 1 0 0 0 10 R 3 STEREO Track 1 To the external effect processor Track 2 1 2 Track 3 L R Track 4 PAN 10 1 10 10 +15 +15 10 HIGH –15 MID –15 AUX PHONES R L E V E L 10 HIGH ST Bus P A N R L E V E L 10 HIGH P A N R L E V E L CUE Bus CUE P A N R MONITOR OUT L FLIP CUE P A N 6 4 Signal flow when applying an effect only to the monitor signal —Owner’s Manual 52 Advanced recording techniques Punch-in/out This section explains techniques using punch-in/out. Punch-in/out is a function that allows you to re-record just a specific portion of a previously-recorded track. While listening to the playback of a track, you can begin recording (punch-in) at the desired location, play the portion that you wish to re-record, and then stop recording (punch-out), thus re-recording only the portion where a mistake occurred. The MD4S allows you to use a variety of punch-in/out techniques. You can use “manual punch-in/out” by pressing the REC button or REC SELECT buttons or an optional FC5 foot switch. Alternatively, you can use “auto punch-in/out” that will automatically perform the operation at the previously-specified locations. You can also use the rehearsal function to practice the punch-in/out for any of these techniques.                     Wrong notes     Re-record Punch-in              Punch-out Manual punch-in/out Here’s how to use the MD4S’s REC button and REC SELECT buttons (or an optional FC5 foot switch) to perform manual punch-in/out. ■ Punch-in/out using the REC button 1. Connect the audio source to the MD4S. 2. Set the FLIP switches of input channels 1–4 to “MIC/LINE ( ).” 3. Turn on the MONITOR SELECT CUE switch. When performing punch-in/out, you will need to monitor the track playback up to the point where you punch-in, and monitor the recording source after punch-in. For this reason when you use punch-in/out, you must always turn on the MONITOR SELECT CUE switch to monitor the CUE bus. Also, you should turn off the MONITOR SELECT STEREO switch. 4. Locate to a point slightly earlier than where you wish to punch-in. By operating the CURSOR shuttle during playback, you can cue (play forward) or review (play backward) at a variety of speeds. (See “Shuttle playback functions” on page 66.) For other locate methods, refer to “Other functions” on page 84. 5. Press one of the REC SELECT buttons (or the BUS button + one of the REC SELECT buttons) to select the track on which you wish to record. The track record indicator for the selected track will blink. 6. Press the REC button and adjust the recording level. The REC indicator will blink, and the MD4S will be in record-pause mode. —Owner’s Manual Punch-in/out 53 7. When you have finished adjusting the recording level, press the STOP button to temporarily cancel record-pause mode. 8. Press the PLAY button to begin playback. 9. At the location where you wish to punch-in, press the REC button. The REC indicator will light, and from this point recording will begin for the track that was selected by the REC SELECT buttons. At this time, the monitor signal of the track that was selected for recording will change from the track playback to the recording source. Tip: By pressing the REHE button instead of the REC button, you can rehearse the punchin/out. In this case, the monitor signal of the track that was selected for recording will change from the track playback to the recording source, but the recording source will not actually be recorded on the track. This is convenient when you wish to practice the timing at which you punch-in/out, or to check the volume difference between the track playback and the recording source. 10. At the point where you wish to punch-out, press the PLAY button. The REC indicator will go dark, recording will end, and normal playback will resume. The monitor signal of the track selected for recording will return to the track playback. Punch-out point Punch-in point 4 REC 3 SELECT 2 1 Playback PLAY Record REC Playback PLAY STOP TOC WRITE ■ Punch-in/out using REC SELECT 1. Make preparations for manual punch-in/out. Use steps 1–6 of “Punch-in/out using the REC button” on page 52 to prepare for manual punch-in/out. 2. For the recording track that you selected in step 1, press the REC SELECT button once again so that all track record indicators are dark. 3. Press the PLAY button. With the REC indicator still blinking, the track will playback. Recording will not occur at this time because the recording track is not selected. 4. When you arrive at the location where you wish to punch-in, press the REC SELECT button for the track that you wish to record. (Alternatively, you can hold down the BUS button and press the REC SELECT button.) The REC indicator will change to be steadily lit, and recording will begin on the track selected by the REC SELECT buttons. —Owner’s Manual 54 Advanced recording techniques 5. When you arrive at the location where you wish to punch-out, press the REC SELECT button once again. The track record indicator will go dark, recording will end, and playback will resume. Punch-in point REC SELECT Punch-out point 4 3 2 1 Record-pause REC PLAY Playback (record-ready) Record REC SELECT Playback STOP PLAY CH3 3 TOC WRITE L ■ Punch-in/out using a foot switch If you connect a separately sold FC5 foot switch to the PUNCH I/O jack located on the front panel of the MD4S, you can punch-in/out using the foot switch. This method is convenient when the same person is both playing an instrument and operating the MD4S to punch-in/ out. Foot switch Foot switch connections 1. Make preparations for manual punch-in/out. Follow steps 1–6 of “Punch-in/out using the REC button” on page 52 to prepare for manual punch-in/out. 2. Press the foot switch. The REC indicator will continue blinking, and track playback will begin. 3. Press the foot switch at the location where you wish to punch-in. The REC indicator and the track record indicator will change to steadily lit, and recording will begin on the track selected by the REC SELECT button. 4. Press the foot switch at the location where you wish to punch-out. The REC indicator will go dark. Recording will end and normal playback will resume. 5. Press the foot switch once again to enter pause mode. Press the STOP button to stop. Note: The PLAY button is not used when using a foot switch to punch-in/out. Be aware that if you inadvertently press the PLAY button from record-pause mode, recording will begin immediately. —Owner’s Manual Punch-in/out 55 Punch-out point Punch-in point 4 REC 3 SELECT 2 1 Record-pause Playback Record REC Playback Pause STOP TOC WRITE Auto punch-in/out Here we will explain how to use the auto punch-in/out function, which performs the punchin and punch-out operations automatically. This function allows you to repeatedly perform punch-in/out with single-frame accuracy (11.6 ms). ■ Specify the auto punch-in/out points Before you begin auto punch-in/out, you must set the “auto punch-in point” at which punchin will occur, and the “auto punch-out point” at which punch-out will occur. The locations at which recording/rehearsal was last started (last record in point) and ended (last record out point) will be used as the auto punch-in/out points. 1. At the location where you wish to auto punch-in, hold down the SET button and press the LAST REC SEARCH [IN] button. The display will indicate “MARK IN,” and this location will be specified as the auto punch-in point. 2. At the location where you wish to auto punch-out, hold down the SET button and press the LAST REC SEARCH [OUT] button. The display will indicate “MARK OUT,” and this location will be specified as the auto punchout point. Note: It is not possible to perform auto punch-in/out if the auto punch-out point is earlier than the auto punch-in point. Note: When the MD4S is turned off, the auto punch-in/out points you set will be lost. Tip: Auto punch-in/out points can be adjusted in steps of a single frame (11.6 ms). (See “Adjusting the location of a marker or auto punch-in/out point” on page 63 for more information.) ■ Setting the pre-roll/post-roll times “Pre-roll time” is the length of playback that will occur immediately before the punch-in point. “Post-roll time” is the length of playback that will occur immediately after the punchout point. On the MD4S, the pre-roll and post-roll times are each set to 5 seconds, but you can modify this if desired. The location at which the pre-roll starts is called the “pre-roll point,” and the location at which the post-roll ends is called the “post-roll point.” —Owner’s Manual 56 Advanced recording techniques Pre-roll point Punch-in point Post-roll point Punch-out poin Pre-roll time Post-roll time IN OUT 1. Press the UTILITY button. 2. Rotate the DATA dial until the display indicates “PrePostRoll,” and press the ENTER button. 3. With the display showing “Pre Xsec” (X will be a number of 0–9), rotate the DATA dial to set a pre-roll length of 0–9 seconds. 4. After you have made the pre-roll setting, press the ENTER button. 5. Rotate the DATA dial until the display indicates “Post Xsec” (X will be a number of 0–9), and rotate the DATA dial to set a post-roll length of 0–9 seconds. 6. After you have made the post-roll setting, press the ENTER button. 7. Press the UTILITY button once again to return to normal operation. Note: Pre-roll/post-roll time settings are remembered even if the MD4S is turned off. ■ Single-take auto punch-in/out There are two types of auto punch-in/out: “single-take” in which auto punch-in/out is performed only once, and “mult-take” in which punch-in/out can be performed two or more times, after which you can select the best take. Here we will explain the procedure for singletake auto punch-in/out. 1. Connect the audio source to the MD4S, and press the REC SELECT button (or the BUS button + REC SELECT button) to select the track that you wish to record. 2. Set the auto punch-in/out points. See “Specify the auto punch-in/out points” on page 55 for more information. 3. Press the AUTO PUNCH I/O button. The display will indicate “SINGLE TAKE.” 4. Press the ENTER button. The AUTO PUNCH SINGLE indicator in the display will light, indicating that single-take auto punch-in/out has been selected. The display will also indicate “A.Punch Rehe,” and the MD4S will be in auto punch-in/out rehearsal-pause mode. —Owner’s Manual Punch-in/out 57 Rehearsing the auto punch-in/out (single-take) 5. Press the PLAY button, and begin rehearsing the auto punch-in/out. When you press the PLAY button, the MD4S will automatically locate to the pre-roll point, and will start playback. When the auto punch-in point is reached, the IN indicator in the display will disappear, and the monitor signal will switch from the track playback to the recording source. When the auto punch-out point is reached the OUT indicator in the display will go dark, and the monitor signal will revert to the track playback. (In rehearsal mode, recording will not actually take place during this time.) After the auto-punch out point is passed and the post-roll is reached, the MD4S will automatically locate to the pre-roll point, and again enter auto punch-in/out rehearsal-pause mode. Tip: When the display shows “A.Punch Rehe,” you can begin rehearsing the auto punch-in/ out simply by pressing the PLAY button. (It is not necessary to press the REHE button.) Tip: If you press the REPEAT button while rehearsing auto punch-in/out, the auto punchin/out rehearsal will repeat automatically. Actually performing the auto punch-in/out (single-take) 6. When stopped or paused, press the REC button. The REC indicator will blink, the display will indicate “A.Pnch,” and the MD4S will be in auto punch-in/out record-pause mode. 7. Press the PLAY button to begin the actual auto punch-in/out. When you press the PLAY button, the MD4S will automatically locate to the pre-roll point, and begin playback. When you reach the auto punch-in point, the IN indicator of the display will go dark, and the track selected by the REC SELECT buttons will begin recording (punchin). When you reach the auto punch-out point, the OUT indicator of the display will go dark, recording will end, and playback will resume (punch-out). When the post-roll point is reached, auto punch-in/out will automatically be defeated, and the MD4S will locate to the pre-roll point and automatically enter playback-pause mode. 8. Press the PLAY button to hear the recorded result. Note: In the case of single-take auto punch-in/out, auto punch-in/out will automatically be canceled when you perform the actual punch-in/out. If you wish to perform auto punch-in/ out once again, you must repeat the procedure from step 1. Tip: If an optional FC5 foot switch is connected to the PUNCH I/O jack, you can use the foot switch to perform steps 4 and 6. —Owner’s Manual 58 Advanced recording techniques Pre-roll point Post-roll point Punch-out point Punch-in point REC SELECT 4 3 2 1 Playback (rehearsal-ready) Rehearsal Playback Record Playback PLAY AUTO PUNCH I/O ENTER Playback (record-ready) PLAY REC SINGLE TAKE IN OUT OUT ■ Multi-take auto punch-in/out Multi-take auto punch-in/out allows you to perform auto punch-in/out recording two or more times, then to audition all takes (including the original) and select the best take. Multitake auto punch-in/out allows you to record up to 99 takes, as long as blank area remains. 1. Connect an audio source to the MD4S, and press a REC SELECT button (or the BUS button + REC SELECT button) to select the track that you wish to record. 2. Set the auto punch-in/out points. See “Specify the auto punch-in/out points” on page 55 for more information. 3. Press the AUTO PUNCH I/O button. The display will indicate “SINGLE TAKE.” 4. Rotate the DATA dial to make the display read “MULTI TAKE.” 5. Press the ENTER button. The display will indicate “TAKE 1 Load” for a short time. Then the AUTO PUNCH MULTI indicator will light, indicating that multi-take auto punch-in/out has been selected. The display will indicate “TAKE 1 Rehe,” and the MD4S will be in auto punch-in/out rehearsal-pause mode. Rehearsing the auto punch-in/out (multi-take) 6. Press the PLAY button to begin rehearsing the auto punch-in/out. In the same way as in single-take auto punch-in/out, the monitor signal of the track selected for recording will switch from the track playback to the recording source between the auto punch-in/out points. Recording will not actually occur. Tip: While rehearsing the auto punch-in/out, you can press the REPEAT button to automatically repeat the rehearsal. —Owner’s Manual Punch-in/out 59 Actually performing the auto punch-in/out (multi-take) 7. From a stopped or paused condition, press the REC button. The REC indicator will blink, and the display will indicate “TAKE 1.” Auto punch-in/out will be in record-pause mode, ready to record the first take (take 1). 8. Press the PLAY button to begin the actual auto punch-in/out. When you reach the post-roll point, the MD4S will automatically stop, and the display will indicate “NEXT TAKE.” Recording the next take 9. With “NEXT TAKE” shown in the display, press the ENTER button. The display will briefly indicate “TAKE 2 Load.” Then the display will change to “TAKE 2,” and the MD4S will be in record-pause mode for take 2 of the auto punch-in/out. Note: Takes 2 and following will always begin with the actual auto punch-in/out. If you wish to rehearse, you must press the REHE button. 10. Press the PLAY button to begin auto punch-in/out. When you reach the post-roll point, the MD4S will automatically stop, and the display will indicate “NEXT TAKE.” If you wish to record another take, press the ENTER button to enter record-pause mode for the next take. If you wish to listen to the takes that you have recorded, advance to the following procedure with “NEXT TAKE” still displayed. Auditioning each take 11. When you have finished recording auto punch-in/out takes and the display indicates “NEXT TAKE,” rotate the DATA dial to make the display read “MONI TAKE.” 12. Press the ENTER button. The display will indicate “TAKE X:MONI” (X will be the take number). 13. Rotate the DATA dial to select the take that you wish to hear, and press the ENTER button to playback the selected take. When you reach the post-roll point (or press the STOP button), the MD4S will stop, and you will again be able to select a take. If you press the EXIT button when the display reads “TAKE X:MONI,” you will return to the “NEXT TAKE” display. Tip: To audition the original, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read “ORIGIN:MONI.” Selecting the best take 14. When the display reads “TAKE X:MONI,” rotate the DATA dial to select the best take. The “TAKE X” display will blink. 15. Rotate the CURSOR shuttle toward the right to make the “MONI” display blink. —Owner’s Manual 60 Advanced recording techniques 16. Rotate the CURSOR shuttle toward the right to make the display read “TAKE X:FIX.” 17. Press the ENTER button. The display will ask “FIX TAKE X?” If at this time you press the EXIT button, you will again return to the step of selecting a take. 18. Press the ENTER button once again to finalize the take. When you finalize the take, the display will indicate “TAKE X FIX” for a short time. Then you will exit auto punch-in/out and return to normal operation. —Owner’s Manual Quick search functions 61 Quick search functions This section explains the variety of Locate functions that are provided by the MD4S. Methods of adjusting the auto punch-in/out points and ways to set Markers will also be explained here. Searching for songs If the disc contains two or more songs, you can use the SONG SEARCH [ ]/[ ] buttons to locate songs. The SONG SEARCH [ ] button locates the previous song, and the SONG SEARCH [ ] button locates the next song. The MD4S will pause at the beginning of the selected song. If you press the SONG SEARCH [ ] button while stopped during a song, the MD4S will locate to the beginning of the song and then pause. If you press the SONG SEARCH [ ] button while a song is playing, the MD4S will locate to the beginning of the song and then immediately begin playback. Current location Song 1 Song 2 Song 3 Song 4 Note: If you press the SONG SEARCH [ ] button when the last song is selected, the MD4S will search for a blank area. (See page 12 for more information.) Note: The SONG SEARCH buttons cannot be used during recording. Locating to a specified time By using the DATA dial and CURSOR shuttle to input a minute/second/frame location, you can locate to a desired location of the disc. If a tempo map (page 111) has been programmed, you can input and locate to a measure/beat/clock location. 1. Press the STOP or PAUSE button to stop or playback-pause the MD4S. It is not possible to locate to a specified time during playback or recording. 2. Press the DISPLAY button to switch the time counter mode. If you wish to locate to a point within the current song, select ELAPSE TIME (or REMAIN TIME). If you wish to locate to a point within the entire disc, select TOTAL TIME. If a tempo map has been programmed for the current song, you can switch the time counter to the measure/beat/clock display. 3. Use the CURSOR shuttle and the DATA dial to specify the desired locate position. By moving the CURSOR shuttle to various angles left or right you can play forward or backward at a variety of speeds, which provides a convenient way to reach the approximate location you desire. As you rotate the DATA dial to left or right, you will move backward or forward in steps of one frame for each click of the dial, allowing you to specify the desired location more precisely. —Owner’s Manual 62 Advanced recording techniques 4. When you have specified the desired location, press the ENTER button. The MD4S will locate to the specified location, and will enter playback-pause mode. If you press the PLAY button instead of the ENTER button, playback will begin from the specified location. Locating to the Last Record In/Out Point When you record or rehearse, the starting location and ending location will automatically be remembered as the “last record in point” and the “last record out point.” When these points have been set, the IN/OUT indicators in the display will light. If the last record in/out points have been set, you can use the LAST REC SEARCH [IN] button to locate to the “last record in point,” or the LAST REC SEARCH [OUT] button to locate to the “last record out point.” The MD4S will then enter playback-pause mode. When you locate to the last record in or out point, the respective IN/OUT indicator will begin blinking. The LAST REC SEARCH [IN] button provides a convenient way to check the result of the last recording. The last record in/out points are also used as the auto punch-in/out points and to specify the range of various editing functions. These points can be adjusted in steps of a single frame (11.6 ms). (For details refer to page 63.) Note: The last record in/out points will be lost when the MD4S is turned off. Searching for Markers The MD4S lets you place up to ten markers in each song. You can use the MARK SEARCH [ ][ ] button to locate immediately to markers that you inserted. Markers are especially convenient when you need to repeatedly jump to specific points in a song. The location of a marker you insert can be adjusted later in steps of a single frame. Inserting a marker in a song 1. At the location where you wish to insert a marker, press the MARK button. Markers can be inserted when the MD4S is playing back, recording, paused, or stopped. When you press the MARK button, the display will indicate “MARK X” (X will be the marker number that was inserted) for a brief time, indicating that a marker has been inserted at that location. Markers are numbered sequentially, starting from the beginning of the song. If a new marker is inserted between two existing markers, the marker numbers will be exchanged. Insert a marker —Owner’s Manual Start marker Marker 1 Marker 2 Start marker Marker 1 Marker 2 Marker 3 Marker 3 End marker Marker 4 End marker Quick search functions 63 2. Press the TOC WRITE button to update the TOC. Note: If you turn off the power of the MD4S without updating the TOC, the marker settings will be lost. Locating to a marker 3. Use the MARK SEARCH[ ]/[ ] buttons to locate to a marker you inserted. The MARK SEARCH [ ] button will locate to a marker earlier than the current location, and the MARK SEARCH [ ] button will locate to a marker after the current location. The MD4S will then enter playback-pause mode. If no marker has been inserted, the MARK SEARCH [ ] button will locate to the start marker (the beginning of the song), and the MARK SEARCH [ ] button will locate to the end marker (the end of the song). Current location Start marker Marker 1 Marker 2 Marker 3 End marker Tip: The marker indicator in the display shows the marker that corresponds to the current location. When an indicator for a marker you inserted is blinking, the current location is between that marker and the next marker. Current location Start marker Marker indicator S Marker 1 Marker 2 Marker 3 End marker 1 2 3 E Adjusting the location of a marker or auto punch-in/out point Here’s how you can make fine adjustments in steps of a single frame to the location of a marker or an auto punch-in/out point. This procedure can be performed when the MD4S is stopped or when it is in playback-pause mode. 1. Press a MARK SEARCH button or a LAST REC SEARCH button to locate to the marker or auto punch-in/out point whose location you wish to adjust. 2. Press the ADJUST button. If you pressed a MARK SEARCH button in step 1, the display will indicate “MARK X:ADJST” (X will be the number of the marker that you selected), and “MARK X” will be blinking. If you pressed a LAST REC SEARCH button, the display will indicate “IN:ADJST” (auto punch-in point) or “OUT:ADJST” (auto punch-out point). At this time you can rotate the DATA dial to select another marker or auto punch-in/out point. —Owner’s Manual 64 Advanced recording techniques 3. Press the ENTER button. The display will indicate “AdjstLoad...” for a short time. Then the display will change to “ADJST 0 ” and the track will play back for approximately 1.5 seconds before and after the point you selected in step 1. At this time, there will be a volume difference between the first 1.5 seconds and the last 1.5 seconds, so that you can hear exactly where the marker occurs. 4. Press the PLAY button, and while listening to playback 1.5 seconds before and after the marker, rotate the DATA dial to adjust the location of the marker in single-frame units (11.6 ms). When you rotate the DATA dial to move the marker backward or forward, the display will indicate “ADJST XXX ” (XXX is the number of frames that the marker was moved.) 5. As necessary, rotate the CURSOR shuttle to invert the high/low volume change. By rotating the CURSOR shuttle to left or right you can invert the high/low volume change that occurs between the first 1.5 seconds and the last 1.5 seconds. If the display indicates , the first 1.5 seconds will be played at a lower volume. if the display indicates , the last 1.5 seconds will be played at a lower volume. CURSOR shuttle Display Playback volume 1.5 sec. 1.5 sec. Marker or auto punch-in/out point 1.5 sec. 1.5 sec. Marker or auto punch-in/out point Tip: 1.5 seconds before and after the marker will also playback immediately after you rotate the CURSOR shuttle. If you keep inverting the volume difference while you listen, it will be easier to make accurate adjustments to the position. 6. When you have finished making adjustments, press the ENTER button. The new location will be finalized, and the MD4S will locate to that spot. The display will return to the state in which it was before you press the ADJUST button in step 2. 7. Press the ADJUST button once again to return to normal operation. 8. Press the TOC WRITE button to update the TOC. Note: The frames with which we are dealing here are 11.6 ms units. Do not confuse them with MTC frames. If MTC frames are displayed in the time display, the adjusted location may not be reflected by the time counter. —Owner’s Manual Quick search functions 65 Note: This method can be used to make fine adjustments in a range of approximately 10 seconds forward or backward from the selected marker (or auto punch-in/out point). If you wish to make adjustments that would be further than this range, you will need to either repeat steps 2–6, or re-set the point that you wish to adjust. If another marker has already been inserted before or after the marker (or auto punch-in/out point) that you are moving, it is not possible to move these markers past each other. Erasing a marker or auto punch-in/out point Here’s how to erase a marker location or auto punch-in/out point that you have set. This procedure can be performed when the MD4S is either stopped or in playback-pause mode. 1. Press a MARK SEARCH or LAST REC SEARCH button to locate to the marker or the auto punch-in/out point that you wish to erase. 2. Press the ADJUST button. The display will indicate “MARK X:ADJST” or “IN:ADJST” or “OUT:ADJST,” and the word on the left (MARK X/IN/OUT) will blink. At this time, you may rotate the DATA dial to select a different marker or auto punch-in/out point. 3. Rotate the CURSOR shuttle toward the right. The word “ADJST” in the display will blink. 4. Rotate the DATA dial toward the right. The word “ADJST” in the display will change to “CLEAR.” 5. Press the ENTER button. If you are erasing a marker, the display will indicate “CLR MARKX?” (X will be the marker number). By pressing the EXIT button at this point you can cancel the Erase operation. 6. Press the ENTER button once again to erase the marker, or press the EXIT button to cancel the Erase operation. The marker indicator (or IN/OUT indicator) that corresponds to the erased marker (or auto punch-in/out point) will go dark. Depending on the marker that was erased, the marker numbers will change. Erase marker 3 Start marker Mark 1 Mark 2 Start marker Mark 1 Mark 2 Mark 3 Mark 4 End marker Mark 3 End marker 7. Press the ADJUST button or the EXIT button to return to normal operation, and press the TOC WRITE button to update the TOC. —Owner’s Manual 66 Advanced recording techniques Various playback functions This section explains the various playback functions offered by the MD4S. Play forward/backward at various speeds (Cue/Review) During playback, you can operate the CURSOR shuttle to play forward (cue) or backward (review) at various speeds. This is a convenient way to find the desired location within a song. 1. Press the PLAY button to begin playback. 2. Move the CURSOR shuttle to right or left to Cue or Review. The cue/review speed will depend on the angle to which you move the CURSOR shuttle. Cue (play forward) Speed Normal playback Display 1/2X speed 2X speed 4X speed 8X speed 16X speed 32X speed CueHALF Cue x2 Cue x4 Cue x8 Cue x16 Cue x32 1/2X speed 4X speed 8X speed 16X speed 32X speed Rev x2 Rev x4 Rev x8 Rev x16 Rev x32 CURSOR shuttle Review (play backward) Speed Normal playback Display CURSOR shuttle Shuttle playback functions Note: It is not possible to move directly from normal playback to 1/2X speed cue. You must move the CURSOR shuttle toward the right to select 2X cue or faster, and then return the CURSOR shuttle to the 1/2X speed cue position. 3. If you press the ENTER button while using cue/review, the cue/review will be locked (fixed). Cue/review will continue even if you release the CURSOR shuttle. When you press the PLAY button, cue/review will be canceled, and normal playback will resume from that location. If cue/review reaches the beginning or end of the song, it will stop. Note: When 1/2X speed cue is used, the playback pitch will be one octave lower than normal. (This is the same effect as the 1/2X speed playback explained below.) However, the pitch will not change for cue/review at other speeds. —Owner’s Manual Various playback functions 67 Playback at half speed (x1/2 Play) x1/2 Play is a function that drops the pitch of the disc to half the normal pitch during playback. When x1/2 Play is used, the pitch will be one octave lower than normal. (This is the same effect as Cue-Half.) This provides a convenient way to practice rapidly-played phrases that you have recorded from a CD etc. Note: Recording or rehearsal cannot be performed at X1/2 Play. Nor will it be possible to synchronize with a MIDI sequencer using MTC or MIDI Clock while using x1/2 Play. 1. Press the UTILITY button. 2. Rotate the DATA dial until the display indicates “X1/2 Play,” and press the ENTER button. The display will indicate “X1/2 OFF.” The HALF indicator will light. 3. Rotate the DATA dial to make the display indicate “X1/2 ON,” and press the ENTER button. X1/2 Play will be active. 4. To turn off the X1/2 Play function, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read “x1/2 OFF” and press the ENTER button. Playing a song repeatedly (One Song Repeat/All Song Repeat) The One Song Repeat function causes a single song to playback repeatedly. The All Songs Repeat function causes all songs on the disc to playback repeatedly. These functions can be selected when the MD4S is playing, stopped, or paused. Note, however, that the One Song Repeat/All Songs Repeat functions are disabled for MIDI sync operation. In this case, you can use the One Song Repeat function only on the MD4S that has been assigned as the MTC master. 1. Press the REPEAT button to select the desired Repeat function. Each time you press the button, the selection will cycle between One Song Repeat, All Song Repeat, and Repeat function off. The display will indicate the selected Repeat function. REPEAT 1 ..................One Song Repeat is selected. The currently selected song will continue playing. One Song Repeat Song 1 Song 2 Song 3 playback repeatedly REPEAT ALL .............All Song Repeat is selected. All songs on disc will continue playing repeatedly. All Song Repeat Song 1 Song 2 Song 3 playback repeatedly —Owner’s Manual 68 Advanced recording techniques 2. To turn off the Repeat function, press the REPEAT button until the Repeat indicator goes dark. Repeating a specific portion of a song (A-B Repeat) A-B Repeat is a function that causes the portion of a song between a specified point A and point B to playback repeatedly. The A and B points can be in different songs if desired. The A and B points can be set while the MD4S is playing, stopped, or in playback-pause mode. 1. At the beginning of the desired repeat, press the A B button. The Repeat indicator in the display will indicate “REPEAT A,” indicating that the beginning of the repeat (point A) has been specified. 2. At the end of the desired repeat, press the A B button once again. The Repeat indicator in the display will indicate “REPEAT A B,” indicating that the end of the repeat (point B) has been specified. When you specify point B, the MD4S will automatically locate to point A, and will begin playing repeatedly between points A and B. 3. During A-B Repeat, press the REPEAT button to turn off the A-B Repeat function. A-B Repeat will also be canceled if you press the STOP button. Note: When A-B Repeat is turned off, points A and B will be reset. If you wish to temporarily stop A-B Repeat playback, use the PAUSE button. Cue List playback Cue List is a function that lets you playback sections between markers in an order that you specify. You can set up to 26 steps (A–Z), each specifying the marker at which playback will begin and end, and the number of times that each step will repeat. Programming a Cue List 1. Press the UTILITY button. 2. Rotate the DATA dial to make the display indicate “Cue List,” and press the ENTER button. The display will indicate “EDIT List.” 3. Rotate the DATA dial to select either “EDIT List” or “NEW List.” If you wish to create a new cue list, select “NEW List.” If you wish to recall an existing cue list, select “EDIT List.” 4. Press the ENTER button to begin programming the cue list. The display will show the first step (A). The blinking letter is the currently selected parameter. —Owner’s Manual Various playback functions Step 69 Number of repeats STEP NO. Beginning marker Ending marker 5. Use the CURSOR shuttle to select a parameter, and rotate the DATA dial to modify the setting. The range of each parameter is as follows. Step ...........................A–Z (while programming, this is shown as lowercase letters a–z) Beginning/ending markers ......... s, 1–10, e (numerals are marker numbers, ‘s’ and ‘e’ are the start marker and end marker respectively) Number of repeats ......................... 0–99 Tip: If you rotate the CURSOR shuttle to the right when the Number of Repeats parameter is selected, you will advance to the next step. If you rotate the CURSOR shuttle toward the left when the Step parameter is selected, you will return to the previous step. If a cue list has been programmed as shown below, the portion between the start marker and marker 1 will be repeated twice, between marker 2 and marker 3 repeated twice, and between marker 3 and marker 4 repeated four times. Cue List a:s—>1 n= b:2—>3 n= c:3—>4 n= d:2—>3 n= e:3—>4 n= f:5—>7 n= g:s—>1 n= h:s—>1 n= i:s—>1 n= " " " " " 2 2 4 1 4 2 0 0 0 Playing a Cue List 6. After you have finished programming the desired steps, press the ENTER button. The display will ask “List PLAY?” 7. Press the ENTER button once again. The display will indicate the first step (A), and the MD4S will be in Cue List playback-pause mode. (During cue list playback, the steps will be shown as uppercase letters A–Z.) At this time you can rotate the DATA dial to change the step at which cue list playback will begin. 8. Press the PLAY button to begin Cue List playback. When all steps have finished playing back, cue list playback will be canceled, and the MD4S will stop. If you wish to stop cue list playback while it is in progress, press the STOP button. If you press the PAUSE button to temporarily halt cue list playback, you can rotate the DATA dial to select a different step, and then resume cue list playback. —Owner’s Manual 70 Advanced recording techniques Note: In rare circumstances, playback may skip between steps of Cue List playback. Note: Cue List program contents are remembered even when the MD4S is turned off. ■ Creating a new song from a Cue List (Cue List Copy) The playback order that you have programmed in a cue list can be rewritten into a new song. As shown in the following diagram, this can be used to remake a song into a new version whose length and arrangement differ from the original song. Original song Intro Opening A Opening B Bridge Chorus A 1 S 1 2 3 4 Opening B Bridge 2 Chorus B 5 6 7 8 measures of fill 8 Chorus C Ending 9 10 E Cue List a: b: c: d: e: f: g: h: i: s—>1 1—>2 2—>3 6—>7 4—>5 8—>9 3—>4 7—>8 10—>e n=2 n=2 n=1 n=1 n=1 n=1 n=1 n=2 n=2 (start the song by repeating the intro twice) (Opening A played twice) (Opening B) (Bridge 2) (Chorus A) (the eight measures of fill are moved forward) (Bridge 1) (repeat Chorus B twice, and move it back) (repeat the Ending twice and fade out) New song after Cue List Copy Intro Opening A Opening A Opening B Bridge Chorus A 2 Intro a b c d e 8 measures of fill f Bridge Chorus B 1 g Chorus B Ending Ending h i 1. As described in steps 1–5 of “Programming a Cue List” on page 68, program the desired cue list. 2. Press the ENTER button. The display will ask “List PLAY?” 3. Rotate the DATA dial to make the display read “List COPY?” 4. Press the ENTER button to execute the Cue List Copy operation. The display will briefly indicate “CopyTo X” (X is the copy destination song number), and then a new song will be created. By pressing the STOP button while “CopyTo X” is displayed, you can cancel the Cue List Copy operation. When the cue list copy has been completed, the TOC will be updated automatically and the MD4S will stop at the beginning of the new song. —Owner’s Manual Various playback functions 71 Programming the song playback order (Program Play) Program Play is a function that lets you program the playback order of the songs on disc. You can specify up to 36 steps of song numbers for playback. 1. Press the UTILITY button. 2. Rotate the DATA dial to make the display read “Prog Play,” and press the ENTER button. The display will indicate “EDIT Prog.” 3. Rotate the DATA dial to select either “EDIT Prog” or “NEW Prog.” If you wish to create a new program, select “NEW Prog.” If you wish to recall an existing program, select “EDIT Prog.” 4. Press the ENTER button to begin programming. The display will indicate the parameters of each step. The blinking character is the currently selected parameter. Step number Song number Song number that was specified for the previous step 5. Rotate the CURSOR shuttle to select parameters, and rotate the DATA dial to modify the value. The range of each parameter is as follows. Step number ...........S1–S36 (S will be displayed as a lowercase letter during programming) Song number .........*, song number (* indicates that no song number has been specified for this step) Note: For steps 2 and following, the song number specified for the previous step will also be displayed. However this is only for your information, and cannot be modified. Tip: If you rotate the CURSOR shuttle to the right when the Song Number parameter is selected, you will advance to the next step. If you rotate the CURSOR shuttle toward the left when the Step parameter is selected, you will return to the previous step. —Owner’s Manual 72 Advanced recording techniques With the program shown in the following diagram, playback will occur in the order of Song 1 → Song 3 → Song 2 → Song 2. Program Play S 1: S 2: S 3: S 4: S 5: S 6: S 7: S 8: S 9: S10: S11: • • • • 1→ 3→ 2→ 2→ 9→ 5→ 1→ *→ *→ *→ 1 3 2 2 9 5 1 * * * * • • 6. After you have entered all of the desired steps, press the ENTER button. The display will show the first step (S1), and the MD4S will be in Program Play playbackpause mode. (In Program Play, the S for “Step” will be show as an uppercase character.) At this time, you can use the SONG SEARCH buttons to change the step at which Program Play will begin. 7. Press the PLAY button to begin Program Play. When all steps have finished playing back, the MD4S will stop. By pressing the STOP button during Program Play, you can also cancel Program Play and stop. Tip: If you press the PAUSE button during Program Play, the playback will pause temporarily, and you can use the PLAY button to resume Program Play. While paused, you can also use the SONG SEARCH buttons to change the step from which Program Play will resume. Note: Program Play settings are remembered even when the MD4S is turned off. —Owner’s Manual Editing functions 73 Editing functions This sections explains the track and song editing functions that are provided on the MD4S. Copying a portion of a track (Part Copy) Part Copy is a function that copies a portion of a track to a different location within the same track or to the desired location in another track. You can also copy between songs. This function is useful when you wish to re-use a specific phrase in a different place. 1. Specify the Last Record In/Out points to set the Copy Source area. Locate to the beginning of the copy source area. Hold down the SET button and press the LAST REC SEARCH IN button to set the Last Record In point. Then locate to the end of the copy source area. Hold down the SET button and press the LAST REC SEARCH OUT button to set the Last Record Out point. When you set each point, the IN/OUT indicators in the display will light. Tip: Last Record In/Out points (auto punch-in/out points) can be adjusted in single-frame units (1/86 second). See “Adjusting the location of a marker or auto punch-in/out point” on page 63 for more information. 2. Locate to the copy destination, and stop or pause playback. The location at which you stop or pause will be the beginning of the copy destination. Tip: If you use the SONG SEARCH buttons to select a different song, the track in the selected song will be copy destination track. Note: The copy destination area must not extend beyond the end of the song. Also, when copying within the same track, the copy destination area must not overlap the copy source area. 3. Press the EDIT button. 4. Rotate the DATA dial to make the display read “Part Copy,” and press the ENTER button. The display will show the copy source track and the copy destination track. The currently selected parameter will blink. Copy source track number Copy destination track number 5. Use the CURSOR shuttle and the DATA dial to specify the copy source track number and the copy destination track number. If “*” is shown for a track number parameter, the Part Copy operation cannot be executed. 6. After you have set the copy source and copy destination tracks, press the ENTER button. The display will ask “COPY EXE?” If you press the EXIT button at this point, the Part Copy operation will be canceled. —Owner’s Manual 74 Advanced recording techniques 7. Press the ENTER button once again to execute the Part Copy operation. While the Part Copy is being executed, the display will indicate “COPY EXE..” and the track record indicator (DIR) for the copy destination track will light. If you press the STOP button at this time, the copy can be interrupted. When the copy is completed, the MD4S will stop. Note: When you execute the copy operation, the content that had been recorded on the copy destination track will be erased. Copy source track IN OUT Copy Copy destination track Current location where stopped/paused Erasing a section of a track (Part Erase) The Part Erase function erases a section portion of a track. You can select two or more tracks for erasure. The section that was erased will be silent. 1. At the beginning of the section you wish to erase, press the SET button + LAST REC SEARCH [IN] button. At the end of the section, press the SET button + LAST REC SEARCH [OUT] button. The last record in/out points will be set, and the area between them will be selected for erasure. When you set each point, the IN/OUT indicator in the display will light. 2. Press the EDIT button. 3. Rotate the DATA dial to make the display read “Part Erase,” and press the ENTER button. The display will show the track from which data will be erased. The currently selected parameter will blink. Track to erase 4. Rotate the CURSOR shuttle to select tracks, and rotate the DATA dial to specify whether or not data will be erased from each track. Data will be erased from the track numbers shown. (The tracks shown as “*” will not be erased.) For example if the display indicates “1**4T,” the specified area of tracks 1 and 4 will be erased. If all tracks show “*”, the Part Erase operation will not be executed. 5. Press the ENTER button. The display will ask “Erase EXE?” If you wish to cancel the operation at this point, press the EXIT button. —Owner’s Manual Editing functions 75 6. Press the ENTER button to execute the Part Erase operation. While the data is being erased, the display will indicate “Erase EXE..” and the track record indicator (DIR) for the tracks being erased will light. Part Erase requires one minute to erase each minute of selected area. While Part Erase is in progress, tracks not being erased will playback. Note: By pressing the STOP button, you can stop the Part Erase operation mid-way through its progress. However, in this case, the data between the point at which Part Erase was executed until the STOP button was pressed will already have been erased. Before Part Erase IN OUT Part Erase After Part Erase Copying an entire track to another track (Track Copy) Track Copy is a function that copies an entire track to another track. 1. Press the EDIT button, use the CURSOR shuttle to make the display read “Track Copy,” and press the ENTER button. The display will show the parameters that specify the copy source track and copy destination track. The currently selected parameter will blink. Copy source track number Copy destination track number 2. Use the CURSOR shuttle and the DATA dial to specify the copy source track number and copy destination track number. If either track number parameter shows “*” the Track Copy operation cannot be executed. 3. After you have specified the copy source and copy destination tracks, press the ENTER button. The display will ask “COPY EXE?” If you wish to cancel the copy operation, you can press the EXIT button at this time. 4. Press the ENTER button once again to execute the Track Copy operation. While the track copy is being executed, the display will indicate “COPY EXE..” and the track record indicator (DIR) for the copy destination track will light. If you wish to cancel the operation mid-way through the copy, you can press the STOP button at this time. When the track copy has been completed, the MD4S will stop. Note: When you execute the copy operation, any content that had been recorded on the copy destination track will be erased. —Owner’s Manual 76 Advanced recording techniques Erasing an entire track (Track Erase) Track Erase is a function that erases an entire track. You can select one or more tracks to erase. The erased track(s) will contain only silence. 1. Press the EDIT button, and rotate the DATA dial to make the display read “Track Erase.” Then press the ENTER button. The display will show the parameter that specifies the track(s) to be erased. The currently selected parameter will blink. Track to erase 2. Use the CURSOR shuttle and the DATA dial to select the track(s) that will be erased. Tracks whose numbers are shown will be displayed. (Tracks for which “*” is displayed will not be erased.) For example with settings of “12**T,” tracks 1 and 2 will be erased. If all tracks are “*” the Track Erase operation cannot be executed. 3. Press the ENTER button. The display will ask “Erase EXE?” If you wish to cancel the Track Erase operation, you can press the EXIT button at this time. 4. Press the ENTER button once again to execute the Track Erase operation. While Track Erase is being executed, the display will indicate “Erase EXE..” and the track record indicator (DIR) for the track(s) being erased will light. The Track Erase operation takes four minutes for a four-minute song. While the operation is in progress, tracks not being erased will play back. Note: By pressing the STOP button, you can stop the Track Erase operation mid-way through its progress. However, in this case, the data between the point at which Track Erase was executed until the STOP button was pressed will already have been erased. Copying/converting a song (Song Copy) Song Copy is a function that duplicates an entire song, including the title, markers, and tempo map data. It is convenient to use this function to create a backup of the original song before performing ping-pong recording or punch-in/out recording. If desired, the recording mode (4TR/2TR/MONO mode) of the copy destination song can be converted, and you may change the order of the tracks. (For more on the recording modes, refer to page 11.) 1. Use the SONG SEARCH buttons to select the copy source song, and press the ENTER button. 2. Rotate the DATA dial to make the display read “Song Copy,” and press the ENTER button. The display will ask “Copy X?” (X is the copy source song number). At this time you can rotate the DATA dial to select a different song number. —Owner’s Manual Editing functions 77 3. Press the ENTER button once again. The display will indicate the recording mode and track order of the copy source song. Recording mode Tracks to copy REC MODE If you wish to create a complete duplicate of the song without changing the recording mode or track order, proceed to step 7. Changing the record mode 4. Rotate the DATA dial to select the recording mode of the copy destination song. The following recording modes are available for conversion. • 4T (4TR mode) • 2T (2TR mode) • MO (MONO mode) For example if you specify “2T:12” the copy destination song will be as follows. 4T:1234 2T:12 Copy source song 4 Vocal 3 Guitar Copy destination song 2 Bass 2 Bass 1 Drums 1 Drums Changing the order of the tracks 5. Rotate the CURSOR shuttle to the right. The numerals indicating the track order will blink. 6. Use the CURSOR shuttle to select the track whose order you wish to change, and rotate the DATA dial to specify the copy source track number. The currently selected track will blink. Rotate the DATA dial to select the copy source track number (1–4) or “-”. If you select “-,” the corresponding track of the copy destination will be blank (silent). —Owner’s Manual 78 Advanced recording techniques For example if you specified “4T:3421,” the order of copy destination tracks would be as follows. 4T:1234 Copy source song 4T:3421 Copy destination song 4 Vocal 4 Drums 3 Guitar 3 Bass 2 Bass 2 Vocal 1 Drums 1 Guitar Tip: You can specify the same track number more than once. For example if you specify “4T:3422” the contents of copy source track 2 will be copied to tracks 3 and 4. Executing the Song Copy 7. When you have finished making settings, press the ENTER button. The display will indicate “Copy to BX” (X is the number of a blank area). 8. Rotate the DATA dial to specify the copy destination blank area. 9. Press the ENTER button. The display will ask “Copy EXE?” If you decide to cancel the Song Copy, press the EXIT button. 10. Press the ENTER button to execute the Song Copy operation. The display will indicate “CopyTo X” (X is the song number of the copy destination) for a time, and when the copy is completed, the TOC will be updated automatically and the MD4S will select the copy destination song and then stop. Erasing a song (Song Erase) Song erase is a function that erases an entire song. The song that was erased will become a blank area. Use this function when you need to increase disc space in order to record a new song. 1. Press a SONG SEARCH button to select the song you wish to erase. 2. Press the EDIT button, and rotate the DATA dial to make the display read “Song Erase.” Then press the ENTER button. The display will indicate “Song No. X” (X is the number of the song to be erased). At this time you can rotate the DATA dial to select a different song. 3. Press the ENTER button. The display will ask “Erase EXE?” If you decide to cancel the Song Erase operation, you can press the EXIT button now. —Owner’s Manual Editing functions 79 4. Press the ENTER button once again to execute the Song Erase operation. The display will indicate “Erase EXE..”, and the TOC will be updated automatically when the song has been erased. Tip: If there are three consecutive songs as shown in the following diagram, erasing the middle song will create a new blank area that is independent of the other blank area. Now you can either record a new song in the blank area, or extend the length of Song 1. Song 1 Song 2 Song 3 Blank area 1 Song 2 Blank area 1 Erase song 2 Song 1 Blank area 2 Note: When you erase a song, the numbers of all subsequent songs will be updated. Splitting a song into two (Song Divide) Song Divide is a function that splits a song into two parts. The Program Play function (page 71) can be used to rearrange the playback order of the newly-divided parts. 1. Locate to the point at which you wish to divide the song, and stop or pause playback. 2. Press the EDIT button. Then rotate the DATA dial to make the display read “Song Divide,” and press the ENTER button. The display will ask “Divide EXE?” If you decide to cancel the Song Divide operation, press the EXIT button now. 3. Press the ENTER button once again to execute the Song Divide operation. When the song has been divided, the TOC will automatically be updated. If markers had been placed in the original song, markers earlier than the Divide point will remain in the original song, and markers following the Divide point will be renumbered as markers of the new song. —Owner’s Manual 80 Advanced recording techniques Song 1 before division S 1 2 3 4 E 1 2 3 E Divide point Song 1 after division S 1 E Song 2 S Note: When a song is divided, the song numbers of all subsequent songs will be updated. For example if you divide song 1, the first part of the divided song will be Song 1, the remainder will be Song 2, and the previous Song 2 will be renumbered as Song 3. Joining divided songs together (Song Combine) Song Combine is an operation that joins two previously-divided songs to create a single song. Note: Separately-recorded songs cannot be joined. 1. Press the EDIT button, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read “Song Combn,” and press the ENTER button. The display will indicate the numbers of the two songs that are to be joined. Song numbers to join 2. Rotate the DATA dial to select the songs that will be joined. To join songs 3 and 4, select “Cmbn 3+4.” If the display indicates “Cmbn *+*” the Song Combine operation cannot be executed. 3. Press the ENTER button. The display will ask “Cmbn EXE?” If you decide to cancel the Song Combine operation at this point, press the EXIT button. 4. Press the ENTER button once again to execute the Song Combine operation. After the songs have been combined, the TOC will automatically be updated. If markers have been placed in the two songs being joined, the marker locations will remain in the newly-joined song. (Marker numbers will be updated automatically.) However since the point at which the songs were joined will be inserted as a new marker, the total number of markers in the song will be one more than the total number of markers in the two songs. —Owner’s Manual 81 Editing functions Song 1 before combining S 1 E Song 2 before combining S 1 2 3 E 2 3 4 5 E Song 1 after combining S 1 Point at which songs were joined Note: If the total number of markers in the song (including the marker added at the point where the songs were joined) is eleven or more, it will not be possible to recall the eleventh or subsequent markers. However the locations of the eleventh and subsequent markers will still be remembered, and if one or more of the first ten markers is deleted, these later markers will once again become available. For the procedure of deleting a marker, refer to page 65. Note: When you combine a song, the numbers of subsequent songs will be updated automatically. For example if you combine songs 1 and 2 into song 1, the following song number 3 will be renumbered as song number 2. Moving a song (Song Move) Song Move is a function that moves a song to a blank area. This is convenient when you wish to record additional material to extend a previously-recorded song, or to organize the blank area on a disc. 1. Use the SONG SEARCH buttons to select the song that you wish to move. 2. Press the EDIT button, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read “Song Move,” and press the ENTER button. The display will ask “Move X?” (X is the number of the song that will be moved). At this time you can rotate the DATA dial to select a different song. 3. Press the ENTER button. The display will read “Move to BX” (X is the number of the blank area to which the song will be moved). 4. Rotate the DATA dial to select the blank area to which the song will be moved. Note: It will not be possible to select a blank area that is shorter than the song being moved. —Owner’s Manual 82 Advanced recording techniques 5. Press the ENTER button. The display will ask “Move EXE?” If you decide to cancel the Song Move operation, press the EXIT button. 6. Press the ENTER button once again to execute the Song Move operation. The display will indicate “MoveTo BX” (X is the number of the blank area to which the song will be moved) for a time. When the song has been moved, the TOC will automatically be updated. Tip: If you wish to record additional material to extend the length of an existing song, there must be a blank area following that song. If as shown in the following diagram, you have recorded song 1 and then recorded song 2 following it, there will be no blank area following song 1, and therefore it will not be possible to record additional material to extend the length of song 1. In such cases, you can move song 1 to blank area 1 so that additional material can be recorded onto the end of song 1. Tip: Before performing the Song Move operation, it is a good idea to check Disc Information to see the arrangement of songs and blank areas. For details refer to page 86. Move song 1 to blank area 1 Song 1 Song 2 Blank area 1 Blank area 2 Song 2 Song 1 Blank area 2 Song 2 Song 1 Blank area 1 Blank area 1 Now the length of song 1 can be extended When a song is moved, its location on disc will change, but the song numbers will not be exchanged. Exchanging the order of songs (Song Renumber) Song Renumber is an operation that rearranges the numbers of the songs on disc. After you have used the Song Move operation, you can use the Song Renumber if you want the song numbers to match their sequence on disc. Tip: To avoid confusion, we recommend that you assign a name to your songs before using the Song Renumber operation. See “Titling discs and songs” on page 85 for more information. 1. Press the EDIT button, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read “Song Renum,” and press the ENTER button. The display will ask “Renum EXE?” If you decide to cancel the Song Renumber operation, press the EXIT button. —Owner’s Manual Editing functions 83 2. Press the ENTER button to execute the Song Renumber operation. When the songs have been renumbered, the TOC will automatically be updated. Note: Some MD recorders other than the Yamaha MD4S, MD4 or MD8 divide the song data into multiple areas on the disc. Song Renumber cannot be used on such songs. Before Song Renumber Song 1 Song 3 Song 5 Song 4 Song 2 After Song Renumber Song 1 Song 2 Song 3 Song 4 Song 5 —Owner’s Manual 84 Advanced recording techniques Other functions The following pages explain other functions of the MD4S. Adjusting the record/playback pitch (Pitch function) The Pitch function lets you adjust the record/playback pitch. This is useful when you need to record a instrument that cannot be easily tuned (such as an acoustic piano) together with previously-recorded instruments. The Pitch function is available when the MD4S is recording, playing, stopped, or paused. Turning the Pitch function on/off 1. Press the PITCH button. The display will indicate the Pitch setting. With the factory settings, the display will indicate “FIX +00.00%” FIX (fixed) Amount of VARI (variable) pitch change 2. Rotate the CURSOR shuttle to turn the Pitch function on (VARI) or off (FIX). FIX (fixed)................ The display will blink “FIX,” and the FIX pitch indicator will light. The Pitch function will be turned off, and the pitch will be fixed at the normal setting. VARI (variable) ....... The display will blink “+00.00%” and the VARI pitch indicator will light. The Pitch function will be on. Adjusting the pitch 3. With VARI (variable) selected, rotate the DATA dial to adjust the amount of pitch change. The pitch can be adjusted over a range of “–10.10%” to “+10.11%”. Lowering the pitch will slow down the recording/playback speed, and raising the pitch will speed up the rec/playback speed. Note: At a setting of “+00.00%” the result is the same as when FIX is selected. 4. When you have finished setting the Pitch function, press the ENTER button to return to normal operation. Note: The amount of pitch change for VARI (variable) is remembered even if the MD4S is turned off. However, the next time that the power is turned on, this function will automatically be set to FIX. Note: After you use the Pitch function to record, don’t forget to return the setting to FIX (fixed) before the next recording. In particular, you should check the Pitch indicator before you start recording a new song. —Owner’s Manual Other functions 85 Titling discs and songs A title of up to 127 characters can be assigned to each disc and to each song on the disc. This provides a convenient way to distinguish discs and songs. Titling a disc 1. Press the EDIT button, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read “Disc Name,” and press the ENTER button. If no title has been assigned to the disc, the display will blink “No Title.” 2. Use the CURSOR shuttle to move to the location where you wish to input a character, and use the DATA dial to select the character. The input location is shown by a blinking character (or a “■” character). The following characters are available. ( indicates a space) Spaces can be inserted between characters. 3. When you have finished inputting the title, press the EDIT button once again to return to normal operation. 4. Press the TOC WRITE key to update the TOC. Note: When a titled disc is inserted into the MD4S, the title will appear in the display for a time. Titling a song 1. Use the SONG SEARCH buttons to select the song that you wish to title. 2. Press the EDIT button, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read “Song Name,” and press the ENTER button. The display will indicate the number and title of the selected song. If no title has been assigned, the display will blink “No Name.” At this time you can rotate the DATA dial to select a different song number. 3. Rotate the CURSOR shuttle toward the right. Now you will be able to input the song title. 4. Use the CURSOR shuttle to specify the location at which to input a character, and use the DATA dial to select a character. The blinking character (or “■” character) indicates the input location. The available characters are the same as in the table shown above. 5. When you finish making settings, press the EDIT button once again to return to normal operation. —Owner’s Manual 86 Advanced recording techniques 6. Press the TOC WRITE button to update the TOC. Note: When you use the SONG SEARCH buttons to select a song that already has a title, the song title will appear in the display beside the song number. However, only the first seven characters of the song title will be displayed. Erasing a disc (Disc Erase) Disc Erase is a function that erases all the songs on a disc. When you execute the Disc Erase function, the entire disc will be a blank area. Before a MD DATA disc that was used to store computer data can be used with the MD4S, you must first execute the Disc Erase operation on that disc. 1. Press the EDIT button, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read “Disc Erase,” and press the ENTER button. The display will ask “Erase EXE?” If you decide to cancel the Disc Erase operation at this point, press the EXIT button. 2. Press the ENTER button once again. The display will ask “Really?” so that you can confirm the operation. You can cancel the Disc Erase operation by pressing the EXIT button. 3. Press the ENTER button once again, and the Disc Erase operation will be executed. When Disc Erase has been completed, the TOC will be updated automatically. The display will indicate “Blank Disc.” Viewing disc contents The Disc Info function allows you to view how the songs and blank areas on a disc are organized. For example when you wish to record additional material onto the end of a song, you can use this function to check the available blank areas. 1. Press the UTILITY button, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read “Disc Info,” and press the ENTER button. The display will show the order of songs and blank areas. Numbers indicate song numbers, and numbers prefixed by “B” are blank area numbers. Song 1 Blank area 2 Song 3 Song 2 Blank area 1 For example if you have executed the Song Move function so that songs and blank areas are arranged on the disc as shown above, the display will indicate the first two blocks as “1→B2→”. 2. Rotate the DATA dial to view the contents of the entire disc. As you rotate the DATA dial toward the right, the display will indicate “1→B2→”, “→B2→3”, “→3→,” “→2→B1” etc. —Owner’s Manual Other functions 87 3. Press the UTILITY button once again to return to normal operation. Note: Some MD recorders other than the Yamaha MD4S, MD4 or MD8 divide the song data into multiple areas on the disc. When Disk Information for a disc including such songs is viewed on the MD4S, songs that are divided will be indicated by a “#” character. Songs that are indicated by “#” cannot be directly edited by the MD4S. However if you use the Song Copy function (page 76) to copy that song, the copy destination song can be edited by the MD4S. Changing the recording mode The MD4S allows you to choose from three recording modes: 4TR mode, 2TR mode, and MONO mode. When 2TR mode or MONO mode are selected, fewer tracks can be recorded, but the available recording time will be longer. There is no difference in audio quality between the modes. Number of tracks Available recording time (minutes) MD DATA MiniDisc 4TR (4 track recording) 1, 2, 3, 4 37 ❍ — 2TR (2 track recording) 1, 2 74 ❍ ❍ 1 148 ❍ ❍ Recording mode MONO (monaural recording) Note: Set the recording mode before you begin a new recording. It is not possible to change the recording mode of an already-recorded song. You may change the recording mode for each song. 1. Press the SONG SEARCH [ ] button to select a blank area. The display will indicate “BLANK X” (X is the blank area number). 2. Press the UTILITY button, rotate the CURSOR shuttle to make the display read “REC MODE,” and press the ENTER button. The display will indicate the current recording mode. 3. While watching the display, use the DATA dial to select the desired recording mode. 4TR MODE ...............(4 track recording) 2TR MODE ...............(2 track recording) MONO MODE ........(monaural recording) Note: If you select 2TR mode, recording will be possible only on tracks 1 and 2. If you select MONO mode, recording will be possible only on track 1. 4. Press the ENTER button to finalize the recording mode. 5. Press the UTILITY button once again to return to normal operation. Note: 8TR mode songs that were recorded on the Yamaha MD8 cannot be edited on the MD4S. However, songs that were converted by the MD8 into 4TR/2TR/MONO modes can be played back by the MD4S. —Owner’s Manual 88 Advanced recording techniques Note: The recording mode setting is not reset when the power is turned off. If a recordable MiniDisc is inserted into the MD4S, it will automatically switch to 2TR mode, meaning that if you later insert an MD DATA disc and wish to perform 4 track recording, you will need to reset the recording mode to 4TR. Adjusting the display brightness The brightness of the display can be adjusted over five steps. 1. Press the UTILITY button, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read “Disp Dimmer,” and press the ENTER button. The display will indicate “Dimmer X” (X will be a number between 1–5). 2. Rotate the DATA dial to adjust the brightness. The range of this parameter is 1–5, and higher settings will increase the brightness. The factory setting is 5. 3. Press the ENTER button to finalize the display brightness setting. 4. Press the UTILITY button or the EXIT button to return to normal operation. Tip: This setting is remembered when the MD4S power is turned off. Selecting the type of Frame display The frame display of the display counter can be switched to either 86 frames/second (MiniDisc/MD DATA audio frames) or 30 frames/second (MTC frames). 1. Press the UTILITY button, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read “Frame Disp,” and press the ENTER button. The display will indicate “XX Frame” (XX will be either 86 or 30). 2. Rotate the DATA dial to select either “86” or “30.” If “86” is selected, the “FRAMES” indicator will light in the Frame area of the time counter. If “30” is selected, the “MTC FRAMES” indicator will light. 3. Press the ENTER button to finalize the frame display setting. 4. Press the UTILITY button or the EXIT button to return to normal operation. Tip: This setting is remembered when the MD4S power is turned off. —Owner’s Manual Other functions 89 Using a Foot switch If an optional FC5 foot switch is connected to the PUNCH I/O jack, you can use the foot switch to perform not only punch-in/out but a variety of other transport operations. When the foot switch is pressed, the MD4S will perform the following operations. ● On z Flashing Mode Before Mode After → Indicators REHE REC PLAY Stop — — — Play — — Play Pause — Cue/Review Indicators REHE REC PLAY Play — — ● ● Play Pause1 — — z — z Play — — ● — — ● Play — — ● Record Pause — z — Play Record Wait — z ● Rehearse Pause z — — Play Rehearse Wait z — ● Play Record Wait — z ● Record2 — ● ● Play Rehearse Wait z — ● Rehearse ● — ● Record — ● ● Play — — ● Rehearse ● — ● Play — — ● New Record Pause — z — New Record — ● ● New Record — ● ● Stop3 — — — Auto Punch Record Standby — z — Auto Punch Record Wait4 — z ● Auto Punch Rehearse Standby z — — Auto Punch Rehearse Wait4 z — ● 1. 2. 3. 4. → → → → → [PAUSE] button operation. Effective only when a [REC SELECT] button is pressed. [STOP] button operation. After locating the Pre-Roll point, the Auto Punch In/Out sequence starts. Note: For the optional Yamaha FC5 Footswitch, operation is initiated when the footswitch is pressed, not when it’s released. This may differ, however, with other footswitches. —Owner’s Manual 90 Advanced recording techniques MIDI functions The MD4S is an ideal device for recording vocals, guitar, or other acoustic instruments, but by using its MIDI functionality you can synchronize it with a MIDI sequencer or with another MD4S, or control the transport of the MD4S from an external MIDI device. This section explains how to use the MIDI functionality of the MD4S. Synchronizing the MD4S with a MIDI sequencer The MD4S allows you to select either “MTC” or “MIDI Clock” synchronization data for output from its MIDI OUT connector. This synchronization data can be transmitted to a MIDI sequencer to make the MIDI sequencer follow and synchronize to the MD4S. In this type of synchronized MIDI system, the MD4S will be the master and the MIDI sequencer will be the slave. ■ Connecting the MD4S with a MIDI system The MD4S can be connected to a synchronized MIDI sequencer system in a wide variety of ways, but the most common setup is for acoustic sounds to be recorded on the MD4S, and other parts to be played by the sequencer on a MIDI tone generator. In such a system, you would monitor the sounds of the MIDI tone generator as you recorded vocals and guitar to the MD4S. Then during mixdown, you would mix the playback of the MD4S with the sound from the MIDI tone generator (See page 42). MIDI keyboard MIDI IN 2 MIDI OUT MIDI OUT 2 L MIDI IN R MIDI OUT 1 MIDI tone generator L IN OUT MIDI 1 TRACK DIRECT OUT THRU 2TR IN STEREO OUT 1 MONITOR OUT MIDI OUT 2 AUX SEND 2 MIC/LINE INPUT INSERT 3 I/O INSERT I/O 1 GAIN MIDI IN R LINE MIC/ LINE 2 GAIN MIC LINE MIC/ LINE PB FLIP LINE L 0 L 0 0 0 10 PB CH1 P A N L L E V E L 10 HIGH REC SELECT CH2 CH3 CH4 0 1 2 3 4 L R L R PEAK HOLD DISPLAY EDIT UTILITY BUS R L E V E L 10 HIGH 7/8 10 CUE MIX TO STEREO R L E V E L 10 8 FLIP P A N R L E V E L 7 0 CUE P A N R 6 5/6 MIC MIC/ LINE PB CUE P A N HIGH LINE FLIP CUE 5 4 GAIN MIC MIC/ LINE PB FLIP CUE L 3 GAIN MIC LINE INPUT 4 MONITOR SELECT 10 EJECT 2TR IN HIGH MULTITRACK MD RECORDER –15 MID +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 MID +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 MID +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 AUX +15 –15 MID +15 –15 LOW +15 –15 AUX +15 PITCH STEREO ADJUST CUE EXIT 1 2 PAN 1 2 PAN 1 2 PAN 1 2 L R ENTER MONITOR LEVEL PAN REPEAT L R L R L R MIN MARK SEARCH MAX MARK 10 10 10 10 10 10 9 9 9 9 9 9 8 8 8 8 8 8 7 7 7 7 7 7 6 6 6 6 6 6 5 5 5 5 5 5 4 4 4 4 4 4 3 3 3 3 3 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 A B LAST REC SEARCH IN AUTO PUNCH I/O REHE OUT SONG SEARCH REC PLAY SET PAUSE STOP DATA CURSOR TOC WRITE 1 2 3 4 STEREO PHONES —Owner’s Manual MIDI IN 1 or MTC IN PUNCH I/O MTC/MIDI Clock MIDI functions 91 Note: When inputting MIDI Time Code sent from the MD4S to the MIDI sequencer, it is best to use a dedicated MTC input connector or a separate MIDI IN connector. The reason for this is that if MIDI musical (playback) data is sent together with MTC to the same MIDI IN connector of the sequencer, synchronization may be disrupted. Tip: If your MIDI sequencer supports MMC (MIDI Machine Control), you can make the MD4S receive MMC data so that the principle transport functions of the MD4S can be controlled by the MIDI sequencer. Even in this case, the MD4S will still be the synchronization master of the MIDI system, but you will have the convenience of being able to control MD4S operations such as Record (including punch-in/out), Playback, and Locate to specified measures from the MIDI sequencer. For details on setting the MD4S to receive MMC, refer to “Controlling the MD4S by MMC” on page 98. About MTC and MIDI Clock MTC and MIDI Clock are different types of MIDI messages used for synchronization between MIDI devices. MTC transmits absolute time information in units of a “frame” (1/30 of a second). If you start a MD4S song at the “5 minutes 10 seconds” location, the MIDI sequencer will also play in synchronization from the “5 minutes 10 seconds” location. Since the MIDI sequencer simply plays according to the time data that it receives, synchronization will not be affected if the tempo of the sequence data changes. Nearly all high-end computer-based sequencers support MTC. MIDI Clock transmits Clock messages according to the tempo. In other words, the MIDI sequencer will synchronize to the Tempo data (tempo map) that was created on the MD4S. When you create a tempo map on the MD4S, the time display will indicate measures/beats/ clocks just as on a MIDI sequencer. In this case if you start the MD4S song from “measure 10,” the MIDI sequencer will synchronize and start playing from “measure 10.” If you need to synchronize the MD4S to a MIDI sequencer or MIDI rhythm machine that does not support MTC, you should use MIDI Clock synchronization. Note: If you are using MIDI Clock and the slave device does not support the MIDI Song Position Pointer message, it will not be possible to synchronize from the middle of the song. In this case, you must always start synchronizing from the beginning of the song. Synchronization using MTC ■ Transmit MTC from the MIDI OUT connector of the MD4S Make MIDI Sync settings so that the MIDI OUT connector of the MD4S will transmit MTC messages. 1. Press the UTILITY button, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read “MIDI Sync,” and press the ENTER button. The display will indicate the currently selected MIDI Sync setting. If MIDI Sync is off, the display will indicate “Sync OFF.” 2. Rotate the DATA dial to make the display read “MTC MASTER.” The MIDI indicator in the display will light to indicate “MTC SYNC MASTER.” With this setting, MTC messages will be transmitted from the MIDI OUT connector when the MD4S is running. 3. Press the UTILITY button once again to return to normal operation. —Owner’s Manual 92 Advanced recording techniques ■ MIDI sequencer settings To use MTC, your MIDI sequencer must be set to synchronize to the MTC messages it receives. In this case, you must set the frame rate to 30 frames/second. For details on making this setting, refer to the owner’s manual of your MIDI sequencer. Synchronization using MIDI Clock ■ Transmit MIDI Clock from the MIDI OUT connector of the MD4S Make MIDI Sync settings so that the MIDI OUT connector of the MD4S will transmit MIDI Clock messages. 1. Press the UTILITY button, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read “MIDI Sync,” and press the ENTER button. The display will indicate the currently selected MIDI Sync setting. If MIDI Sync is off, the display will indicate “Sync OFF.” 2. Rotate the DATA dial to make the display read “MIDI CLOCK.” The MIDI indicator in the display will light to indicate “MIDI CLOCK.” 3. Press the UTILITY button once again to return to normal operation. ■ Programming a tempo map Tempo and meter (time signature) data can be programmed into a MD4S song. For each song, you can program 26 steps (A–Z) each of tempo data and meter data, allowing you to change tempo and meter during the song. Before you start programming a tempo map, it will be convenient to use the “Tempo Map Chart” on page 111 to make a note of the measures at which the tempo or meter changes. 1. Press the ENTER button, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read “Song Tempo,” and press the ENTER button. The display will indicate “Meter Setup” or “Tempo Setup.” 2. Rotate the DATA dial to select “Meter” if you wish to program time signature data or “Tempo” if you wish to program tempo data. Then press the ENTER button. The display will indicate “Edit Meter” or “Edit Tempo.” 3. Rotate the DATA dial to make the display read “Edit” if you are editing an existing tempo map or “New” if you are programming a new tempo map. Then press the ENTER button. The display will indicate step A at the first measure. The character “A” that indicates the step will be blinking. —Owner’s Manual MIDI functions When setting Meter (time signature) data Step Measure 93 Meter STEP NO. When setting Tempo data Step Measure/beat Tempo STEP NO. 4. Rotate the CURSOR shuttle to the right to select the meter/tempo parameter, and rotate the DATA dial to set the meter or tempo. It is not possible to set the measure location of step A. The range of settings is as follows. Meter ........................1–99/2, 4, 8, 16 Tempo ......................  =20–300 5. Press the ENTER button. The character (A) that indicates the step will blink. 6. Rotate the DATA dial to the right to select the next step (B). 7. Use the CURSOR shuttle to select the measure at which the tempo map will be inserted and the meter/tempo parameters, and rotate the DATA dial to set the value. For steps other than step A, setting the measure location to “000” will erase the tempo map that had been specified for that step. • To specify a 3/4 time signature from measure 5, set “B 005 3/4”. • To specify a tempo of “ =90” from measure 10 beat 3, set “B010-3  090”. • To erase the current step “B012-3 110”, set “B000-0 110”. 8. Press the ENTER button. The step B meter data has now been inserted (or deleted, if you specified “000” as the measure location). 9. Repeat steps 6–8 to continue programming the tempo map. 10. Press the EDIT button once again to return to normal operation. 11. Press the TOC WRITE button to update the TOC. If you edited an existing tempo map, it is not necessary to update the TOC. Note: The tempo map is saved independently for each song. When you select a song, the tempo map that has been programmed for that song will be loaded automatically. However, please be aware that the number of tempo maps that can be stored on a disc is limited, and will depend on the number of steps that have been programmed. If a display of “Save Warn!” appears when you update a tempo map, the disc area provided for tempo maps has been used up. Note: A tempo map can be saved only on an MD DATA disc. It cannot be saved on a MiniDisc. —Owner’s Manual 94 Advanced recording techniques Tip: If the measure location of a new step is set earlier than the measure location of an existing step, the subsequent steps will automatically be reordered. Similarly if you set the measure location of an existing step to 000 to delete it, the subsequent steps will automatically be reordered. C 008 3/4 Insert Song A 001 4/4 B 016 5/4 Song A 001 4/4 B 008 3/4 C 016 5/4 Song A 001 4/4 B 008 3/4 C 016 5/4 Delete ( B 008 3/4 ) Song A 001 4/4 B 016 5/4 ■ MIDI sequencer settings When using MIDI Clock, you will need to make settings on your MIDI sequencer so that it will synchronize to MIDI Clock messages. For details on making this setting, please refer to the owner’s manual of your MIDI sequencer. Synchronizing two MD4S recorders The MD4S is able to synchronize to MTC received from an external device. For example if you have two MD4S recorders, and set one MD4S to transmit MTC messages and the other MD4S to receive these MTC messages, the two units will act as a single 8-track multi-track recorder. In this case, the MD4S that transmits the MTC will be the MTC Master and the MD4S that receives the MTC will be the MTC Slave. When the MTC Master MD4S runs, the MTC Slave MD4S will follow the MTC Master and run in synchronization. In this setup, you can connect the STEREO OUT jacks of the MTC Slave MD4S to LINE INPUT jacks 5 and 6 of the MTC Master MD4S so that the signals of the ST bus of both units can be combined by the MTC Master MD4S. —Owner’s Manual 95 MIDI functions Connect the two MD4S recorders as follows. MTC MIDI OUT IN OUT MIDI 1 2TR IN 1 MONITOR OUT 2 AUX SEND IN 1 2 GAIN 3 GAIN 5 4 GAIN LINE MIC LINE MIC LINE MIC PB MIC/ LINE PB MIC/ LINE PB MIC/ LINE PB FLIP FLIP CUE R L R 0 R P A N L L E V E L MTC SYNC MASTER REC SELECT CH2 CH3 L E V E L MIC/LINE INPUT INSERT 3 I/O 1 2 3 4 R L R 2 GAIN 3 GAIN 5 1 MONITOR OUT MIC LINE MIC LINE MIC MIC/ LINE PB MIC/ LINE PB MIC/ LINE PB FLIP FLIP CUE 2 AUX SEND L R R 0 10 R MTC SYNC CUE MIX TO STEREO P A N L 7/8 10 CH1 CUE P A N L 0 8 FLIP CUE P A N 7 5/6 LINE PB FLIP 6 4 GAIN MIC MIC/ LINE CUE L STEREO OUT LINE INPUT 4 LINE CH4 BUS R 1 GAIN 10 CUE MIX TO STEREO P A N L L E V E L 7/8 10 CH1 CUE P A N L E V E L 0 2TR IN 2 INSERT I/O 8 FLIP CUE P A N 7 5/6 MIC FLIP 6 STEREO OUT TRACK DIRECT OUT THRU LINE INPUT 4 MIC/ LINE CUE OUT MIDI 1 MIC/LINE INPUT INSERT 3 I/O LINE L STEREO OUT 2 INSERT I/O GAIN MIDI IN TRACK DIRECT OUT THRU P A N L 1 BUS R SLAVE L L E V E L L E V E L L E V E L L E V E L MTC master REC SELECT CH2 CH3 CH4 2 3 4 R L R MTC slave Tip: The MTC Master device can be a Yamaha MD8 or MD4 as well as another MD4S. ■ Settings for the MTC Slave MD4S 1. Press the UTILITY button, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read “MIDI Sync,” and press the ENTER button. The display will indicate the current MIDI Sync setting. 2. Rotate the DATA dial to make the display read “MTC SLAVE.” Set the master MD4S to indicate “MTC SLAVE.” 3. Press the UTILITY button once again to return to normal operation. Note: On the MD4S that is being used as the slave, the following buttons and functions cannot be used. • • • • MARK SEARCH buttons • LAST REC SEARCH buttons ADJUST button • PAUSE button Shuttle playback • Repeat playback Punch-in/out using a foot switch • MMC reception • • • • PITCH button Locate to a specified time Auto punch-in/out x1/2 playback ■ Synchronized recording on a slave MD4S If you first put the MTC slave MD4S into Record-Pause mode, then you will be able to perform Record-Start and Pause operations from the MTC master MD4S. 1. On the slave MD4S, press a REC SELECT button or the BUS button + REC SELECT button to select the track(s) for recording. 2. Press the REC button of the slave MD4S. The slave MD4S will enter record-pause mode. If you press the REHE button instead of the REC button, it will enter rehearsal-pause mode. Note: When the slave MD4S is in record-pause or rehearsal-pause mode, its EDIT, UTILITY, and SONG SEARCH buttons cannot be used. —Owner’s Manual 96 Advanced recording techniques 3. Start the master MD4S (playback/record/rehearsal). The slave MD4S will receive the MTC messages, and will record/rehearse in synchronization with the location of the master. 4. When you press the STOP button on the master MD4S, the slave MD4S will also stop. Tip: It is also possible to manually punch-in/out on the slave MD4S. In this case, press the PLAY button instead of the REC button in step 2, and then start the MTC master MD4S. When you reach the desired punch-in point, press the REC button of the slave unit. When you reach the punch-out point, press the PLAY button of the slave unit. Note: The MTC slave MD4S will require a certain length of time after receiving MTC before it reaches a stable state of synchronization. If you will be recording on the MTC slave MD4S, start the master unit running (play/record/rehearsal) at least 10 seconds ahead of the location where you wish to begin recording. Note: If the Pitch function of the MTC master MD4S is turned on, the MTC slave MD4S may be unable to synchronize accurately. As far as possible, please turn off the Pitch function of the MTC master. Note: When you first record a new song on the MTC slave MD4S, you must begin synchronized operation from the beginning of the song (the “000:00:00” location) on the MTC master MD4S. Note: The MTC slave MD4S is able to receive an MTC frame rate of 30 frames/second. If you are using a device other than an MD4S as the MTC master, you must set the frame rate to 30 frames/second. Note: If you are synchronizing to an MTC master other than another MD4S (i.e., a MIDI sequencer etc.), you must use a dedicated MTC output connector on the MTC master, or output the MTC from a separate MIDI output connector. If MIDI playback data is merged with MTC data, the MTC slave MD4S may be unable to synchronize accurately. ■ Synchronized playback of a slave MD4S If you first set the MTC slave MD4S to playback-pause mode, playback-start and pause operations can be performed from the MTC master MD4S. 1. Press the PLAY button on the slave MD4S. The slave MD4S will enter playback-pause mode. 2. Start the master MD4S running (play/record/rehearsal). The slave MD4S will receive MTC, and will begin playing in synchronization with the master MD4S. 3. Press the STOP button on the master MD4S, and the slave MD4S will return to playback-pause mode. At this time if you start the master MD4S running, the slave MD4S will chase to the location of the master and will resume synchronized playback. —Owner’s Manual MIDI functions 97 Synchronizing to MTC with a specified offset (time difference) When using the MD4S as an MTC slave, you can assign an offset (time difference) that will be applied to the MTC time data received from the external device. Note: The offset setting affects only the MTC slave MD4S. Even if you specify an offset for the MTC master MD4S, it will not affect the MTC that is transmitted from the MTC master. 1. If the MTC slave MD4S is in record/playback/rehearsal-pause mode, press the STOP button to defeat pause mode. 2. On the slave unit, press the UTILITY button, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read “MTC Offset,” and press the ENTER button. The display will indicate the current offset value as hours/minutes/seconds/frames. With the factory settings, this will read “00:00:00.00.” Hours Minutes Seconds Frames 3. Use the CURSOR shuttle to select the hours/minutes/seconds/frames parameters, and rotate the DATA dial to specify the value. You can specify an offset in the range of “00:00:00.00” to “23:59:59.29.” For example if you specify an offset value of “00:01:00.00,” an MTC master location of “00:01:00.00” will be considered by the MTC slave MD4S as a location of “00:00:00.00” (the display will indicate “000:00.00”) for synchronization purposes. If you specify an offset value of “23:59:00.00,” an MTC master location of “23:59:00.00” will be considered by the MTC slave MD4S as a location of “00:00:00.00” (the display will indicate “000:00.00”), and an MTC master location of “00:00:00.00” will be considered by the slave as “00:01:00.00” (the display will indicate “001:00.00”). With an offset setting of “ 00:01:00.00 ” 00:01:00.00 (MTC) MTC master MTC slave 00:00:00.00 (MD4S display) With an offset setting of “ 23:59:00.00 ” 23:59:00.00 (MTC) 00:00:00.00 (MTC) MTC master MTC slave 000:00.00 (MD4S display) 001:00.00 (MD4S display) 4. Press the UTILITY button to return to normal operation. —Owner’s Manual 98 Advanced recording techniques Controlling the MD4S by MMC MMC (MIDI Machine Control) is a type of MIDI message that allows the transport of an audio/video recorder etc. to be controlled by an external MIDI device. Since the MD4S is able to receive MMC, an MMC-compatible MIDI sequencer or other device can control the transport of the MD4S. In this case, the device that transmits MMC data will be the MMC Master, and the device that receives MMC data will be the MMC Slave. The MD4S supports the following MMC messages. Function MMC# MD4S operation Stop Command 01 If this command is received during recording, rehearsal, or playback etc., that operation will be halted. Playback Command 02, 03 When this command is received, playback will begin. If this command is received during recording or rehearsal, that operation will be halted. Fast-forward Command 04 Skip to the next song. If this command is received during recording or rehearsal, that operation will be halted. Rewind Command 05 Skip to the previous song. If this command is received during recording or rehearsal, that operation will be halted. Record Strobe Command 06 If this command is received when stopped, recording will begin. If this command is received during playback, punch-in will be performed. If received while paused, this command will be ignored. End Record Command 07 Record mode will be turned off. Paus Command 09 Enter pause mode. If received during record or rehearsal, stop. MMC Reset Command 0D Reset MMC data to the initial settings (the condition at power-on). Write Command 40 Write data to the specified data field. Locate Command 44 Locate to the specified time code location. Record Mode Data field 4C Switch between REHE and REC. Track Record Ready Data field 4F Select the track to be recorded by “Record Strobe.” ■ Switching MMC reception on/off You can specify whether or not the MD4S will receive MMC. 1. Press the UTILITY button, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read “MMC Receive,” and press the ENTER button. The display will indicate the current MMC reception setting. With the factory settings this is off, and the display will indicate “MMC Rx OFF.” 2. Rotate the DATA dial to switch the setting “ON” or “OFF.” When this is “ON,” MMC can be received. 3. Press the ENTER button to confirm the setting. —Owner’s Manual MIDI functions 99 4. Press the UTILITY button or the EXIT button to return to normal operation. If MMC reception was turned on, the MD4S will be the MMC Slave, and can be operated by MMC messages received from the external device. Tip: This setting is remembered even if the power is turned off. ■ Setting the MMC Device ID If there is more than one MMC slave, a single command will control all MMC slaves since MMC commands are common to all devices. However in some cases (such as when specifying the tracks for recording), you may wish to control only a specific MMC slave device. In such cases, you can set the MMC Device ID so that the MMC master will control only a specific MMC slave device. 1. Press the UTILITY button, rotate the DATA dial to make the display read “MMC Dev ID,” and press the ENTER button. The display will indicate the currently selected Device ID. With the factory settings, the Device ID is set to 1, and the display will indicate “DEV ID 1.” 2. Rotate the DATA dial to select the Device ID (1–127). 3. Press the ENTER button to confirm the selection. 4. Press the UTILITY button or the EXIT button to return to normal operation. Note: Set the MMC Master device so that it will transmit MMC to the ID you specified here. Tip: This setting is remembered even if the MD4S is turned off. —Owner’s Manual 100 Appendix Appendix Q&A Section This section is intended to answer your questions about the MD4S and MD DATA discs. What’s the difference between MiniDiscs and MD DATA Discs? MiniDiscs were designed to store mono and stereo sound data. MD DATA discs were originally designed to store computer data. Ideal for use with digital cameras. However, they can also be used to store mono, stereo, and four-channel sound data. That’s how MD4S uses them. Can the MD4S use normal MiniDiscs? Yes, but only for 2-track or mono recording and playback. MiniDiscs recorded on the MD4S can be played on normal MiniDisc decks. Are Yamaha MD8 and MD4 discs compatible with the MD4S? All discs recorded on the Yamaha MD4 can be used by the MD4S. Discs recorded on the Yamaha MD8 can be used by the MD4S if they are converted by the MD8 to 4TR mode. What happens if I insert an MD DATA Disc into a MiniDisc deck? The disc will not be recognized. MiniDisc decks cannot use MD DATA discs. How long is the life of an MD DATA disc? So long as the disc is not damaged physically, it has an infinite life span. Even after one million record and playback operations there is no signal degradation. Do I need to format an MD DATA Disc before recording with the MD4S? Yes and no. The MD4S uses MD DATA discs straight out of the wrapper. No fuss. An MD DATA disc that has been used to store computer data, however, must be erased before use with MD4S. What is the available recording time? This depends on the Recording mode: 37 minutes for four-track (4TR), 74 minutes for stereo (2TR), and 148 minutes for mono (MONO). What is the frame counter? A frame is an integral part of the MD DATA disc format. One frame can hold 11.6 ms of data (i.e., 512 samples of ATRAC sound data at 44.1 kHz). There are approximately 86 frames to a second. Using the FrameDisp function you can select between 86 (MD) and 30 (MTC) frames per second. Is the sound quality affected by repeated ping-pong operations? No—thanks to digital recording technology. Note, however, that the MD4S mixer is analog, so after many ping-pong operations slight signal degradation may occur, although this is still insignificant when compared to tape-based analog recorders. —Owner’s Manual Troubleshooting 101 Do I have to sacrifice one track to record timecode? No. The MD4S generates MTC (MIDI Timecode) or MIDI Clock from the disc’s internal sync signals. So even in a synchronized MIDI system, all eight tracks are available for sound recording. How many songs can I store on an MD DATA disc? Up to 254. Do I have to clean the MD4S heads? No. Troubleshooting If you’re having difficulty operating the MD4S or if it doesn’t seem to work as expected, look up the symptoms in the following table and follow the advice provided. Symptom Advice Make sure the power cord is connected to a suitable AC wall outlet and plugged into the AC IN connector at the rear of the MD4S. Make sure that the MD4S POWER switch is set to the ON position. If you still cannot turn on your MD4S, contact your Yamaha dealer. Make sure that the MONITOR LEVEL control is raised, and that the FLIP switches and MONITOR SELECT switches are set appropriately. If the FLIP switch is in the “MIC/LINE ( )” position, raise the fader Cannot listen to a connected of the corresponding input channel and the STEREO fader, and turn music source! on the MONITOR SELECT STEREO switch. If the FLIP switch is in the “PB ( )” position, raise the CUE LEVEL control of the corresponding input channel and the STEREO fader, and turn on the MONITOR SELECT CUE switch. Are you using a MiniDisc? Please use MD DATA discs. Cannot record four tracks! Make sure that the 4TR recording mode is selected. Make sure the disc’s write protect tab is set to unprotect. Make sure that the x1/2 Play function is not on. Press a REC SELECT button, or the BUS button + REC SELECT button, and make sure that the track is ready to record. Cannot record! Make sure that the signal that you wish to record has been selected as the recording source for the appropriate track. Use the CUE LEVEL control to check whether the signal is actually being sent to the track. You cannot rehearse the first recording on a blank disc or blank area. Cannot rehearse! Record something first, then use the Rehearse function. Press a REC SELECT button, or the BUS button + REC SELECT button, The level meters do not indi- and make sure that the desired track is ready to record. Next, press cate signal levels! the REC button or the REHE button, and make sure that the MD4S is in record-pause or rehearsal-pause mode. Make sure that the track you wish to record has been selected. Make sure that the auto punch-in/out points have been specified. If Cannot use the Auto Punch they have been specified, the IN and OUT point indicators will be lit. In/Out function! Make sure that the auto punch-out point has not been set at a location that is earlier than the auto punch-in point. The MD4S cannot be turned on! —Owner’s Manual 102 Appendix Symptom Advice In some cases, punch-in or ping-pong recording may not be possible on a song that was edited on an MD recorder other than the MD4S or the Yamaha MD8/MD4. Use the Song Copy function to Cannot use the punch-in/out copy the song, and perform the punch-in/out or ping-pong recording operation on the copy. or ping-pong recording function! If the song was recorded on an MD recorder other than the MD4S or the Yamaha MD8/MD4, it is possible that the song may be copyprotected (by SCMS). In this case, it will not be possible to perform punch-in or ping-pong recording. Make sure that the Pitch function is not set to VARI. Recordings play back at the wrong pitch! Make sure that the 1/2 Play function is turned off. Make sure that the Last Record In/Out points have been set. If they Cannot use Part Copy or Part have been set, the IN/OUT point indicators will light. Erase! Make sure that the Last Record Out point has not been set in a location earlier than the Last Record In point. The signal of the input chan- Rotate the AUX control toward 1 or 2, and raise the channel fader. nel is not output from the Since the signal sent to the AUX SEND jacks is post-fader, no signal AUX SEND jacks! will be sent to the AUX SEND jacks unless the channel fader is raised. Make sure not all steps in the Cue List are set for zero repeats (n=0). Cannot play the Cue List! Make sure that the specified ranges within the cue list are correct. Make sure that no non-existent markers are selected in the cue list. Make sure that your MIDI sequencer supports MTC or MIDI Clock. Make sure that the MIDI sequencer has been set to synchronize to incoming MTC or MIDI Clock messages. If you are using MIDI Clock, make sure that a tempo map has been programmed in the MD4S. (If the measure/beat display does not appear when you press the DISPLAY button, a tempo map has not been set.) MIDI sequencer does not Make sure that the MD4S has been set to transmit MTC or MIDI synchronize to the MD4S! Clock messages from its MIDI OUT connector. When MTC is being transmitted, the MTC SYNC MASTER indicator will light. When MIDI Clock is being transmitted, the MIDI CLK indicator will light. Make sure that X1/2 Play is turned off. If X1/2 Play is on, synchronization is not possible. If you are using a Repeat function such as A-B Repeat, some time may be required for the MIDI sequencer to synchronize during a repeat, due to the slowness of the MD4S locate function. —Owner’s Manual Display Messages 103 Display Messages Message ADJST Stop BLANK X Blank Disc Can’t Combn Can’t Copy Can’t REC Can’t Rehe CLK OFF! Copy Stop DiscErr xx Disc FULL Erase Stop Erase Warn! Error xx IN/OUT Err InvalidSong List Error MARK Failed Move Stop MTC OFF! No Blank No Disc PNCH Abort Protected Reading TOC Reload Disc Save Warn ! UTOC FULL Writing TOC Meaning The STOP button was pressed, so the Adjust function was cancelled. The MD4S is located at the Blank Top position. The disc is blank. MD4S cannot combine these two songs because they were not split using the Song Divide function, or MD4S cannot edit this type of song. This song cannot be copied because it’s copy protected. The MD4S cannot record over this type of song, so you cannot overwrite this song. The MD4S does not have permission to record in this mode, so you cannot rehearse a recording that would overwrite this song. MIDI Clock was turned OFF automatically because you selected the Program Play or Cue List function. The STOP button was pressed, so the Song Copy, Track Copy, Part Copy, or Cue List Copy function was cancelled. A disc scratch or defect was discovered while recording. Replace the disc. The disc is full. You cannot record any more data or additional takes (Multi Take Auto Punch In). The STOP button was pressed, so the Track Erase or Part Erase function was cancelled. This song has been write protected by another recorder. Press the ENTER button to erase or the EXIT button to cancel. A fatal error occurred. Contact your Yamaha dealer. The IN or OUT point is not valid, so you cannot use Auto Punch In/Out. Since this song is not compatible with the MD4S, it cannot be played. The cue list is invalid. No more markers can be inserted because the song contains the maximum of eight, or you tried to insert a marker at the position of an existing marker. The STOP button was pressed, so the Song Move function was cancelled. MTC was turned OFF automatically because you selected the Program Play or Cue List function. No blank area can be found for further recording. No disc is loaded. Because the STOP button was pressed, the off-line punch-in/out function was aborted. The disc’s write protect tab is set to protect, so you cannot record. The MD4S is reading the TOC from disc. The MD4S is waiting for you to reload the disc. Not all the Tempo Map steps can be saved because the data area is full. The TOC area is full, so not all of the song title or Tempo Map could be saved. The MD4S is writing the TOC to disc. —Owner’s Manual 104 Appendix Modes of the MD4S transport ● On z Flashing Mode Indicators REHE REC PLAY MD4S operating Status Stop Play — — — — — ● No activity. Normal playback Play Pause — — z Playback is paused. Cue FF — — ● Review — — ● Record Pause — z — Recording is paused. Record — ● ● Recording in progress. Rehearse Pause z — — Rehearsal is paused. Rehearse New Record ● — — ● ● ● Rehearsal in progress. A new song is being recorded. New Record Pause — z — New song recording is paused. Auto Punch Record Standby — z — Play Record Wait — z ● Auto Punch Rehearse Standby z — — Play Rehearse Wait z — ● —Owner’s Manual High-speed playback at 1/2 speed or 2X, 4X, 8X, 16X or 32X speed. High-speed reverse playback at 2X, 4X, 8X, 16X or 32X speed. The Auto Punch In/Out function has been activated and the MD4S is standing by to start the Auto Punch recording sequence. The Auto Punch recording sequence has started and is currently between the Pre-Roll point and the Punch IN point. The Auto Punch In/Out Rehearse function has been activated and the MD4S is standing by to start the Auto Punch rehearsal sequence. The Auto Punch rehearsal sequence has started and is currently between the Pre-Roll point and the Punch IN point. Specifications 105 Specifications Recorder Digital/Audio Rec/Play Locate Sampling Frequency: 44.1 kHz Compression: ATRAC Frequency Response: 20 Hz–20 kHz, +1 dB, –3 dB THD+N: Less than 0.02% (1 kHz) S/N: 96 dB typ. 4-track independent simultaneous record/play (Recording time: 37 min) Dubbing with 4-track playback Auto & Manual Punch In/Out (11.6 ms accuracy) Four-track (37 min), Stereo (74 min), or Mono (148 min) record/play Repeat play A-B, Single song, All song Vari-pitch (±10%) Start and End point of Song Direct Time Locate 10 Marker locate points for each song Last Recording In/Out point Cue & review 0.5x, 2x, 4x, 8x, 16x, 32x play speed Disc Editing Disc Erase Song Editing Copy, Move, Divide, Combine, Renumber, Erase Track Editing Track Copy, Part Copy, Track Erase, Part Erase Title Editing Disc title, Song title Panel Controls REC SELECT buttons 1–4, BUS button Transport buttons: PLAY, STOP, PAUSE, REC, REHE, SONG SEARCH, EJECT Mode buttons: AUTO PUNCH I/O, EDIT, UTILITY, ADJUST, PITCH, PEAK HOLD, DISPLAY, EXIT CURSOR shuttle/DATA dial Locate buttons: MARK, MARK SEARCH, LAST REC (IN/OUT), SEARCH, SET, REPEAT, A B MIDI MIDI IN, OUT, THRU jacks Display FLD (Fluorescent Display) Mixer Inputs Outputs MIC/LINE IN (CH1, 2) MIC/LINE IN (CH1, 2) MIC/LINE INPUT (CH3–4) LINE INPUT (CH5–8) INSERT IN/OUT (CH 1, 2) 2TR IN (L, R) TRACK DIRECT OUT (1–4) STEREO OUT (L, R) MONITOR OUT (L, R) AUX SEND (1, 2) PHONES OUT Balanced phone jack x2 (–10 to –50 dB) Balanced XLR x2 (–10 to –50 dB) Unbalanced phone jack x2 (–10 to –50 dB) Unbalanced phone jack x4 (–10 dB) TRS phone jack x2 (–10 dB) Phono x2 (–10 dB) Phono x4(–10 dB) Phono x2 (–10 dB) Phono x2 (–10 dB) Phone jack x2 (–10 dB) Stereo phone jack (8–40 Ω) Frequency response 20 Hz–20 kHz +1, –3 dB EQ 3-band, ±15 dB (LOW: 100 Hz shelving, MID: Peaking (2.5 kHz), HIGH: 10 kHz Shelving) MASTER Channel Features Stereo Fader (45 mm), Monitor Level control, Monitor Select buttons (2TR IN, STEREO, CUE), CUE MIX TO STEREO buttons 0 dB is referenced to 0.775 V r.m.s. —Owner’s Manual Appendix General Power Requirements USA & Canada: 120 V/60 Hz, Others: 230 V/50 Hz Power Consumption 24 W Dimensions (W x H x D) 413 x 109.5 x 388 mm Weight 5.2 kg Operating Conditions Temperature: 5˚C–35˚C (41˚F–95˚F), Humidity: 10%–95% Supplied Accessories AC power cord, Owner’s Manual Optional Accessories FC5 Footswitch Dimensions W: 413 H: 109 .5 D: 388 106 Unit: mm Specifications subject to change without notice. —Owner’s Manual Block Diagram 107 INSERT I/O PB CH1 OFF Recorder Tr1 PB REC PAN CH2 3 Band EQ OFF Recorder Tr2 PB REC 2 R HIGH GAIN MID FLIP LOW MIC/ LINE to Meter CUE PAN INSERT I/O PB 2* 1 AUX CUE LEVEL HA REC L HIGH FLIP GAIN LOW 1* PAN 3 Band EQ MIC/ LINE MID HA (PB) to Meter Tr4 from ST AUX CUE LR 12 LR Tr3 Tr1 * MIC/LINE INPUT jacks 1 and 2 accept either phone or XLR plugs. Only one plug can be inserted in each jack. Tr2 Block Diagram AUX CUE LEVEL CUE PAN MIC/LINE INPUT PB PAN OFF PAN CH4 3 Band EQ OFF Recorder Tr4 REC PB 4 R HIGH MID MIC/ LINE LOW GAIN CUE PAN to Meter PB FLIP 3 AUX CUE LEVEL HA Recorder Tr3 PB REC L HIGH FLIP GAIN 4 CH3 3 Band EQ MIC/ LINE MID HA LOW 3 to Meter TRACK DIRECT OUT AUX CUE LEVEL CUE PAN L STEREO OUT STEREO R 5 STEREO 5/6 LINE INPUT 6 L 7 CUE 7/8 8 CUE MIX TO STEREO MONITOR LEVEL MONITOR OUT R PHONES L 2TR IN 2TR IN R 1 AUX SEND 2 —Owner’s Manual 108 Appendix Glossary This section explains the technical terms used in this owner’s manual. ATRAC—An acronym for Adaptive Transform Acoustic Coding. This is the compression technique used to fit the same amount of data as that of a 120 mm CD on a 64 mm MiniDisc. Using the ATRAC system, the MD4S provides an 4-track recording time of 37 minutes. ATRAC uses established psychoacoustic principles to compress audio data to approximately one-fifth of its original size, with virtually no loss in sound quality. The threshold of hearing principle states that the sensitivity of the human ear is frequency dependent. Two tones of the same level but at different frequencies will not be heard at the same loudness. Another principle used is the masking effect. That is, softer sounds become inaudible when louder sounds at similar frequencies are present. Bus—A “bus” is a route for audio signals to which the signal from each input channel can be distributed, and which can be sent to its own output jack. The MD4S has the following buses. ST bus: Input channel signals are mixed in stereo to the stereo bus, and output from the STEREO OUT jacks. CUE bus: Signals from each input channel and the track playback are mixed in stereo to the Cue bus, and output from the MONITOR OUT jacks and the PHONES jack. The output signal of this bus is mainly used to monitor signals during recording. AUX bus: Signals from each input channel are mixed in monaural to the AUX buses, and output from the AUX OUT jacks. The output signal of these buses are mainly used as sends to external effect processors, etc. Clipping—The unwanted distortion effect of overloading an audio circuit with a signal that is too large. Care must be taken when setting the MD4S GAIN controls so as not to overload the recording circuits. See “Recording the first track (Direct Recording)” on page 26. Cue List—The Cue List function allows you to compile a cue list (i.e., a sequence of cues for playback) using markers. Cues are loaded into memory for continuous, uninterrupted playback. A new song can be created from the Cue List using the Cue List Copy function. See “Cue List playback” on page 68 for more information. DAT—An acronym for Digital Audio Tape. DAT recorders are especially popular in recording studios for recording the final stereo mix. EQ—An acronym for an audio equalizer. The MD4S input channels feature three-band EQ. Foot switch—A foot operated switch. Several MD4S transport functions and the punch in/ out function can be controlled using an optional footswitch. Frame—An integral unit of the MD DATA disc format. One frame can hold 11.6 ms of data (i.e., 512 samples of ATRAC sound data at 44.1 kHz). There are approximately 86 frames in a second. Using the FrameDisp function you can select between 86 (MD) and 30 (MTC) frames per second. Input channel—An “input channel” is a section of the mixer that individually processes an input signal. After a signal is input to an input channel, it is sent through the EQ to adjust its tone, its volume level is adjusted, and then it is routed to a variety of output jacks. Locate—To “locate” means to move to a specific point in the song. The MD4S provides a variety of Locate functions that allow you to jump instantly to the desired location. See “Quick search functions” on page 61 for more information. MD DATA—A compact data storage medium designed to store computer-type data. Although similar to MiniDiscs, they are not interchangeable. MD DATA discs come in two varieties: playback only and rewritable. MD4S uses the rewritable type for recording. See “Buying discs for the MD4S” on page 10 for more information. —Owner’s Manual Glossary 109 MIDI—An acronym for Musical Instrument Digital Interface. An internationally agreed standard that allows electronic musical instruments and audio equipment to communicate. MIDI Clock—A clock signal transmitted as MIDI data. MIDI Clock refers to a timing signal and Start, Continue, and Stop commands. The MD4S can supply MIDI Clock to a MIDI sequencer for synchronized operation. MIDI Song Position Pointer—A type of MIDI message that is used to derive position information from a MIDI Clock signal. The MD4S generates MIDI Song Position Pointers. So no matter where you start playback in a song, your MIDI sequencer will locate to that point and then play along in synchronization. MIDI Timecode (MTC)—An addition to the MIDI Standard that allows audio equipment to be synchronized. MIDI Timecode contains clock and position information. MD4S can supply MTC to a MIDI sequencer for synchronized operation. MiniDisc—A compact data storage medium designed to store music. MiniDiscs come in two varieties: playback only and recordable. MiniDiscs can only be used for 2-track or mono recording with the MD4S. MiniDiscs recorded on the MD4S can be played on a normal MiniDisc deck. See also Random Access, ATRAC, and MD DATA Disc. Mixdown—“Mixdown” (also called “track-down”) is the process of mixing two or more previously-recorded tracks into a stereo mix, and recording the result on an external master recorder. Monitor CUE—The cue monitor allows you to monitor individual tracks as they are being recorded or played back. In Record Pause mode and during recording, the CUE monitor source is the signal being recorded (i.e., the input signal). For playback the CUE monitor source is from disc (i.e., the signal that was recorded to disc). This is useful with the punch in/ out functions, because you can monitor the recorded signal up to the specified IN point, and then the new signal that’s being recorded up to the OUT point. Overdub Recording—“Overdubbing” is the process of recording a new performance while monitoring other previously-recorded tracks. Panning—A technique used to position sounds in a stereo mix. PB—An abbreviation for Playback. This abbreviation appears next to the input selector switch on each input channel and is used to select the disc signal as the source for the input channel. Phone Jack—A 1/4-inch socket commonly used on audio equipment. Phono Jack—Also know as an RCA jack, this type of connector is often used on semiprofessional audio and video equipment. Ping-Pong—“Ping-pong” recording is the process of mixing two or more previouslyrecorded tracks, and re-recording the mix to one or two other tracks. Pre-Roll Time—For Auto Punch In/Out, this is the time before the IN point at which playback starts. See “Setting the pre-roll/post-roll times” on page 55 for more information. Post Fader—A point in the signal path after a fader. The signals for the MD4S AUX controls are sourced post-fader. So as well as turn up the AUX control, you must also raise the fader. This has the advantage that the level of the processed signal from the external effects processor depends on the level of the unprocessed signal that is controlled by the fader. Post-Roll Time—For Auto Punch In/Out, this is the time after the OUT point at which playback stops. See “Setting the pre-roll/post-roll times” on page 55 for more information. Punch In/Out—A recording technique that allows you to rerecord specific sections of an existing track. The MD4S provides both manual and automatic punch in/out operations. Random Access—The ability to access data instantly. The MD4S quick locate functions allow you to locate any point instantly. Tape-based recorders do not have random access capabilities because they have to wind a tape, which takes time. —Owner’s Manual 110 Appendix SCMS (Serial Copy Management System)—A protection system intended to prevent illegal copying of music. SCMS allows one-time serial copying of copy-protected material. If the source is not copy protected, it’s possible to make any number of digital-to-digital copies of the material. If the source is copy protected, however, it’s possible to make a first-generation copy, but further copies cannot be made from the first-generation copy. SCMS is only effective when copying via digital connections. Recordings made via analog connections are not affected. Signal to Noise Ratio (S/N)—In an audio system, the difference between the nominal signal level and the residual noise floor, usually expressed as a ratio in decibels. It’s used as a measure of an audio system’s noise performance. Tempo Map—A map containing the tempo and meter information for a song. TOC—An acronym for Table Of Contents. An area of the MD DATA disc used to store information about what is recorded on the disc, the disc title, song titles, and so on. Tracking—A “track” is an area used to record and playback an individual audio signal. The MD4S has four tracks, each of which can be recorded/played independently. Recorders like the MD4S which have multiple tracks are called “multi-track recorders” (MTR). Unity Gain—A gain of one. That is, the signal is output from a circuit at the same level at which it entered. Once passed the MIC/LINE amplifier, a unity gain system minimizes signal noise and distortion. The unity gain position for the MD4S faders is at the 7–8 mark. —Owner’s Manual Tempo Map Chart 111 Tempo Map Chart Meter Tempo Step Measure Time Signature Step Measure -Beat A 001 / A 001–1 B / B C / C D / D E / E F / F G / G H / H I / I J / J K / K L / L M / M N / N O / O P / P Q / Q R / R S / S T / T U / U V / V W / W X / X Y / Y Z / Z Tempo —Owner’s Manual YAMAHA [Multitrack Recorder] Date: 11 02 1998 MIDI Implementation Chart Model: MD4S Function... Transmitted Recognized Basic Channel Default Changed X X X X Mode Default Messages Altered X X ************** X X X True Voice X ************** X X Note Number Version: 1.0 Remarks Velocity Note On Note Off X X X X After Touch Keys Ch’s X X X X Pitch bend X X Control Change X X X ************** X X X O *1 *2 Prog Change :True# System Exclusive System Common :Song Pos :Song Sel :Tune O X X X X X System Real Time :Clock :Commands O O X X Aux Messages :Local ON/OFF :All Notes OFF :Active Sense :Reset X X X X X X X X Notes MTC quarter frame messages are received in MTC Sync slave mode MTC quarter frame messages are transmitted in MTC Sync master mode. *1: MMC *2: During MIDI Clock synchronization Mode 1: OMNI ON, POLY Mode 3: OMNI OFF, POLY Mode 2: OMNI ON, MONO Mode 4: OMNI OFF, MONO O: Yes X: No Index 113 Index Numerics 2TR IN jacks 23 2-track (2TR) 11 4-track (4TR) 11 A A B button 68 A-B Repeat 68 A B repeat button 17 AC IN 23 Adding sounds during mixdown 42 ADJUST button 18, 63, 65 Advanced recording techniques 35 All Song Repeat 67 Applying an effect during ping-pong recording 48 Applying an effect only to the monitor signal 50 Applying effects 44 Applying effects during mixdown 47 ATRAC 108 AUTO PUNCH I/O button 17 Auto punch indicator 21 auto punch-in point 55 auto punch-in/out 55, 56 , 58 auto punch-in/out points 62 auto punch-out point 55 AUX bus 108 AUX control 14 AUX SEND 1, 2 jacks 23 AUX SEND jacks 46 B backward (review) 66 blank area 12, 27 Bus 108 BUS button 17 C Check the recording level 27 Clipping 108 CUE bus 108 Cue List 68, 69, 70 , 108 cue mix function 15 , 43 CUE MIX indicator 20 CUE MIX TO STEREO switch 15, 43 CUE PAN/CUE LEVEL controls 14 Cue/Review 66 CURSOR shuttle 18 I IN, OUT indicators 21 Input channel 108 INSERT I/O jacks 22, 44 Inserting a marker 62 D DAT 108 DATA dial (DATA+ –) 18 DATA dial and CURSOR shuttle 61 direct recording 26 disc 10 disc contents 86 Disc Erase 86 Disc transport buttons 16 Display 19 display brightness 88 DISPLAY button 18 Display Massages 103 E EDIT button 18 Editing functions 73 EJECT button 17 end marker 63 ENTER button 18 EQ 108 EQ controls 14 EXIT button 18 extend the length of Song 12, 79, 81, 86 F Fader 14 Find a blank area 27 FIX (fixed) 84 FLIP switch 13 Foot switch 54, 89, 108 Frame 88, 108 Function buttons 18 G GAIN control 13 L LAST REC SEARCH [IN] button 62 LAST REC SEARCH [IN]/[OUT] button 17 LAST REC SEARCH [OUT] button 62 last record in point 55, 62 last record out point 55 , 62 Level (5/6), (7/8) controls 15 LINE INPUT 5~8 jacks 22 Locate 108 M Manual punch-in/out 52, 53, 54 MARK button 17, 62 MARK SEARCH [ ]/[ ] button 17, 62 Marker indicators 21 , 63 Markers 62 MD DATA 10, 108 MIC/LINE INPUT 1,2 jacks 22 MIC/LINE INPUT 3, 4 jacks 22 MIDI 109 Implementation chart 112 MIDI Clock 91, 92, 109 MIDI functions 90 MIDI IN connector 24 MIDI IN, OUT, THRU connectors 24 MIDI indicators 20 MIDI OUT connector 24 MIDI Song Position Pointer 91 , 109 MIDI THRU connector 24 MIDI Timecode (MTC) 109 MiniDisc 10, 109 Mixdown 32, 109 Mixing multiple channels as you record 36 MMC (MIDI Machine Control) 98 MMC Device ID 99 MMC Master 98 —Owner’s Manual 114 Index MMC Slave 98 monaural (MONO) 11 Monitor CUE 109 MONITOR LEVEL control 15 MONITOR OUT jacks 23 MONITOR SELECT switches 15 Monitor/Master section 15 Mono Inputs 13 MTC 91, 94 MTC Master 94 MTC Slave 94 Multi-take 58 O One Song Repeat 67 Overdub Recording 109 Overdubbing 30 P PAN control 14 Part Copy 73 Part Erase 74 PAUSE button 16 PB 109 PEAK HOLD button 18 Phone Jack 109 PHONES jack 24 Phono Jack 109 Ping-Pong 109 Ping-pong recording 39 PITCH button 18 Pitch function 84 Pitch indicator 19 PLAY button 16 play forward (cue) 66 PLAY indicator 16 post-fader 14 , 109 post-roll point 55 Post-Roll Time 109 POWER switch 23 pre-roll point 55 Pre-Roll Time 109 pre-roll/post-roll times 55 Program Play 71 PUNCH I/O jack 24 , 89 Punch-in/out 52, 53, 54, 109 Q Quick search functions 61 —Owner’s Manual R Random Access 109 REC button 16 REC indicator 16 REC SELECT buttons 17 recording mode 11, 76, 87 Recording the first track 26 REHE button 16 REHE indicator 16 rehearsal function 52 Rehearsing 57, 58 REPEAT button 17, 67 Repeat function 67 Repeat indicator 21 Track Erase 76 Track level meters 20 Track recording indicators 20 Tracking 110 U Unity gain 14, 110 UTILITY button 18 V VARI (variable) 84 S X SCMS 110 SET button 17 Signal to Noise Ratio 110 Single-take 56 Song Combine 80 Song Copy 76 Song Divide 79 Song Erase 78 Song Move 81 Song Renumber 82 SONG SEARCH [ ]/[ ] buttons 17 , 61 songs 12 ST bus 108 start marker 63 Status indicators 19 STEREO fader 15 Stereo Inputs 15 Stereo level meter 20 STEREO OUT jacks 23 STOP button 11 STOP/TOC WRITE button 17 x1/2 Play 67 T Tempo Map 92, 110 Time counter 21 Time counter mode 20 Title and function display 19 Titling 85 TOC 11, 110 TOC EDIT indicator 11, 19 TOC WRITE button 11 Track Copy 75 TRACK DIRECT OUT 1~4 jacks 23 V291240 R2 1 IP 116 01 03 1500 CP Printed in Japan Pro Audio & Digital Musical Instrument Division P.O. Box 3, Hamamatsu, 430-8651, Japan YAMAHA CORPORATION 1 1 0 1 0 L 1 2 FLIP Marker Log 3 2 3 2 5 4 5 4 7 6 8 8 7 9 6 10 PAN 9 R 2 –15 AUX 10 L 1 +15 –15 AUX PAN +15 –15 LOW –15 LOW –15 MID +15 –15 MID 0 L HIGH 10 0 L E V E L CUE MIC/ LINE LINE HIGH R L P A N PB MIC/ LINE CUE MIC LINE FLIP 2 GAIN 1 GAIN Source: Source: S R 2 +15 +15 +15 10 R PB L E V E L P A N MIC 0 L 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 PAN L 1 –15 AUX –15 LOW –15 MID HIGH CUE MIC/ LINE LINE GAIN 3 FLIP 3 1 R 2 +15 +15 +15 10 R PB L E V E L P A N MIC 0 L 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 PAN L 1 –15 AUX –15 LOW –15 MID HIGH CUE MIC/ LINE LINE GAIN 4 FLIP 4 Source: Mixer Setup Source: 2 R 2 +15 +15 +15 10 R PB L E V E L P A N MIC 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 0 7/8 MAX 3 STEREO MIN MONITOR LEVEL CUE STEREO 2TR IN MONITOR SELECT 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 10 Source: CUE MIX TO STEREO 10 0 5/6 Source: 4 3 5 6 7 Tracking Sheet 8 → Y 9 → → X Z → → → → W V U T → S → → P Notes: → R O Process: → → N Step: → Q M → → → J K → → H I → G → → E F → → C D → → A B Section Cue List Step L 4 Date: Session Info 2 Title: 1 Track List 10 Repeat E
  • Page 1 1
  • Page 2 2
  • Page 3 3
  • Page 4 4
  • Page 5 5
  • Page 6 6
  • Page 7 7
  • Page 8 8
  • Page 9 9
  • Page 10 10
  • Page 11 11
  • Page 12 12
  • Page 13 13
  • Page 14 14
  • Page 15 15
  • Page 16 16
  • Page 17 17
  • Page 18 18
  • Page 19 19
  • Page 20 20
  • Page 21 21
  • Page 22 22
  • Page 23 23
  • Page 24 24
  • Page 25 25
  • Page 26 26
  • Page 27 27
  • Page 28 28
  • Page 29 29
  • Page 30 30
  • Page 31 31
  • Page 32 32
  • Page 33 33
  • Page 34 34
  • Page 35 35
  • Page 36 36
  • Page 37 37
  • Page 38 38
  • Page 39 39
  • Page 40 40
  • Page 41 41
  • Page 42 42
  • Page 43 43
  • Page 44 44
  • Page 45 45
  • Page 46 46
  • Page 47 47
  • Page 48 48
  • Page 49 49
  • Page 50 50
  • Page 51 51
  • Page 52 52
  • Page 53 53
  • Page 54 54
  • Page 55 55
  • Page 56 56
  • Page 57 57
  • Page 58 58
  • Page 59 59
  • Page 60 60
  • Page 61 61
  • Page 62 62
  • Page 63 63
  • Page 64 64
  • Page 65 65
  • Page 66 66
  • Page 67 67
  • Page 68 68
  • Page 69 69
  • Page 70 70
  • Page 71 71
  • Page 72 72
  • Page 73 73
  • Page 74 74
  • Page 75 75
  • Page 76 76
  • Page 77 77
  • Page 78 78
  • Page 79 79
  • Page 80 80
  • Page 81 81
  • Page 82 82
  • Page 83 83
  • Page 84 84
  • Page 85 85
  • Page 86 86
  • Page 87 87
  • Page 88 88
  • Page 89 89
  • Page 90 90
  • Page 91 91
  • Page 92 92
  • Page 93 93
  • Page 94 94
  • Page 95 95
  • Page 96 96
  • Page 97 97
  • Page 98 98
  • Page 99 99
  • Page 100 100
  • Page 101 101
  • Page 102 102
  • Page 103 103
  • Page 104 104
  • Page 105 105
  • Page 106 106
  • Page 107 107
  • Page 108 108
  • Page 109 109
  • Page 110 110
  • Page 111 111
  • Page 112 112
  • Page 113 113
  • Page 114 114
  • Page 115 115

Yamaha MD4S Manual de usuario

Categoría
Mezcladores de audio
Tipo
Manual de usuario